CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
TECHNICAL FIELD
[0002] This disclosure features methods and compositions for treating diseases of the gastrointestinal
tract with a S1P modulator.
BACKGROUND
[0003] The gastrointestinal (GI) tract generally provides a therapeutic medium for an individual's
body. One means of accessing the therapeutic medium of the GI tract is via oral administration,
however, the convenience of per oral delivery is countered by well-established challenges.
For instance, traditional oral delivery of a drug may lend itself to systemic exposure
associated with undesirable or potentially harmful side effects. Another challenge
associated with oral administration relates to potential instability of the drug upon
exposure to the harsh chemical and/or enzymatic degradation conditions of the GI tract.
Yet at times, therapeutic drugs may need to be dispensed to specified locations within
the small intestine or large intestine, which is more effective than traditional oral
administration of the therapeutic drugs to cure or alleviate the symptoms of some
medical conditions. For example, therapeutic drugs dispensed directly within the small
intestine would not be contaminated, digested or otherwise compromised in the stomach,
and thus allow a higher dose to be delivered at a specific location within the small
intestine. An effective way to provide topical/local delivery to the GI tract (and/or
to a particular portion or section of the GI tract) - of a therapeutic drug to treat
the diseased tissue in GI tract with would be desirable, given the following advantages
over systemic administration:
- Reduced systemic exposure;
- Increase bioavailability at disease site;
- Potential to reduce the therapeutic dose relative to that required when delivered
systemically;
- Supply drug to the biophase only when required;
- Maintain drug in intact form as close as possible to the target site; and
- Provide high residence time of the drug in an environment with low digestive enzymatic
activity, particularly for delivery to the colon. [Van den Mooter & Kinget, Drug Delivery, 2, pp. 81-93 (1995].
[0004] In practice, however, there are several challenges to such an approach. To begin
with, identifying a "go / no-go" trigger for delivery to a specific site is generally
difficult (e.g., see
Rubenstein A. "Approaches and Opportunities in Colon-Specific Drug Delivery"; Critical
Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 12(2&3), pp. 101-149 (1995)., p. 106:
"A successful delivery of a drug molecule to the colon means that most of it has been
transported intact through the stomach and the small intestine. Practically, one cannot
find a physiologic feature that may serve as a "go no-go" trigger for [delivery of]
colonic-specific drugs. "). For example, dispensing therapeutic drugs directly within the small intestine inside
a human body (e.g., the cecum, the ascending colon) can be difficult, because a device
or mechanism or a particular formulation) would be needed to transport a therapeutically
effective dose of drug to a desired location within the small intestine and then automatically
deliver the therapeutic drug at the desired location. Such a device or mechanism also
would also need to be operated in a safe manner in that the device or mechanism needs
to physically enter the human body. Dispensing therapeutic drugs directly within other
locations in the GI tract of the human body can be similarly difficult.A further hurdle
exists when the drug is a biologic, such as a monoclonal antibody, in which case there
is a need to achieve high concentrations of the therapeutic drug in the large intestine
for diseases such as, for example, colitis, and Crohn's disease [
Van den Mooter et al., Drug Delivery (1996)]. Monoclonal antibodies ("mAbs") are typically delivered in single doses, generally
100 mg to 1 g protein per dose; since formulations of mAbs typically have concentrations
up to about 50 mg/mL, administration of a relatively high volume of 2-20mL per dose
is required [
Yang et al., PNAS, 2003]. At the relatively high concentrations required to deliver efficacious doses, mAbs
have a tendency to aggregate; in addition, these high concentrations often result
in very high viscosity and poor overall stability [Yang et al.]. Increasing protein
concentrations may also result in opalescence, complicating the visual inspection
[
Puhl et al., Asian J. Pharm. Sci. II (2016), pp. 469-477]. While the use of more dilute formulations may help overcome these drawbacks, the
resulting large volumes may not be practical for oral delivery to treat diseases and
conditions of the GI tract, and may instead be conducive to IV infusion - which, in
turn, may enhance unwanted systemic exposure.
[0005] Methods typically employed to deliver drugs locally all have their own drawbacks.
For example, the usefulness of formulations relying on pH-mediated release (including
but not limited to enteric coated formulations) may be limited by the high inter-
and intra-patient variability of pH and microflora. The utility may be further limited
in patient populations having highly variable motility (e.g., patients with ulcerative
colitis), contributing to unpredictable transit times (times for transitioning from
one portion of the GI tract to an adjacent portion). For example, budesonide formulated
using Multi Matrix (MMX
®) colonic delivery technology (budesonide MMX
®) is a once-daily oral tablet designed for controlled release of budesonide throughout
the colon for the treatment of ulcerative colitis. The tablet relies on pH-mediated
release. When
153Sm labelled budesonide MMX
® tablets were administered to 12 healthy subjects and evaluated for initial tablet
disintegration (ITD) within the GI tract via pharmaco-scintigraphy, high variability
in the location and time of ITD were observed, ranging from release in the ileum or
small intestine/ileum after 6 to 12 hours (4 subjects) to release in the sigmoid colon
after greater than 24 h (1 subject) [
Brunner M. et al. "Gastrointestinal transit, release and plasma pharmacokinetics of
a new oral budesonide formulation" Br. J. Clin. Pharmacol. (2006) 61(1), pp. 31-38.]. Moreover, pH is dysregulated in ulcerative colitis patients, making MMX technology
and other pH-dependent drug delivery technologies less predictable. Not only are release
and emulsification of drug unpredictable, but such technologies also have poor compatibility
with some preferred formulation systems, including emulsifying systems. Rectal delivery
forms (suppositories and enemas) have varying effectiveness since here too high variability
has been observed in the distribution of these forms. Suppositories are only effective
in the rectum because of their confined spread, and enemas may only offer effective
topical treatment only to the sigmoid colon and descending colon [
Van den Mooter et al., Drug Delivery (1996)].
[0006] Ingestible devices for delivery of drugs in the gastrointestinal tract have been
described in prior art (
J. Drug Delivery & Ther. 2(3):1-8, 2012;
Intl. J. Pharm. Ind. 6(3):72-74;
Gastrointest. Endosc. 78(3);520-528;
WO2016049602;
WO2004/066903). However, none of these disclose the effective delivery of drugs in the cecum.In
sum, there remains a significant unmet medical need for improved treatment regimens
for gastrointestinal diseases, such as inflammatory bowel disease (IBD), including
a need for regimens which can dispense therapeutics to specific locations within the
GI tract, thereby reducing or avoiding the drawbacks of oral or other forms of systemic
administration.
SUMMARY
[0007] The invention is as defined in the appended claims. The technical teachings can be
summarized as follows:
The present disclosure provides novel treatment paradigms for inflammatory conditions
of the gastrointestinal tract. The methods and compositions described herein allow
for the regio-specific release of therapeutic drugs in the cecum, wherein the site
of disease is in the colon. By releasing a therapeutic drug locally instead of systemically,
the bioavailability of the drug can be increased at the site of injury and/or decreased
in the systemic circulation, thereby resulting in improved overall safety and/or efficacy
and fewer adverse side effects. Advantages may include one or more of increased drug
engagement at the target, leading to new and more efficacious treatment regimens,
and/or lower systemic drug levels, which can translate to reduced toxicity and reduced
immunogenicity, e.g., in the case of biologics. In some instances, releasing a therapeutic
drug locally also provides for new modes of action that may be unique to local delivery
in the cecum as opposed to systemic administration. For patients, clinicians and payors,
this can mean an easier or simpler route of administration, fewer co-medicaments (e.g.,
immunomodulators), fewer side effects, and/or better outcomes.
[0008] Accordingly, described herein are methods for treating disorders of the gastrointestinal
(GI) tract. The methods can include one or more of:
- diagnosing a GI disease in a subject; and/or
- mapping, sampling, and/or assessing the site, severity, pathology, and extent of a
GI disease in the GI tract of a subject and/or mapping, sampling, and/or assessing
a patient response to a therapeutic agent, e.g., in the patient's GI tract; and/or
- identifying, quantifying, and/or monitoring one or more markers of a GI disease in
the GI tract of the subject and/or one or more markers of patient response to a therapeutic
agent, e.g., in the patient's GI tract;-and/or
- releasing a therapeutic agent in the cecum.
[0009] The present disclosure accordingly provides patients and physicians more personalized
treatment options for GI disorders by facilitating regimens which can release a therapeutic
agent according to desired (e.g., customized or optimized) dosage, timing, and/or
location parameters. In some cases, the treatment methods can employ one or more ingestible
devices to achieve the benefits disclosed herein.
[0010] Disclosed herein is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract
in a subject, comprising:
administering to the subject a pharmaceutical formulation that comprises a S1P modulator,
wherein the pharmaceutical formulation is released in the cecum, wherein the site
of disease is in the colon.
[0011] Provided herein the pharmaceutical formulation is administered in an ingestible device.
In some disclosures, the pharmaceutical formulation is released from an ingestible
device. In some disclosures, the ingestible device comprises a housing, a reservoir
containing the pharmaceutical formulation, and a release mechanism for releasing the
pharmaceutical formulation from the device,
wherein the reservoir is releasably or permanently attached to the exterior of the
housing or internal to the housing.
[0012] Provided herein is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in
a subject, comprising:
administering to the subject an ingestible device comprising a housing, a reservoir
containing a pharmaceutical formulation, and a release mechanism for releasing the
pharmaceutical formulation from the device,
wherein the reservoir is releasably or permanently attached to the exterior of the
housing or internal to the housing;
wherein the pharmaceutical formulation comprises a S 1P modulator , and
the ingestible device releases the pharmaceutical formulation in the cecum, wherein
the site of disease is in the colon.
[0013] In some embodiments, the housing is non-biodegradable in the GI tract.
In some embodiments, the release of the formulation is triggered autonomously. In
some embodiments, the location of one or more sites of disease is predetermined.
[0014] In some embodiments, the reservoir is made of a material that allows the formulation
to leave the reservoir, such as a biodegradable material.
[0015] In some embodiments, the release of the formulation is triggered by a pre-programmed
algorithm. In some embodiments, the release of the formulation is triggered by data
from a sensor or detector to identify the location of the device. In some more particular
embodiments, the data is not based solely on a physiological parameter (such as pH,
temperature, and/or transit time).
[0016] In some embodiments, the device comprises a detector configured to detect light reflectance
from an environment external to the housing. In some more particular embodiments,
the release is triggered autonomously or based on the detected reflectance.
[0017] In some embodiments, the device releases the formulation at substantially the same
time as one or more sites of disease are detected. In some embodiments, the one or
more sites of disease are detected by the device (e.g., by imaging the GI tract).
[0018] In some embodiments, the release mechanism is an actuation system. In some embodiments,
the release mechanism is a chemical actuation system. In some embodiments, the release
mechanism is a mechanical actuation system. In some embodiments, the release mechanism
is an electrical actuation system. In some embodiments, the actuation system comprises
a pump and releasing the formulation comprises pumping the formulation out of the
reservoir. In some embodiments, the actuation system comprises a gas generating cell.
[0019] In some embodiments, the formulation comprises a therapeutically effective amount
of the S1P modulator. In some embodiments, the formulation comprises a human equivalent
dose (HED) of the S1P modulator.
[0020] In some embodiments, the device is a device capable of releasing a solid S1P modulator
or a solid formulation comprising the S1P modulator. In some embodiments, the device
is a device capable of releasing a liquid S 1P modulator or a liquid formulation comprising
the S 1P modulator. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the pharmaceutical formulation
released from the device is a solid formulation. In other embodiments, the pharmaceutical
formulation release from the device is a liquid formulation.
[0021] The devices disclosed herein are capable of releasing a S1P modulator or a formulation
comprising the S1P modulator irrespective of the particular type of S1P modulator.
For example, the S1P modulator may be a small molecule, a biological, a nucleic acid,
an antibody, a fusion protein, and so on.
[0022] Provided herein is a method of releasing a S1P modulator into the cecum of a subject
for treating one or more sites of disease within the colon, the method comprising:
administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator
housed in an ingestible device, wherein the ingestible device comprises:
a detector configured to detect the presence of the one or more sites of disease,
and
a controller or processor configured to trigger the release of the S1P modulator in
the cecum in response to the detector detecting the presence of the one or more sites
of disease.
[0023] Also provided herein is a method of releasing a S1P modulator into the cecum of a
subject for treating one or more pre-determined sites of disease within the colon,
the method comprising:
administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator
contained in an ingestible device, wherein the ingestible device comprises:
a detector configured to detect the location of the device within the gastrointestinal
tract, and
a controller or processor configured to trigger the release of the S1P modulator in
the cecum in response to the detector detecting a location of the device in the cecum.
[0024] Providedherein is a method of releasing a S1P modulator into the cecum of a subject
for treating one or more sites of disease within the colon, the method comprising:
administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator
contained in an ingestible device;
receiving at an external receiver from the device a signal transmitting environmental
data;
assessing the environmental data to confirm the presence of the one or more sites
of disease; and
when the presence of the one or more sites of disease is confirmed, sending from an
external transmitter to the device a signal triggering the release of the S1P modulator
in the cecum.
[0025] Provided herein is a method of releasing a S1P modulator into the cecum of a subject
for treating one or more sites of disease within the colon, the method comprising:
administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator
contained in an ingestible device;
receiving at an external receiver from the device a signal transmitting environmental
or optical data;
assessing the environmental or optical data to confirm the location of the device
within the gastrointestinal tract; and
when the location of the device is confirmed, sending from an external transmitter
to the device a signal triggering the release of the S1P modulator in the cecum.
[0026] Provided herein in one embodiment is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal
tract in a subject, comprising:
delivering a S1P modulator to the cecum of the subject,
wherein the method comprises administering to the subject a pharmaceutical composition
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator .
[0027] Provided herein is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in
a subject, comprising:
releasing a S1P modulator in the cecum of the subject,
wherein the method comprises administering to the subject a pharmaceutical composition
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator.
[0028] Provided herein in one embodiment is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal
tract in a subject, comprising:
releasing a S1P modulator in the cecum of the subject,
wherein the method comprises administering to the subject a pharmaceutical composition
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator, wherein the pharmaceutical
composition is an ingestible device. and the method comprises administering orally
to the subject the pharmaceutical composition.
[0029] Provided herein is a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in
a subject, comprising:
releasing a S1P modulator in the cecum of the subject, wherein the method comprises
administering to the subject a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically
effective amount of the S1P modulator, wherein the method provides a concentration
of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 3 µg/ml.
[0030] In another aspect of the present invention, there is provided a S1P modulator for
use in a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in a subject according
to claim 1.
[0031] In another aspect, the present disclosure provides a composition comprising or consisting
of an ingestible device loaded with a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P modulator,
for use in a method of treatment, wherein the method comprises orally administering
the composition to the subject, wherein the S1P modulator is released by the device
in the cecum.
[0032] In another aspect, the present disclosure provides an ingestible device loaded with
a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P modulator, wherein the device is controllable
to release the S1P modulator in the cecum of the subject. The device may be for use
in a method of treatment of the human or animal body, for example, any method as described
herein.
[0033] In still another aspect, the present disclosure provides an ingestible device for
use in a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in a subject,
wherein the method comprises orally administering to the subject the ingestible device
loaded with a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P modulator, wherein the S1P
modulator is released by the device in the cecum of the subject.
[0034] An ingestible device as used in the present disclosure may comprise one or more mechanical
and/or electrical mechanisms which actively control release of the S1P modulator.
For example, in any of the above aspects and embodiments, the ingestible device as
used in the present invention may comprise a release mechanism for release of the
S 1P modulator (e.g., from a reservoir comprising the S 1P modulator) and an actuator
controlling the release mechanism.
[0035] In one disclosure, the ingestible device comprises:
an ingestible housing comprising a reservoir having a therapeutically effective amount
of the S1P modulator stored therein;
a release mechanism having a closed state which retains the S 1P modulator in the
reservoir and an open state which releases the S 1P modulator from the reservoir to
the exterior of the device; and
an actuator which changes the state of the release mechanism from the closed to the
open state.
[0036] In one aspect of the disclosure, the ingestible device comprises
a housing defined by a first end, a second end substantially opposite from the first
end;
a reservoir located within the housing and containing the S 1P modulator wherein a
first end of the reservoir is attached to the first end of the housing;
a mechanism for releasing the S 1P modulator from the reservoir;
and
an exit valve configured to allow the S 1P modulator to be released out of the housing
from the reservoir.
[0037] Here, the exit valve can be considered as the release mechanism having a closed state
which retains the S 1P modulator in the reservoir and an open state which releases
the S 1P modulator from the reservoir to the exterior of the device, and the mechanism
for releasing the S1P modulator from the reservoir can be considered as the actuator.
[0038] In some disclosures of methods of treatment as described herein, the one or more
disease sites may have been pre-determined (e.g., determined in a step preceding the
administration of the composition of the present disclosure). The disease site(s)
may have been determined by imaging the gastrointestinal tract. For example, the disease
site(s) may have been pre-determined by endoscopy (e.g., a step of colonoscopy, enteroscopy,
or using a capsule endoscope).
[0039] In some embodiments, the location of the device in the gut may be detected by tracking
the device. For example, the device may comprise a localization mechanism which may
be a communication system for transmitting localization data, e.g., by radiofrequency
transmission. The device may additionally or alternatively comprise a communication
system for receiving a signal remotely triggering the actuator and thus causing release
of the S 1P modulator. The signal may be sent when it is determined that the device
is in the correct location in the gut.
[0040] Thus, the ingestible device may comprise:
an ingestible housing comprising a reservoir having a therapeutically effective amount
of the S 1P modulator stored therein;
a release mechanism having a closed state which retains the S 1P modulator in the
reservoir and an open state which releases the S 1P modulator from the reservoir to
the exterior of the device;
a communication system for transmitting localization data to an external receiver
and for receiving a signal from an external transmitter; and
an actuator which changes the state of the release mechanism from the closed to the
open state and which can be triggered by the signal.
[0041] In other embodiments, the ingestible device as used in the present invention may
comprise an environmental sensor for detecting the location of the device in the gut.
For example, the environment sensor may be an image sensor for obtaining images
in vivo.
[0042] Where the ingestible device comprises an environmental sensor, actuation of the release
mechanism may be triggered by a processor or controller communicably coupled to the
environmental sensor. Thus, in some embodiments, the device may not require any external
signal or control in order to release the drug.
[0043] The ingestible device comprises:
an ingestible housing comprising a reservoir having a therapeutically effective amount
of the S1P modulator stored therein;
a release mechanism having a closed state which retains the S 1P modulator in the
reservoir and an open state which releases the S 1P modulator from the reservoir to
the exterior of the device;
an actuator which controls the transition of the release mechanism from the closed
to the open state;
a detector for detecting the location of the device in the gut and/or the presence
of diseased tissue; and
a processor or controller which is coupled to the detector and to the actuator and
which triggers the actuator to cause the release mechanism to transition from its
closed state to its open state to release the S 1P modulator in the cecum when it
is determined that the device is in the cecum of the subject, wherein the site of
disease is in the colon.
[0044] In another aspect of the disclosure, there is provided:
an ingestible housing comprising a reservoir having a therapeutically effective amount
of the S1P modulator stored therein;
a detector coupled to the ingestible housing, the detector configured to detect a
transition of the ingestible device from the ileum to the cecum;
a valve system in fluid communication with the reservoir system; and
a controller communicably coupled to the valve system and the detector, the controller
configured to cause the valve system to open in response to the detector detecting
a transition of the ingestible device from the ileum to the cecum so as to release
the therapeutically effective amount of the S 1P modulator in the cecum.
[0045] As above, detection of a transition from the ileum to the cecum may be based on environmental
data indicating the location of the device in the GI tract (and reference to a pre-determined
disease site).
[0046] Additionally, or alternatively, the device may further comprise a communication system
adapted to transmit the environment data to an external receiver (e.g., outside of
the body). This data may be used, for example, for diagnostic purposes. The external
receiver may comprise means for displaying the data.
[0047] These data may be analyzed externally to the device and used to determine when the
drug should be released: an external signal may then be sent to the device to trigger
release of the drug. Thus, the communication system may further be adapted to receive
a signal remotely triggering the actuator and thus causing release of the S 1P modulator.
The signal may be sent from an external transmitter in response to receipt/analysis
and/or assessment of the environmental data, e.g., data indicating that the device
has reached the desired location of the gut (where the location of the diseased tissue
has been pre-determined) and/or data indicating the presence of diseased tissue. "External"
may be "outside of the body."
[0048] Thus, in another aspect of the disclosure, the ingestible device may comprise:
an ingestible housing comprising a reservoir having a a therapeutically effective
amount of the S1P modulator stored therein;
a release mechanism having a closed state which retains the S 1P modulator in the
reservoir and an open state which releases the S 1P modulator from the reservoir to
the exterior of the device;
an environmental detector for detecting environmental data indicating the location
of the device in the gut and/or the presence of diseased tissue;
a communication system for transmitting the environmental data to an external receiver
and for receiving a signal from an external transmitter; and
an actuator which controls the transition of the release mechanism from the closed
to the open state in response to the signal.
[0049] Disclosed herein is a system comprising:
an ingestible device loaded with a therapeutically effective amount of a S 1P modulator,
a release mechanism for release of the S 1P modulator (e.g., from a reservoir comprising
the S 1P modulator), an actuator controlling the release mechanism, an environmental
sensor for determining the location of the device in the gut and a communication system
adapted to transmit the environment data and receive a signal triggering the actuator;
a receiver and display module for receiving and displaying outside of the body the
environment data from the ingestible device;
a transmitter for sending to the ingestible device a signal triggering the actuator.
[0050] In any of the above disclosures, disease of the GI tract may be an inflammatory bowel
disease.
[0051] In some embodiments, the disease of the GI tract is ulcerative colitis.
[0052] In some embodiments, the disease of the GI tract is Crohn's disease.
[0053] In general, apparatuses, compositions, and methods disclosed herein are useful in
the treatment of diseases of the gastrointestinal tract. Exemplary gastrointestinal
tract diseases that can be treated include, without limitation, inflammatory bowel
disease (IBD), Crohn's disease (e.g., active Crohn's disease, refractory Crohn's disease,
or fistulizing Crohn's disease), ulcerative colitis, indeterminate colitis, microscopic
colitis, infectious colitis, drug or chemical-induced colitis, diverticulitis, and
ischemic colitis, gastritis, peptic ulcers, stress ulcers, bleeding ulcers, gastric
hyperacidity, dyspepsia, gastroparesis, Zollinger-Ellison syndrome, gastroesophageal
reflux disease, short-bowel (anastomosis) syndrome, a hypersecretory state associated
with systemic mastocytosis or basophilic leukemia or hyperhistaminemia, Celiac disease
(e.g., nontropical Sprue), enteropathy associated with seronegative arthropathies,
microscopic colitis, collagenous colitis, eosinophilic gastroenteritis, colitis associated
with radiotherapy or chemotherapy, colitis associated with disorders of innate immunity
as in leukocyte adhesion deficiency-1, chronic granulomatous disease, food allergies,
gastritis, infectious gastritis or enterocolitis (e.g., Helicobacter pylori-infected
chronic active gastritis), other forms of gastrointestinal inflammation caused by
an infectious agent, pseudomembranous colitis, hemorrhagic colitis, hemolytic-uremic
syndrome colitis, diversion colitis, irritable bowel syndrome, irritable colon syndrome,
and pouchitis.
[0054] In some embodiments, apparatuses, compositions, and methods disclosed herein are
for use to treat one gastrointestinal disease. In some embodiments, apparatuses, compositions,
and methods disclosed herein are for use to treat more than one gastrointestinal disease.
In some embodiments, apparatuses, compositions, and methods disclosed herein are for
use to treat multiple gastrointestinal diseases that occur in the same area of the
gastrointestinal tract (the colon, or any sub-region thereof). In some disclosures,
apparatuses, compositions, and methods disclosed herein are used to treat multiple
gastrointestinal diseases that occur in different areas of the gastrointestinal tract.
In some aspects of the disclosures, administration (e.g., local administration to
the gastrointestinal tract) of a S 1P modulator is useful in the treatment of gastrointestinal
diseases including, but not limited to, inflammatory bowel disease (IBD), ulcerative
colitis, Crohn's disease, or any of the other gastrointestinal diseases described
herein.
[0055] The features described herein are intended to be freely combinable. For example,
any details described herein for methods of treatment apply equally to a S 1P modulator,
composition or ingestible device for use in said treatment. Any details described
for a device apply equally to methods of treatment using the device, or to a S 1P
modulator or composition for use in a method of treatment involving the device.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0056]
FIG. 1 is a view of an example ingestible device, in accordance with some parts of
the disclosure;
FIG. 2 is an exploded view of the ingestible device of FIG. 1, in accordance with
some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 3 is a diagram of an ingestible device during an example transit through a GI
tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 4 is a diagram of an ingestible device during an example transit through a jejunum,
in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 5 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for determining a location of an ingestible
device as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 6 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting transitions from a stomach
to a duodenum and from a duodenum back to a stomach, which may be used when determining
a location of an ingestible device as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance
with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 7 is a plot illustrating data collected during an example operation of an ingestible
device, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device as it
transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 8 is another plot illustrating data collected during an example operation of
an ingestible device, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible
device as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 9 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting a transition from a duodenum
to a jejunum, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device
as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 10 is a plot illustrating data collected during an example operation of an ingestible
device, which may be used when detecting a transition from a duodenum to a jejunum,
in accordance with some parts of the disclosure;
FIG. 11 is a plot illustrating muscle contractions detected by an ingestible device
over time, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device as
it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 12 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting a transition from a jejunum
to an ileum, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device
as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 13 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting a transition from a jejunum
to an ileum, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device
as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 14 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting a transition from an ileum
to a cecum, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device
as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 15 is a flowchart of illustrative steps for detecting a transition from a cecum
to a colon, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device
as it transits through a GI tract, in accordance with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 16 illustrates an ingestible device for delivering a substance in the GI tract.
FIG. 17 illustrates aspects of a mechanism for an ingestible device with a gas generating
cell configured to generate a gas to dispense a substance;
FIG. 18 illustrates an ingestible device having a piston to push for drug delivery.
FIG. 19 illustrates an ingestible device having a bellow structure for a storage reservoir
of dispensable substances.
FIG. 20 illustrates an ingestible device having a flexible diaphragm to deform for
drug delivery;
FIG. 21 shows an illustrative part of an ingestible device with multiple openings
in the housing.
FIG. 22 shows a highly cross-section of an ingestible device including a valve system
and a sampling system.
FIG. 23 illustrates a valve system;
FIGs. 24A and 24B illustrate a portion of a two-stage valve system in its first and
second stages, respectively.
FIGs. 25A and 25B illustrate a portion of a two-stage valve system in its first and
second stages, respectively.
FIGs. 26A and 26B illustrate a portion of a two-stage valve system in its first and
second stages, respectively.
FIG. 27 illustrates a more detailed view of an ingestible device including a valve
system and a sampling system.
FIG. 28 illustrates a portion of an ingestible device including a sampling system
and a two-stage valve system in its second stage. and
FIG. 29 is a highly schematic illustrate of an ingestible device.
FIG. 30 is a graph showing the percentage (%) change in body weight at day 14 (± SEM)
for DSS mice treated with anti-IL-12 p40 antibody intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg) every
third day (Q3D) or intracecally (10 mg/kg or 1 mg/kg) daily (QD), when compared to
mice treated with anti-IL-12 p40 antibody intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg) every third
day (Q3D) and vehicle control (Vehicle). Mann-Whitney's U¬- test and Student's t-test
were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively.
A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 31 is a graph showing the concentration of anti-IL-12 p40 rat IgG2A (µg/mL) in
plasma of anti-IL-12 p40 intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg) and intracecally (10 mg/kg and
1 mg/kg) administered treatment groups given daily (QD) or every third day (Q3D) when
compared to vehicle control (Vehicle) and when IP is compared to IC. ELISA analysis
was used to determine the concentration of anti-IL-12 p40 (IgG2A). Data presented
as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U¬- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical
analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered
significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 32 is a graph showing the concentration of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody (IgG2A) (µg/mL)
in the cecum and colon content of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg)
and intracecally (10 mg/kg and 1 mg/kg) administered treatment groups given daily
(QD) or every third day (Q3D), when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle) and when
IP is compared to IC. ELISA analysis was used to determine the concentration of rat
IgG2A. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were
used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively. A value
of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 33 is a graph showing the mean overall tissue immunolabel scores (intensity and
extent) in acute DSS colitis mouse colon of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody intracecally-treated
versus vehicle control-treated DSS mice. Data presented as mean ± SEM.
FIG. 34 is a graph showing the mean location-specific immunolabel scores in acute
DSS colitis mouse colon of anti-IL-12 p40 intracecally-treated versus vehicle control-treated
DSS mice. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test
were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively.
A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 35 is a graph showing the ratio of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody in the colon tissue
to the plasma concentration of the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody in mice treated with the
anti-IL-12 p40 antibody on day 0 (Q0) or day 3 (Q3D) of the study, when measured at
the same time point after the initial dosing. An outlier animal was removed from Group
5.
FIG. 36 is a graph showing the concentration of Il-1β (µg/mL) in colon tissue lysate
of acute DSS colitis mice treated with anti-IL-12 p40 intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg)
every third day (Q3D) or intracecally (10 mg/kg or 1 mg/kg) administered daily (QD),
when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle). Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's
U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 37 is a graph showing the concentration of IL-6 (µg/mL) in colon tissue lysate
of acute DSS colitis mice treated with anti-IL-12 p40 intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg)
every third day (Q3D) or intracecally (10 mg/kg or 1 mg/kg) administered daily (QD),
when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle). Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's
U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.
FIG. 38 is a graph showing the concentration of Il-17A (µg/mL) in colon tissue lysate
of acute DSS colitis mice treated with anti-IL-12 p40 intraperitoneally (10 mg/kg)
every third day (Q3D) or intracecally (10 mg/kg and 1 mg/kg) administered daily (QD),
when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle). Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's
U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 39 is a graph showing the percentage (%) change in body weight at day 14 (± SEM)
for DSS mice treated with DATK32 (anti-α4ϑ7) antibody intraperitoneally (25 mg/kg)
every third day (Q3D) or intracecally (25 mg/kg or 5 mg/kg) administered daily (QD),
when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle) and when IC is compared to IP. Data presented
as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical
analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 40 is a graph showing the plasma concentration of DATK32 rat IgG2A (µg/mL) of
intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) and intracecally (25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg) administered treatment
groups given daily (QD) or every third day (Q3D), where IP is compared to IC. Data
presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for
statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 41 is a graph showing the concentration of DATK32 rat IgG2A antibody (µg/mL)
in cecum and colon content of intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) or intracecally (25 mg/kg
and 5 mg/kg) administered treatment groups given daily (QD) or every third day (Q3D),
where IP is compared to IC. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 42 is a graph showing the concentration of DATK32 rat IgG2A (µg/mL) in the colon
content of intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) or intracecally (25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg) administered
treatment groups given daily (QD), and concentration over time (1, 2 ,4, 24, and 48
hours), where IP is compared to IC. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p<0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 43 is a graph showing the concentration of DATK32 rat IgG2A (µg/g) in colon tissue
of intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) or intracecally (25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg) administered
treatment groups given daily (QD) or every third day (Q3D), where IP is compared to
IC. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p<0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 44 is a graph showing the concentration of DATK32 rat IgG2A (µg/g) in the colon
tissue of intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) or intracecally (25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg) administered
treatment groups given daily (QD), and the concentration over time (1, 2, 4, 24, and
48 hours) was determined, where IP is compared to IC. Data presented as mean ± SEM.
Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value ofp < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad
Software, Inc.).
FIG. 45 is a graph showing the mean overall tissue immunolabel scores (intensity and
extent) in acute DSS colitis mouse colon of DATK32 (anti-α4β7 antibody treated versus
vehicle control (Vehicle) treated DSS mice. The data are presented as mean ± SEM.
FIG. 46 is a graph showing the mean location-specific immunolabel scores in acute
DSS colitis mouse colon of DATK32 (anti-α4β7 antibody-treated versus vehicle control
(Vehicle)-treated DSS mice. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 47 is a graph showing the ratio of the DATK-32 antibody in the colon tissue to
the plasma concentration of the DATK-32 antibody in mice treated with the DATK-32
antibody on day 0 (Q0) or day 3 (Q3D) of the study (Groups 9-12), when measured after
initial dosing.
FIG. 48 is a graph showing the mean percentage of Th memory cells (mean ± SEM) in
blood for DATK32 (anti-α4β7 antibody intraperitoneally (25mg/kg) or intracecally (25
mg/kg or 5 mg/kg) administered treatment groups given daily (QD) or every third day
(Q3D), when compared to vehicle control (Vehicle) and when IP is compared to IC. Mean
percentage Th memory cells were measured using FACS analysis. Data presented as mean
± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 49 is an exemplary image of a histological section of a distal transverse colon
of Animal 1501 showing no significant lesions (i.e., normal colon).
FIG. 50 is an exemplary image of a histological section of a distal transverse colon
of Animal 2501 (treated with TNBS) showing areas of necrosis and inflammation.
FIG. 51 is a representative graph of plasma adalimumab concentrations over time following
a single subcutaneous (SQ) or topical administration of adalimumab. The plasma concentrations
of adalimumab were determined 6, 12, 24, and 48 hours after administration of adalimumab.
N/D = not detectable.
FIG. 52 is a representative table of the plasma adalimumab concentrations (µg/mL)
as shown in Figure 4-6.
FIG. 53 is a graph showing the concentration of TNFα (pg/mL per mg of total protein)
in non-inflamed and inflamed colon tissue after intracecal administration of adalimumab,
as measured 6, 12, 24, and 24 hours after the initial dosing.
FIG. 54 is a graph showing the concentration of TNFα (pg/mL per mg of total protein)
in colon tissue after subcutaneous or intracecal (topical) administration of adalimumab,
as measured 48 hours after the initial dosing.
FIG. 55 is a graph showing the percentage (%) change in body weight at day 14 (± SEM)
in acute DSS colitis mice treated with cyclosporine A orally (10 mg/kg) every third
day (Q3D) or intracecally (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) daily (QD), when compared to vehicle
control (Vehicle). Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's
t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and Gaussian data respectively.
A value of p <0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 56 is a graph showing the plasma cyclosporine A (CsA) (ng/mL) concentration over
time (1 h, 2 h, 4 h, and 24 h) in acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with orally
(PO) (10 mg/kg) or intracecally (IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA. Data
presented as mean ± SEM.
FIG. 57 is a graph showing the colon tissue cyclosporine A (CsA) (ng/g) concentration
over time (1 h, 2 h ,4 h and 24 h) in acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with
orally (PO) (10 mg/kg) or intracecally (IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA.
Data presented as mean ± SEM.
FIG. 58 is a graph showing the peak colon tissue cyclosporine A (CsA) (ng/g) concentration
in acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with orally (PO) (10 mg/kg) or intracecally
(IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA. Data presented as mean ± SEM.
FIG. 59 is a graph showing the trough tissue concentration of cyclosporine (CsA) (ng/g)
in colon of acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with orally (PO) (10 mg/kg)
or intracecally (IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA. Data presented as mean
± SEM.
FIG. 60 is a graph showing the interleukin-2 (Il-2) concentration (µg/mL) in colon
tissue of acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with orally (PO) (10 mg/kg) or
intracecally (IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA, where PO is compared to
IC. Data presented as mean ± SEM. Mann-Whitney's U- test and Student's t-test were used for statistical analysis on non-Gaussian and
Gaussian data respectively. A value of p < 0.05 was considered significant (Graph Pad Software, Inc.).
FIG. 61 is a graph showing the interleukin-6 (Il-6) concentration (µg/mL) in colon
tissue of acute DSS colitis mice treated daily (QD) with orally (PO) (10 mg/kg) or
intracecally (IC) (10 mg/kg or 3 mg/kg) administered CsA. Data presented as mean ±
SEM.
FIG. 62 illustrates a nonlimiting example of a system for collecting, communicating
and/or analyzing data about a subject, using an ingestible device.
FIGs. 63A-63F are graphs showing rat IgG2A concentration as measured in (A) colon
homogenate, (B) mLN homogenate, (C) small intestine homogenate, (D) cecum contents,
(E) colon contents, and (F) plasma by ELISA. Standards were prepared with plasma matrix.
Samples were diluted 1:50 before analysis. Sample 20 was removed from cecum contents
analysis graph (outlier). ∗p<0.05; ∗∗p<0.01; ∗∗∗∗p<0.001 were determined using the unpaired t test.
FIG. 64 illustrates a tapered silicon bellows.
FIG. 65 illustrates a tapered silicone bellows in the simulated device jig.
FIG. 66 illustrates a smooth PVC bellows.
FIG. 67 illustrates a smooth PVC bellows in the simulated device jig.
FIG. 68 demonstrates a principle of a competition assay performed in an experiment.
FIG. 69 shows AlphaLISA data.
FIG. 70 shows AlphaLISA data.
FIG. 71 shows AlphaLISA data.
FIG. 72 is a flowchart of illustrative steps of a clinical protocol, in accordance
with some parts of the disclosure.
FIG. 73 is a graph showing the level of FAM-SMAD7-AS oligonucleotide in the cecum
tissue of DSS-induced colitis mice at 12-hours. The bars represent from left to right,
Groups 2 through 5 in the experiment described in Example 9.
FIG. 74 is a graph showing the level of FAM-SMAD7-AS oligonucleotide in the colon
tissue of DSS-induced colitis mice at 12-hours. The bars represent from left to right,
Groups 2 through 5 in the experiment described in Example 9.
FIG. 75 is a graph showing the level of FAM-SMAD7-AS oligonucleotide in the cecum
contents of DSS-induced colitis mice at 12-hours. The bars represent from left to
right, Groups 2 through 5 in the experiment described in Example 9.
FIG. 76 is a graph showing the mean concentration of tacrolimus in the cecum tissue
and the proximal colon tissue 12 hours after intracecal or oral administration of
tacrolimus to swine as described in Example 10.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0057] The present disclosure is directed to various methods and formulations for treating
diseases of the gastrointestinal tract with a S1P modulator. For example, a method
of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract in a subject comprises administering
to the subject a pharmaceutical formulation comprising a S1P modulator wherein the
pharmaceutical formulation is released in the subject's cecum. For example, the pharmaceutical
formulation comprises a therapeutically effective amount of a S 1P modulator.
[0058] The formulation is contained in an ingestible device, and the device releases the
formulation in the cecum. The location of the site of disease may be predetermined.
The release of the formulation may be triggered autonomously, as further described
herein.
[0059] The following disclosure illustrates aspects of the formulations and methods embodied
in the claims.
Formulations, including Pharmaceutical Formulations
[0060] As used herein, a "formulation" of a S1P modulator may refer to either the S1P modulator
in pure form, such as, for example, a lyophilized S 1P modulator, or a mixture of
the S 1P modulator with one or more physiologically acceptable carriers, excipients
or stabilizers. Thus, therapeutic formulations or medicaments can be prepared by mixing
the S 1P modulator having the desired degree of purity with optional physiologically
acceptable carriers, excipients or stabilizers (
Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980)), in the form of lyophilized formulations or aqueous solutions. Acceptable carriers,
excipients, or stabilizers are nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations
employed, and include buffers such as phosphate, citrate, and other organic acids;
antioxidants including ascorbic acid and methionine; preservatives (such as octadecyldimethylbenzyl
ammonium chloride; hexamethonium chloride; benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride;
phenol, butyl or benzyl alcohol; alkyl parabens such as methyl or propyl paraben;
catechol; resorcinol; cyclohexanol; 3-pentanol; and m-cresol); low molecular weight
(less than about 10 residues) antibody; proteins, such as serum albumin, gelatin,
or immunoglobulins; hydrophilic polymers such as polyvinylpyrrolidone; amino acids
such as glycine, glutamine, asparagine, histidine, arginine, or lysine; monosaccharides,
disaccharides, and other carbohydrates including glucose, mannose, or dextrins; chelating
agents such as EDTA; sugars such as sucrose, mannitol, trehalose or sorbitol; salt-
forming counter-ions such as sodium; metal complexes (e.g., Zn- protein complexes);
and/or non-ionic surfactants such as TWEEN
™, PLURONICS
™ or polyethylene glycol (PEG). Exemplary pharmaceutically acceptable carriers herein
further include interstitial drug dispersion agents such as soluble neutral-active
hyaluronidase glycoproteins (sHASEGP), for example, human soluble PH-20 hyaluronidase
glycoproteins, such as rHuPH20 (HYLENEX
®, Baxter International, Inc.). Certain exemplary sHASEGPs and methods of use, including
rHuPH20, are described in
US Patent Publication Nos. 2005/0260186 and
2006/0104968. In one aspect, a sHASEGP is combined with one or more additional glycosaminoglycanases
such as chondroitinases. Exemplary lyophilized formulations are described in
US Patent No. 6,267,958. Aqueous formulations include those described in
US Patent No. 6,171,586 and
WO2006/044908, the latter formulations including a histidine-acetate buffer.
[0061] A formulation of a S1P modulator as disclosed herein, e.g., sustained-release formulations,
can further include a mucoadhesive agent, e.g., one or more of polyvinyl pyrrolidine,
methyl cellulose, sodium carboxyl methyl cellulose, hydroxyl propyl cellulose, carbopol,
a polyacrylate, chitosan, a eudragit analogue, a polymer, and a thiomer. Additional
examples of mucoadhesive agents that can be included in a formulation with a S1P modulator
are described in, e.g.,
Peppas et al., Biomaterials 17(16): 1553-1561, 1996;
Kharenko et al., Pharmaceutical Chemistry J. 43(4):200-208, 2009;
Salamat-Miller et al., Adv. Drug Deliv. Reviews 57(11):1666-1691, 2005;
Bernkop-Schnurch, Adv. Drug Deliv. Rev. 57(11):1569-1582, 2005; and
Harding et al., Biotechnol. Genet. Eng. News 16(1):41-86, 1999.
[0062] In some embodiments, components of a formulation may include any one of the following
components, or any combination thereof:
Acacia, Alginate, Alginic Acid, Aluminum Acetate, an antiseptic, Benzyl Alcohol, Butyl
Paraben, Butylated Hydroxy Toluene, an antioxidant, Citric acid, Calcium carbonate,
Candelilla wax, a binder, Croscarmellose sodium, Confectioner sugar, Colloidal silicone
dioxide, Cellulose, Carnuba wax, Corn starch, Carboxymethylcellulose calcium, Calcium
stearate, Calcium disodium EDTA, Chelation agents, Copolyvidone, Castor oil hydrogenated,
Calcium hydrogen phosphate dehydrate, Cetylpyridine chloride, Cysteine HCl, Crosspovidone,
Dibasic Calcium Phosphate, Disodium hydrogen phosphate, Dimethicone, Erythrosine Sodium,
Ethyl Cellulose, Gelatin, Glyceryl monooleate, Glycerin, Glycine, Glyceryl monostearate,
Glyceryl behenate, Hydroxy propyl cellulose, Hydroxyl propyl methyl cellulose, Hypromellose,
HPMC phthalate, Iron oxides or ferric oxide, Iron oxide yellow, Iron oxide red or
ferric oxide, Lactose (hydrous or anhydrous or monohydrate or spray dried), Magnesium
stearate, Microcrystalline cellulose, Mannitol, Methyl cellulose,, Magnesium carbonate,
Mineral oil, Methacrylic acid copolymer, Magnesium oxide, Methyl paraben, PEG, Polysorbate
80, Propylene glycol, Polyethylene oxide, Propylene paraben, poloxamer 407 or 188
or plain, Potassium bicarbonate, Potassium sorbate, Potato starch, Phosphoric acid,
Polyoxy140 stearate, Sodium starch glycolate, Starch pregelatinized, Sodium crossmellose,
Sodium lauryl sulfate, Starch, Silicon dioxide, Sodium benzoate,, Stearic acid, Sucrose
base for medicated confectionery, a granulating agent, Sorbic acid, Sodium carbonate,
Saccharin sodium, Sodium alginate, Silica gel, Sorbiton monooleate, Sodium stearyl
fumarate, Sodium chloride, Sodium metabisulfite, Sodium citrate dehydrate, Sodium
starch, Sodium carboxy methyl cellulose, Succinic acid, Sodium propionate, Titanium
dioxide, Talc, Triacetin, Triethyl citrate.
[0063] Accordingly, in some examples of the method of treating a disease , the method comprises
administering to the subject a pharmaceutical composition that is a formulation as
disclosed herein. In some cases the formulation is a dosage form, which may be, as
an example, a solid form such as, for example, a capsule, a tablet, a sachet, or a
lozenge; or which may be, as an example, a liquid form such as, for example, a solution,
a suspension, an emulsion, or a syrup.
[0064] In some embodiments, the formulation is comprised in an ingestible device as defined
in claim 1. In some embodiments, the formulation may be suitable for oral administration.
The formulation may be, for example, a solid dosage form or a liquid dosage form as
disclosed herein. In some embodiments the formulation is suitable for introduction
and optionally for storage in the device. In some embodiments the formulation is suitable
for introduction and optionally for storage in a reservoir comprised in the device.
In some embodiments the formulation is suitable for introduction and optionally for
storage in a reservoir comprised in the device. Thus, provided herein is a reservoir
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P modulator, wherein the reservoir
is configured to fit into an ingestible device. In some disclosures, the reservoir
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P modulator is attachable to
an ingestible device.
[0065] In some cases the formulation is suitable for introduction in a spray catheter, as
disclosed herein.
[0066] The formulation herein may also contain more than one active compound as necessary
for the particular indication being treated, for example, those with complementary
activities that do not adversely affect each other. For instance, the formulation
may further comprise another S1P modulator or a chemotherapeutic agent. Such molecules
are suitably present in combination in amounts that are effective for the purpose
intended.
[0067] The active ingredients may also be entrapped in microcapsules prepared, for example,
by coacervation techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example, hydroxymethylcellulose
or gelatin-microcapsule and poly-(methylmethacrylate) microcapsule, respectively,
in colloidal drug delivery systems (for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres,
microemulsions, nanoparticles and nanocapsules) or in macroemulsions. Such techniques
are disclosed in
Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980).
[0068] The formulations to be used for in vivo administration must be sterile. This is readily
accomplished by filtration through sterile filtration membranes.
[0069] Sustained-release preparations may be prepared. Suitable examples of sustained- release
preparations include semipermeable matrices of solid hydrophobic polymers containing
the S1P modulator, which matrices are in the form of shaped articles, e.g., films,
or microcapsule. Examples of sustained-release matrices include polyesters, hydrogels
(for example, poly(2-hydroxyethyl-methacrylate), or poly(vinylalcohol)), polylactides
(
U.S. Pat. No. 3,773,919), copolymers of L-glutamic acid and γ ethyl-L-glutamate, non-degradable ethylene-vinyl
acetate, degradable lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymers such as the LUPRON DEPOT
™ (injectable microspheres composed of lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymer and leuprolide
acetate), and poly-D-(-)-3-hydroxybutyric acid. While polymers such as ethylene-vinyl
acetate and lactic acid-glycolic acid enable release of molecules for over 100 days,
certain hydrogels release proteins for shorter time periods. When encapsulated S1P
modulator remain in the body for a long time, they may denature or aggregate as a
result of exposure to moisture at 37°C, resulting in a loss of biological activity
and possible changes in immunogenicity. Rational strategies can be devised for stabilization
depending on the mechanism involved. For example, if the aggregation mechanism is
discovered to be intermolecular S-S bond formation through thio-disulfide interchange,
stabilization may be achieved by modifying sulfhydryl residues, lyophilizing from
acidic solutions, controlling moisture content, using appropriate additives, and developing
specific polymer matrix compositions.
[0070] Pharmaceutical formulations may contain one or more S1P modulator. The pharmaceutical
formulations may be formulated in any manner known in the art. In some cases the formulations
include one or more of the following components: a sterile diluent (e.g., sterile
water or saline), a fixed oil, polyethylene glycol, glycerin, propylene glycol, or
other synthetic solvents, antibacterial or antifungal agents, such as benzyl alcohol
or methyl parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, ascorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like,
antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid or sodium bisulfite, chelating agents, such as
ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid, buffers, such as acetates, citrates, or phosphates,
and isotonic agents, such as sugars (e.g., dextrose), polyalcohols (e.g., mannitol
or sorbitol), or salts (e.g., sodium chloride), or any combination thereof. Liposomal
suspensions can also be used as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers (see, e.g.,
U.S. Patent No. 4,522,811). The formulations can be formulated and enclosed in ampules, disposable syringes,
or multiple dose vials. Where required, proper fluidity can be maintained by, for
example, the use of a coating, such as lecithin, or a surfactant. Controlled release
of the S1P modulator can be achieved by implants and microencapsulated delivery systems,
which can include biodegradable, biocompatible polymers (e.g., ethylene vinyl acetate,
polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid;
Alza Corporation and Nova Pharmaceutical, Inc.).
[0071] In some embodiments, the S 1P modulator is present in a pharmaceutical formulation
within the device.
[0072] In some embodiments, the S 1P modulator is present in solution within the device.
[0073] In some embodiments, the S 1P modulator is present in a suspension in a liquid medium
within the device.
[0074] In some embodiments, the S 1P modulator is present as a pure, powder (e.g., lyophilized)
form of the S 1P modulator.
[0075] In some cases, data obtained from cell culture assays and animal studies can be used
in formulating an appropriate dosage of any given S 1P modulator. The effectiveness
and dosing of any S 1P modulator can be determined by a health care professional or
veterinary professional using methods known in the art, as well as by the observation
of one or more disease symptoms in a subject (e.g., a human). Certain factors may
influence the dosage and timing required to effectively treat a subject (e.g., the
severity of the disease or disorder, previous treatments, the general health and/or
age of the subject, and the presence of other diseases).
[0076] In one embodiment, the formulation comprises a small molecule drug. In one embodiment,
the small molecule drug formulation is provided as a solution. In one embodiment,
the small molecule drug formulation is provided as a solid. In one embodiment, the
small molecule drug formulation is provided as a dispersion formulation. In one embodiment,
the formulation is provided as a suspension. In some aspects, the suspension formulation
comprises the drug suspended via a suspending agent in an aqueous media, such as an
aqueous buffer. In one embodiment, the formulation is provided as an emulsion.
[0077] In some aspects, the S 1P modulator is administered in combination with a second
agent, wherein the second agent is an antibody or other therapeutic protein. An antibody
or other therapeutic protein can be formulated in a solution (e.g., aqueous formulation),
dry formulation (e.g., lyophilized solid formulation), microemulsion, nanoemulsion,
solid composition, semisolid composition, dispersion, liposome, or a particulate composition
containing a micro- or nanoencapsulated antibody or other therapeutic protein. In
some embodiments, the present disclosure provides a formulation comprising a polyol.
In some embodiments, a formulation can include any desired free amino acid, a salt
thereof, or a combination thereof, which can be in the L-form, the D-form or any desired
mixture of these forms.
[0078] In some embodiments, a formulation may contain a surfactant. In some embodiments,
the formulation comprises at least one bile salt. In some embodiments, the formulation
comprises at least one adhesive agent, such as a mucoadhesive agent, wherein the adhesive
agent is optionally a thermoreversible adhesive agent.A formulation described herein
may include any antibody or fragment thereof, or other therapeutic protein (e.g.,
a recombinant protein, therapeutic enzyme, etc.). In some embodiments, an antibody
or other therapeutic protein is crystalline.
Definitions:
[0079] By "ingestible", it is meant that the device can be swallowed whole.
[0080] "Gastrointestinal inflammatory disorders" are a group of chronic disorders that cause
inflammation and/or ulceration in the mucous membrane. These disorders include, for
example, inflammatory bowel disease (e.g., Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, indeterminate
colitis and infectious colitis), mucositis (e.g., oral mucositis, gastrointestinal
mucositis, nasal mucositis and proctitis), necrotizing enterocolitis and esophagitis.
[0081] "Inflammatory Bowel Disease" or "IBD" is a chronic inflammatory autoimmune condition
of the gastrointestinal (GI) tract. The GI tract can be divided into four main different
sections, the oesophagus, stomach, small intestine and large intestine or colon. The
small intestine possesses three main subcompartments: the duodenum, jejunum and ileum.
Similarly, the large intestine consists of six sections: the cecum, ascending colon,
transverse colon, ascending colon, sigmoid colon, and the rectum. The small intestine
is about 6 m long, its diameter is 2.5 to 3 cm and the transit time through it is
typically 3 hours. The duodenum has a C-shape, and is 30 cm long. Due to its direct
connection with the stomach, it is physically more stable than the jejunum and ileum,
which are sections that can freely move. The jejunum is 2.4 m in length and the ileum
is 3.6 m in length and their surface areas are 180 m
2 and 280 m
2 respectively. The large intestine is 1.5 m long, its diameter is between 6.3 and
6.5 cm, the transit time though this section is 20 hours and has a reduced surface
area of approximately 150 m
2. The higher surface area of the small intestine enhances its capacity for systemic
drug absorption.
[0082] The etiology of IBD is complex, and many aspects of the pathogenesis remain unclear.
The treatment of moderate to severe IBD poses significant challenges to treating physicians,
because conventional therapy with corticosteroids and immunomodulator therapy (e.g.,
azathioprine, 6 mercaptopurine, and methotrexate administered via traditional routes
such as tablet form, oral suspension, or intravenously) is associated with side effects
and intolerance and has not shown proven benefit in maintenance therapy (steroids).
Monoclonal antibodies targeting tumor necrosis factor alpha (TNF-a), such as infliximab
(a chimeric antibody) and adalimumab (a fully human antibody), are currently used
in the management of CD. Infliximab has also shown efficacy and has been approved
for use in UC. However, approximately 10%-20% of patients with CD are primary nonresponders
to anti TNF therapy, and another ~20%-30% of CD patients lose response over time (
Schnitzler et al., Gut 58:492-500 (2009)). Other adverse events (AEs) associated with anti TNFs include elevated rates of
bacterial infection, including tuberculosis, and, more rarely, lymphoma and demyelination
(
Chang et al., Nat Clin Pract Gastroenterol Hepatology 3:220 (2006);
Hoentjen et al., World J. Gastroenterol. 15(17):2067 (2009)). No currently available therapy achieves sustained remission in more than 20%-30%
of IBD patients with chronic disease (
Hanauer et al, Lancet 359: 1541-49 (2002);
Sandborn et al, N Engl J Med 353: 1912-25 (2005)). In addition, most patients do not achieve sustained steroid-free remission and
mucosal healing, clinical outcomes that correlate with true disease modification.
[0083] Although the cause of IBD remains unknown, several factors such as genetic, infectious
and immunologic susceptibility have been implicated. IBD is much more common in Caucasians,
especially those of Jewish descent. The chronic inflammatory nature of the condition
has prompted an intense search for a possible infectious cause. Although agents have
been found which stimulate acute inflammation, none has been found to cause the chronic
inflammation associated with IBD. The hypothesis that IBD is an autoimmune disease
is supported by the previously mentioned extraintestinal manifestation of IBD as joint
arthritis, and the known positive response to IBD by treatment with therapeutic agents
such as adrenal glucocorticoids, cyclosporine and azathioprine, which are known to
suppress immune response. In addition, the GI tract, more than any other organ of
the body, is continuously exposed to potential antigenic substances such as proteins
from food, bacterial byproducts (LPS), etc.
[0084] A chronic inflammatory autoimmune condition of the gastrointestinal (GI) tract presents
clinically as either ulcerative colitis (UC) or Crohn's disease (CD). Both IBD conditions
are associated with an increased risk for malignancy of the GI tract.
[0085] "Crohn's disease" ("CD") is a chronic transmural inflammatory disease with the potential
to affect any part of the entire GI tract, and UC is a mucosal inflammation of the
colon. Both conditions are characterized clinically by frequent bowel motions, malnutrition,
and dehydration, with disruption in the activities of daily living.
[0086] CD is frequently complicated by the development of malabsorption, strictures, and
fistulae and may require repeated surgery. UC, less frequently, may be complicated
by severe bloody diarrhea and toxic megacolon, also requiring surgery. The most prominent
feature Crohn's disease is the granular, reddish-purple edematous thickening of the
bowel wall. With the development of inflammation, these granulomas often lose their
circumscribed borders and integrate with the surrounding tissue. Diarrhea and obstruction
of the bowel are the predominant clinical features. As with ulcerative colitis, the
course of Crohn's disease may be continuous or relapsing, mild or severe, but unlike
ulcerative colitis, Crohn's disease is not curable by resection of the involved segment
of bowel. Most patients with Crohn's disease require surgery at some point, but subsequent
relapse is common and continuous medical treatment is usual. Crohn's disease may involve
any part of the alimentary tract from the mouth to the anus, although typically it
appears in the ileocolic, small-intestinal or colonic-anorectal regions. Histopathologically,
the disease manifests by discontinuous granulomatomas, crypt abscesses, fissures and
aphthous ulcers. The inflammatory infiltrate is mixed, consisting of lymphocytes (both
T and B cells), plasma cells, macrophages, and neutrophils. There is a disproportionate
increase in IgM- and IgG-secreting plasma cells, macrophages and neutrophils.
[0087] To date, the primary outcome measure in Crohn's Disease clinical trials is the Crohn's
Disease Activity Index (CDAI), which has served as the basis for approval of multiple
drug treatments, including for example, vedolizumab and natalizumab. The CDAI was
developed by regressing clinician global assessment of disease activity on eighteen
potential items representing patient reported outcomes (PROs) (i.e. abdominal pain,
pain awakening patient from sleep, appetite), physical signs (i.e. average daily temperature,
abdominal mass), medication use (i.e. loperamide or opiate use for diarrhea) and a
laboratory test (i.e. hematocrit). Backward stepwise regression analysis identified
eight independent predictors which are the number of liquid or soft stools, severity
of abdominal pain, general well-being, occurrence of extra-intestinal symptoms, need
for anti-diarrheal drugs, presence of an abdominal mass, hematocrit, and body weight.
The final score is a composite of these eight items, adjusted using regression coefficients
and standardization to construct an overall CDAI score, ranging from 0 to 600 with
higher score indicating greater disease activity. Widely used benchmarks are: CDAI
<150 is defined as clinical remission, 150 to 219 is defined as mildly active disease,
220 to 450 is defined as moderately active disease, and above 450 is defined as very
severe disease (
Best WR, et al., Gastroenterology 77:843-6, 1979). Vedolizumab and natalizumab have been approved on the basis of demonstrated clinical
remission, i.e. CDAI < 150.
[0088] Although the CDAI has been in use for over 40 years, and has served as the basis
for drug approval, it has several limitations as an outcome measure for clinical trials.
For example, most of the overall score comes from the patient diary card items (pain,
number of liquid bowel movements, and general well-being), which are vaguely defined
and not standardized terms (
Sandler et al., J. Clin. Epidemiol 41 :451-8, 1988;
Thia et al., Inflamm Bowel Dis 17: 105-11, 2011). In addition, measurement of pain is based on a four-point scale rather than an
updated seven-point scale. The remaining 5 index items contribute very little to identifying
an efficacy signal and may be a source of measurement noise. Furthermore, concerns
have been raised about poor criterion validity for the CDAI, a reported lack of correlation
between the CDAI and endoscopic measures of inflammation (which may render the CDAI
as a poor discriminator of active CD and irritable bowel syndrome) and high reported
placebo rates (
Korzenik et al., N Engl J Med. 352:2193-201, 2005;
Sandborn WJ, et al., N Engl J Med 353 : 1912-25, 2005;
Sandborn WJ, et al., Ann Intern 19; 146:829-38, 2007, Epub 2007 Apr 30;
Kim et al., Gastroenterology 146:(5 supplement 1) S-368, 2014).
[0089] It is, thus, generally recognized that additional or alternative measures of CD symptoms
are needed, such as new PRO tools or adaptations of the CDAI to derive a new PRO.
The PRO2 and PRO3 tools are such adaptations of the CDAI and have been recently described
in
Khanna et al., Aliment Pharmacol. Ther. 41:77-86, 2015. The PRO2 evaluates the frequency of loose/liquid stools and abdominal pain (Id).
These items are derived and weighted accordingly from the CDAI and are the CDAI diary
card items, along with general well-being, that contribute most to the observed clinical
benefit measured by CDAI (
Sandler et al., J. Clin. Epidemiol 41 :451-8, 1988;
Thia et al., Inflamm Bowel Dis 17: 105-11, 2011;
Kim et al., Gastroenterology 146:(5 supplement 1) S-368, 2014). The remission score of <11 is the CDAI-weighted sum of the average stool frequency
and pain scores in a 7-day period, which yielded optimum sensitivity and specificity
for identification of CDAI remission (score of <150) in a retrospective data analysis
of ustekinumab induction treatment for moderate to severe CD in a Phase II clinical
study (
Gasink C, et al., abstract, ACG Annual Meeting 2014). The PRO2 was shown to be sensitive and responsive when used as a continuous outcome
measure in a retrospective data analysis of MTX treatment in active CD (
Khanna R, et al., Inflamm Bowel Dis 20: 1850-61, 2014) measured by CDAI. Additional outcome measures include the Mayo Clinic Score, the
Crohn disease endoscopic index of severity (CDEIS), and the Ulcerative colitis endoscopic
index of severity (UCEIS). Additional outcome measures include Clinical remission,
Mucosal healing, Histological healing (transmural), MRI or ultrasound for measurement
or evaluation of bowel wall thickness, abscesses, fistula and histology.
[0090] An additional means of assessing the extent and severity of Crohn's Disease is endoscopy.
Endoscopic lesions typical of Crohn's disease have been described in numerous studies
and include, e.g., aphthoid ulcerations, "punched-out ulcers," cobblestoning and stenosis.
Endoscopic evaluation of such lesions was used to develop the first validated endoscopic
score, the Crohn's Disease Endoscopic Index of Severity (CDEIS) (
Mary et al., Gut 39:983-9, 1989). More recently, because the CDEIS is time-consuming, complicated and impractical
for routine use, a Simplified Endoscopic Activity Score for Crohn's Disease (SES-
CD) was developed and validated (
Daperno et al., Gastrointest. Endosc. 60(4):505-12, 2004). The SES-CD consists of four endoscopic variables (size of ulcers, proportion of
surface covered by ulcers, proportion of surface with any other lesions (e.g., inflammation),
and presence of narrowings [stenosis]) that are scored in five ileocolonic segments,
with each variable, or assessment, rated from 0 to 3.
[0091] To date, there is no cure for CD. Accordingly, the current treatment goals for CD
are to induce and maintain symptom improvement, induce mucosal healing, avoid surgery,
and improve quality of life (
Lichtenstein GR, et al., Am J Gastroenterol 104:465-83, 2009;
Van Assche G, et al., J Crohns Colitis. 4:63-101, 2010). The current therapy of IBD usually involves the administration of anti-inflammatory
or immunosuppressive agents, such as sulfasalazine, corticosteroids, 6- mercaptopurine/azathioprine,
or cyclosporine, all of which are not typically delivered by localized release of
a drug at the site or location of disease. More recently, biologics like TNF-alpha
inhibitors and IL-12/IL-23 blockers, are used to treat IBD. If anti-inflammatory/immunosuppressive/biologic
therapies fail, colectomies are the last line of defense. The typical operation for
CD not involving the rectum is resection (removal of a diseased segment of bowel)
and anastomosis (reconnection) without an ostomy. Sections of the small or large intestine
may be removed. About 30% of CD patients will need surgery within the first year after
diagnosis. In the subsequent years, the rate is about 5% per year. Unfortunately,
CD is characterized by a high rate of recurrence; about 5% of patients need a second
surgery each year after initial surgery.
[0092] Refining a diagnosis of inflammatory bowel disease involves evaluating the progression
status of the diseases using standard classification criteria. The classification
systems used in IBD include the Truelove and Witts Index (
Truelove S. C. and Witts, L.J. Br Med J. 1955;2: 1041-1048), which classifies colitis as mild, moderate, or severe, as well as Lennard- Jones.
(
Lennard-Jones JE. Scand J Gastroenterol Suppl 1989; 170:2-6) and the simple clinical colitis activity index (SCCAI). (
Walmsley et. al. Gut. 1998;43:29-32) These systems track such variables as daily bowel movements, rectal bleeding, temperature,
heart rate, hemoglobin levels, erythrocyte sedimentation rate, weight, hematocrit
score, and the level of serum albumin.
[0093] There is sufficient overlap in the diagnostic criteria for UC and CD that it is sometimes
impossible to say which a given patient has; however, the type of lesion typically
seen is different, as is the localization. UC mostly appears in the colon, proximal
to the rectum, and the characteristic lesion is a superficial ulcer of the mucosa;
CD can appear anywhere in the bowel, with occasional involvement of stomach, esophagus
and duodenum, and the lesions are usually described as extensive linear fissures.
[0094] In approximately 10-15% of cases, a definitive diagnosis of ulcerative colitis or
Crohn's disease cannot be made and such cases are often referred to as "indeterminate
colitis." Two antibody detection tests are available that can help the diagnosis,
each of which assays for antibodies in the blood. The antibodies are "perinuclear
anti-neutrophil antibody" (pANCA) and "anti-Saccharomyces cervisiae antibody" (ASCA).
Most patients with ulcerative colitis have the pANCA antibody but not the ASCA antibody,
while most patients with Crohn's disease have the ASCA antibody but not the pANCA
antibody. However, these two tests have shortcomings as some patients have neither
antibody and some Crohn's disease patients may have only the pANCA antibody. A third
test, which measures the presence and accumulation of circulating anti-microbial antibodies
- particularly flagellin antibodies, has proven to be useful for detecting susceptibility
to Crohn's Disease before disease development. See
Choung, R. S., et al. "Serologic microbial associated markers can predict Crohn's
disease behaviour years before disease diagnosis." Alimentary pharmacology & therapeutics
43.12 (2016): 1300-1310.
[0095] "Ulcerative colitis (UC)" afflicts the large intestine. The course of the disease
may be continuous or relapsing, mild or severe. The earliest lesion is an inflammatory
infiltration with abscess formation at the base of the crypts of Lieberkuhn. Coalescence
of these distended and ruptured crypts tends to separate the overlying mucosa from
its blood supply, leading to ulceration. Symptoms of the disease include cramping,
lower abdominal pain, rectal bleeding, and frequent, loose discharges consisting mainly
of blood, pus and mucus with scanty fecal particles. A total colectomy may be required
for acute, severe or chronic, unremitting ulcerative colitis.
[0096] The clinical features of UC are highly variable, and the onset may be insidious or
abrupt, and may include diarrhea, tenesmus and relapsing rectal bleeding. With fulminant
involvement of the entire colon, toxic megacolon, a life-threatening emergency, may
occur. Extraintestinal manifestations include arthritis, pyoderma gangrenoum, uveitis,
and erythema nodosum.
[0098] "Treatment regimen" refers to a combination of dosage, frequency of administration,
or duration of treatment, with or without addition of a second medication.
[0099] "Effective treatment regimen" refers to a treatment regimen that will offer beneficial
response to a patient receiving the treatment.
[0100] "Effective amount" refers to an amount of drug that offers beneficial response to
a patient receiving the treatment. For example, an effective amount may be a Human
Equivalent Dose (HED).
[0101] "Dispensable", with reference to any substance, refers to any substance that may
be released from an ingestible device as disclosed herein, or from a component of
the device such as a reservoir. For example, a dispensable substance may be a S 1P
modulator, and/or a formulation comprising a S 1P modulator.
[0102] "Patient response" or "patient responsiveness" can be assessed using any endpoint
indicating a benefit to the patient, including, without limitation, (1) inhibition,
to some extent, of disease progression, including slowing down and complete arrest;
(2) reduction in the number of disease episodes and/or symptoms; (3) reduction in
lesional size; (4) inhibition (i.e., reduction, slowing down or complete stopping)
of disease cell infiltration into adjacent peripheral organs and/or tissues; (5) inhibition
(i.e., reduction, slowing down or complete stopping) of disease spread; (6) decrease
of auto-immune response, which may, but does not have to, result in the regression
or ablation of the disease lesion; (7) relief, to some extent, of one or more symptoms
associated with the disorder; (8) increase in the length of disease-free presentation
following treatment; and/or (9) decreased mortality at a given point of time following
treatment. The term "responsiveness" refers to a measurable response, including complete
response (CR) and partial response (PR).
[0103] As used herein, "complete response" or "CR" means the disappearance of all signs
of inflammation or remission in response to treatment. This does not necessarily mean
the disease has been cured.
[0104] "Partial response" or "PR" refers to a decrease of at least 50% in the severity of
inflammation, in response to treatment.
[0105] A "beneficial response" of a patient to treatment with a therapeutic agent and similar
wording refers to the clinical or therapeutic benefit imparted to a patient at risk
for or suffering from a gastrointestinal inflammatory disorder from or as a result
of the treatment with the agent. Such benefit includes cellular or biological responses,
a complete response, a partial response, a stable disease (without progression or
relapse), or a response with a later relapse of the patient from or as a result of
the treatment with the agent.
[0106] As used herein, "non-response" or "lack of response" or similar wording means an
absence of a complete response, a partial response, or a beneficial response to treatment
with a therapeutic agent.
[0107] "A patient maintains responsiveness to a treatment" when the patient's responsiveness
does not decrease with time during the course of a treatment.
[0108] A "symptom" of a disease or disorder (e.g., inflammatory bowel disease, e.g., ulcerative
colitis or Crohn's disease) is any morbid phenomenon or departure from the normal
in structure, function, or sensation, experienced by a subject and indicative of disease.
S1P Modulators
[0109] The term "S1P modulator" refers to an agent which modulates (reduces or increases)
the activity of one or more sphingosine 1-phosphate receptor(s) (SIPs) (e.g., one
or more of any of sphingosine 1-phosphate receptor 1 (S1P1), sphingosine 1-phosphate
receptor 2 (S1P2), sphingosine 1-phosphate receptor 3 (S1P3), sphingosine 1-phosphate
receptor 4 (S1P4), and sphingosine 1-phosphate receptor 5 (S1P5)) and/or the expression
of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of any of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5),
e.g., as compared to the activity and/or expression of the one or more SIPs (e.g.,
S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and/or S1P5) in the absence of the agent; and/or modulates
(reduces or increases) the level of one or more S1Ps (e.g., S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4,
and/or S1P5) protein in a mammalian cell contacted with the agent, e.g., as compared
to the same mammalian cell not contacted with the agent.
[0110] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a S1P agonist. In some embodiments, a S1P
agonist can result in an increase (e.g., a 1% to a 99% increase, or any of the subranges
of this range described herein) in the levels of sphingosine 1-phosphate in a subject,
e.g., as compared to the level of sphingosine 1-phosphate in a subject not administered
the S1P agonist.
In other embodiments, the S1P modulator is an S1P antagonist. In some embodiments,
a S1P antagonist can result in a decrease (e.g., a 1% to a 99% decrease, or any of
the subranges of this range described herein) in the levels of sphingosine 1-phosphate
in a subject, e.g., as compared to the level of sphingosine 1-phosphate in a subject
not administered the S1P antagonist.
[0111] The term "S1P agonist" refers to an agent which (i) increases at least one activity
of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of any of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5)
in vitro or in a mammalian cell; and/or (ii) increases the level of one or more SIPs
(e.g., one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5) in a mammalian cell. In some
embodiments, a S1P agonist increases (e.g., a 1% increase to a 500% increase) the
downstream signaling activity of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of any of S1P1,
S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5), e.g., as compared to the level of downstream signaling
activity in the absence of the S1P agonist. In some embodiments, a S1P agonist increases
(e.g., a 1% increase to a 500% increase, or any of the subranges of this range described
herein) the level of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4,
and S1P5) (protein or mRNA levels) in a mammalian cell, e.g., as compared to the level
in the absence of the S1P agonist. In some embodiments, a S1P agonist (i) increases
(e.g., a 1% increase to a 500% increase, or any of the subranges of this range described
herein) the downstream signaling activity of one or more S1Ps (e.g., one or more of
any of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5), e.g., as compared to the level of downstream
signaling activity in the absence of the S1P agonist, and (ii) increases (e.g., a
1% increase to a 500% increase, or any of the subranges of this range described herein)
the level of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5)
(protein or mRNA levels) in a mammalian cell, e.g., as compared to the level in the
absence of the S1P agonist.
[0112] The term "S1P antagonist" refers to an agent which decreases the activity of one
or more SIPs (e.g., one or more S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5) and/or the expression
of one or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5).
[0113] In some embodiments, a S1P antagonist decreases (e.g., a 1% decrease to a 99% decrease)
the downstream signaling activity of one or more S1Ps (e.g., one or more of any of
S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5), e.g., as compared to the level of downstream signaling
activity in the absence of the S1P antagonist. In some embodiments, a S1P antagonist
decreases (e.g., a 1% decrease to a 99% decrease, or any of the subranges of this
range described herein) the level of one or more S1Ps (e.g., one or more of S1P1,
S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5) (protein or mRNA levels) in a mammalian cell, e.g., as
compared to the level in the absence of the S1P antagonist. In some embodiments, a
S1P antagonist (i) decreases (e.g., a 1% decrease to a 99% decrease, or any of the
subranges of this range described herein) the downstream signaling activity of one
or more SIPs (e.g., one or more of any of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5), e.g.,
as compared to the level of downstream signaling activity in the absence of the S1P
antagonist, and (ii) decreases (e.g., a 1% decrease to a 500% decrease, or any of
the subranges of this range described herein) the level of one or more SIPs (e.g.,
one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5) (protein or mRNA levels) in a mammalian
cell, e.g., as compared to the level in the absence of the S1P antagonist.
[0114] Exemplary sequences for the protein and cDNA sequences for human S1P1, S1P2, S1P3,
S1P4, and S1P5 are shown below. In some embodiments, a S1P modulator can reduce the
level of sphingosine 1-phosphate in a subject (e.g., in a tissue or in the extracellular
space of a subject), e.g., as compared to the level in the absence of the S1P modulator.
Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 1 (also called S1P1 and S1PR1) Protein (SEQ
ID NO: 1)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 1 cDNA (SEQ ID NO: 2)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 2 (also called S1P2 and S1PR2) Protein (SEQ
ID NO: 3)


Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 2 (also called S1P2 and S1PR2) cDNA (SEQ ID
NO: 4)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 3 (also called S1P3 and S1PR3) Protein (SEQ
ID NO: 5)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 3 (also called S1P3 and S1PR3) cDNA (SEQ ID
NO: 6)


Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 4 (also called S1P4 and S1PR4) Protein (SEQ
ID NO: 7) (signal peptide bold and underlined)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 4 (also called S1P4 and S1PR4) cDNA (SEQ ID
NO: 8)


Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 5 (also called SIPS and S1PR5) Protein (SEQ
ID NO: 9)

Human Sphingosine 1-Phosphate Receptor 5 (also called SIPS and S1PR5) cDNA (SEQ ID
NO: 10)


[0115] Non-limiting examples of the downstream signaling activity of one or more SIPs include:
phospholipase C (PLC) activity, PI3K activity, PKC activity, ERK1/ERK2 activity, MEK
activity, Raf activity, Ras activity, Akt1 activity, JNK activation, GTPase activity
(e.g., GTPase activity that is coupled with any one of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and
S1P5), JNK activity, and mTOR activation. Methods for detecting a levels of PLC activity,
P13K activity, PKC activity, ERK1/ERK2 activity, MEK activity, Raf activity, Ras activity,
Akt1 activity, JNK activity, GTPase activity (e.g., GTPase activity that is coupled
with any one of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5), JNK activity, and mTOR activation
are known in the art.
[0116] Non-limiting examples of methods that can be used to determine the level of S1P1,
S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5 include immunoblotting, immunofluorescence microscopy,
fluorescence-assisted cell sorting, and RT-PCR. Additional methods for determining
the level of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5 are known in the art.
[0117] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is phosphorylated
in vivo (e.g., following administration to a subject), and thereafter, resembles naturally-occurring
sphingosine-1-phosphate.
[0118] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator reduces immune cell (e.g., T cells, macrophages,
neutrophils, and/or B cells) migration and/or immune cell (e.g., T cell, macrophage,
neutrophils, and/or B cells) differentiation and/or proliferation. In some embodiments,
a S1P1 modulator decreases inflammation in a subject following administration.
[0119] In other embodiments, a S1P modulator increases vasoconstriction, fibrosis, and cell
proliferation in a subject following administration.
[0120] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator binds to S1P1, is internalized and activates
intracellular AKT and ERK signaling pathways.
[0121] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator reduces intracellular calcium ion mobilization
(e.g., cenerimod).
[0122] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator reduces vascular permeability, reduces expression
of one or more pro-inflammatory cytokines (e.g., one or more of IL-6, Il-17, IL-12/IL-23
p40, CCL2, and TNFα), and/or reduces expression of myeloperoxidase levels. In some
embodiments, the S1P modulator reduces neutrophil infiltration.
[0123] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator reduces migration of lymphocytes from lymph
nodes. In some embodiments, a S1P modulator reduces the release of inflammatory cytokines,
reduces organ and/or tissue damage, or maintains immune surveillance.
[0124] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is ABT-413.
[0125] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is
18F-radiolabeled sphingosine-1-phosphate receptor 1 targeted PET imaging agent (fluorine-18-TZ-4881,
fluorine 18-TZ-4877, 18F-TZ-4877, 18F-TZ-4881).
[0126] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator selectively targets S1P1, S1P4 and/or S1P5.
[0127] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator is a S1P agonist. For example, a S1P agonist
can be a small molecule (e.g., less than 900 daltons), a peptide, or a fusion protein.
In some embodiments, the S1P agonist is a non-selective S1P1 agonist (e.g., fingolimod).
[0128] In some embodiments, a S1P1 modulator is a S1P antagonist. For example, a S1P antagonist
can be an inhibitory nucleic acid, an antibody or fragment thereof, a fusion protein,
or a small molecule (e.g., less than 900 daltons). In some embodiments, the inhibitory
nucleic acid is a small interfering RNA or an antisense molecule.
[0129] Non-limiting examples of S1P modulators are described in
US 9,073,888;
US 8,318,783;
US 8,497,255;
US 8,501,726;
US 9,079,864;
US 8,686,046;
WO 11/134280;
WO 11/144338,
US 2010/0240614,
US 2016/0338978,
US 2015/0232492,
US 2015/0218090,
US 2014/0227358,
US 2012/0288559,
US 2010/0040678,
US 2004/0235794,
US 9,765,016,
US 9,078,907,
US 8,377,910,
US 2015/0361029,
US 2013/0202648,
US 2005/0009757,
US 2018/0009770,
US 2017/0368001,
US 2017/0320839,
US 2017/0217963,
US 2017/0165236,
US 2017/0151195,
US 2016/0296481,
US 2016/0137616,
US 2015/0335666,
US 2015/0299179,
US 2015/0299150,
US 2015/0299149,
US 2015/0284403,
US 2015/0265573,
US 2015/0252037,
US 2015/0231158,
US 2015/0165046,
US 2015/0057261,
US 2015/0057253,
US 2015/0051186,
US 2015/0051176,
US 2015/0045341,
US 2015/0045328,
US 2014/0371200,
US 2014/0363457,
US 2014/0274963,
US 2014/0256945,
US 2014/0243307,
US 2014/0243287,
US 2014/0235613,
US 2014/0235592,
US 2014/0235588,
US 2014/0235587,
US 2014/0235585,
US 2014/0228445,
US 2014/0228345,
US 2014/0228344,
US 2014/0228341,
US 2014/0228325,
US 2014/0228324,
US 2014/0221498,
US 2014/0221317,
US 2014/0213573,
US 2014/0206652,
US 2014/0171393,
US 2014/0170067,
US 2014/0142192,
US 2014/0135366,
US 2014/0135365,
US 2014/0135293,
US 2014/0135291,
US 2014/0128369,
US 2014/0128366,
US 2014/0128348,
US 2014/0107075,
US 2014/0100251,
US 2014/0100199,
US 2014/0100197,
US 2014/0066433,
US 2014/0057952,
US 2014/0057878,
US 2014/0057876,
US 2014/0039183,
US 2013/0338195,
US 2013/0338158,
US 2013/0338136,
US 2013/0338135,
US 2013/0338109,
US 2013/0338108,
US 2013/0331373,
US 2013/0310360,
US 2013/0310359,
US 2013/0303577,
US 2013/0303513,
US 2013/0296361,
US 2013/0231326,
US 2013/0217667,
US 2013/0217652,
US 2013/0217651,
US 2013/0196966,
US 2013/0157982,
US 2013/0150411,
US 2013/0150331,
US 2013/0065860,
US 2013/0018019,
US 2013/0017190,
US 2012/0328661,
US 2012/0302606,
US 2012/0264732,
US 2012/0264730,
US 2012/0264718,
US 2012/0264716,
US 2012/0264715,
US 2012/0208840,
US 2012/0142745,
US 2012/0142740,
US 2014/0142739,
US 2012/0142736,
US 2012/0142664,
US 2012/0142663,
US 2012/0142662,
US 2012/0142661,
US 2012/0142642,
US 2012/0142640,
US 2012/0142639,
US 2012/0129906,
US 2012/0129829,
US 2012/0129814,
US 2012/0129813,
US 2012/0088800,
US 2011/0281822,
US 2011/0275677,
US 2011/0263661,
US 2011/0257232,
US 2011/0212925,
US 2011/0183953,
US 2011/0178056,
US 2011/0172202,
US 2011/0152241,
US 2010/0317709,
US 2010/0310547,
US 2010/0267675,
US 2010/0226916,
US 2009/0325907,
US 2009/0074789,
US 2009/0074720,
US 2008/0213274,
US 2008/0171772,
US 2007/0280933,
US 2007/0191313,
US 2007/0148168,
US 2003/0157086,
US 2003/0096022,
US 2003/0027304,
US 2003/0026799,
US 9,765,016,
US 9,687,477,
US 9,670,220,
US 9,572,792,
US 9,481,659,
US 9,399,066,
US 9,394,264,
US 9,388,147,
US 9,371,296,
US 9,370,497,
US 9,345,791,
US 9,271,992,
US 9,120,784,
US 9,108,993,
US 9,101,576,
US 9,096,612,
US 9,062,030,
US 9,000,016,
US 8,993,553,
US 8,987,471,
US 8,987,467,
US 8,957,051,
US 8,957,061,
US 8,946,195,
US 8,906,899,
US 8,871,755,
US 8,859,598,
US 8,846,729,
US 8,846,728,
US 8,828,973,
US 8,754,066,
US 8,741,875,
US 8,735,433,
US 8,729,110,
US 8,729,109,
US 8,729,062,
US 8,722,712,
US 8,716,267,
US 8,703,797,
US 8,703,746,
US 8,703,745,
US 8,697,733,
US 8,673,918,
US 8,673,892,
US 8,658,634,
US 8,658,623,
US 8,653,270,
US 8,653,062,
US 8,653,050,
US 8,623,856,
US 8,618,139,
US 8,609,636,
US 8,541,582,
US 8,541,397,
US 8,530,462,
US 8,524,917,
US 8,518,932,
US 8,513,418,
8,513,220,
US 8,507,686,
US 8,507,685,
US 8,507,682,
US 8,507,538,
US 8,497,254,
US 8,492,561,
US 8,492,410,
US 8,486,918,
US 8,440,698,
US 8,440,644,
US 8,404,663,
US 8,399,492,
US 8,362,048,
US 8,357,706,
US 8,288,555,
US 8,273,776,
US 8,258,150,
US 8,232,319,
US 8,143,291,
US 7,888,336,
US 7,737,173,
US 6,881,546,
US 6,858,383,
US 5,877,167,
US 5,260,288, and
US 5,391,800, each of which is incorporated by reference in its entirety. Additional examples
of S1P modulators are described in
US 2008/0194670,
US 2011/0224239,
US 2009/0163523,
US 2018/0133233,
US 2018/0002356,
US 2017/0239280,
US 2017/0020826,
US 2016/0129023,
US 2016/0089348,
US 2016/0030572,
US 2015/0080347,
US 2014/0309190,
US 2014/0271541,
US 2014/0199382,
US 2014/0179636,
US 2014/0100195,
US 2013/0253066,
US 2013/0065954,
US 2012/0328664,
US 2012/0225031,
US 2012/0190649,
US 2011/0313033,
US 2011/0224239,
US 2011/0195936,
US 2011/0124605,
US 2010/0240617,
US 2010/0160357,
US 2010/0160258,
US 2009/0324542,
US 2009/0253761,
US 2009/0253760,
US 2009/0253759,
US 2009/0196859,
US 2009/0163523,
US 2009/0105315,
US 2009/0042955,
US 2008/0311188,
US 2008/0207739,
US 2008/0194526,
US 2006/0281709,
US 2006/0275357,
US 2006/0046979,
US 2004/0063667,
US 9,827,258,
US 9,708,353,
US 9,572,824,
US 9,186,367,
US 9,181,191,
US 8,802,659,
US 8,349,849,
US 8,324,283,
US 8,269,043,
US 8,173,170,
US 7,985,586,
US 7,964,649,
US 7,915,315,
US 7,786,173,
US 7,151,093,
US 2013/0183322,
US2013/0012491,
US 2012/0213837,
US 2012/0101124,
US 2017/0304326,
US 2017/0050941,
US 2016/0008340,
US 2015/0376173,
US 2015/0306189,
US 2015/0283154,
US 2015/0105712,
US 2015/0104497,
US 2015/0057307,
US 2014/0303257,
US 2014/0162964,
US 2014/0099316,
US 2013/0281541,
US 2012/0329840,
US 2012/0329839,
US 2012/0329838,
US 2011/0245204,
US 2011/0152275,
US 2011/0136739,
US 2011/0124739,
US 2011/0015159,
US 2010/0324057,
US 2010/0249187,
US 2010/0249074,
US 2010/0093745,
US 2010/0010001,
US 2009/0264469,
US 2009/0253802,
US 2009/0209495,
US 2009/0029922,
US 2008/0249070,
US 2008/0139662,
US 2008/0039530,
US 2006/0094790,
US 2005/0222092,
US 2005/0215331,
US 2005/0032744,
US 9,975,863,
US 9,540,362,
US 9,382,217,
US 9,266,867,
US 9,200,309,
US 9,101,575,
US 8,809,539,
US 8,796,318,
US 8,530,503,
US 8,519,006,
US 8,481,573,
US 8,476,305,
US 8,466,183,
US 8,329,676,
US 7,960,588,
US 7,910,626,
US 7,838,562,
US 7,754,703, and
US 7,691,563, each of which is incorporated by reference in its entirety. Additional examples
of S1P modulators are described in, e.g.,
US 9,663,511,
US 8,212,010,
US 2015/0045332,
US 2014/0336365,
US 2012/0225064,
US 2009/0226453,
US 2018/0141942,
US 2017/0135997,
US 2014/0186339,
US 2012/0190694,
US 2011/0301188,
US 2011/0288076,
US 2011/0039866,
US 2010/0041715,
US 2005/0226862,
US 8,802,692,
US 8,791,102,
US 8,614,103,
US 8,444,970,
US 8,168,795,
US 8,049,037,
US 7,862,812,
US 6,368,831, and
US 6,352,844, each of which is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0130] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator can bind to one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3,
S1P4, and S1P5 with a K
D of about 10 pM to about 25 TM, about 10 pM to about 20 TM, about 10 pM to about 15
TM, about 10 pM to about 10 TM, about 10 pM to about 5 TM, about 10 pM to about 1
TM, about 10 pM to about 900 nM, about 10 pM to about 800 nM, about 10 pM to about
700 nM, about 10 pM to about 600 nM, about 10 pM to about 500 nM, about 10 pM to about
450 nM, about 10 pM to about 400 nM, about 10 pM to about 350 nM, about 10 pM to about
300 nM, about 10 pM to about 250 nM, about 10 pM to about 200 nM, about 10 pM to about
150 nM, about 10 pM to about 100 nM, about 10 pM to about 50 nM, about 10 pM to about
40 nM, about 10 pM to about 30 nM, about 10 pM to about 20 nM, about 10 pM to about
10 nM, about 10 pM to about 5 nM, about 10 pM to about 1 nM, about 10 pM to about
800 pM, about 10 pM to about 600 pM, about 10 pM to about 400 pM, about 10 pM to about
200 pM, about 10 pM to about 100 pM, about 100 pM to about 25 TM, about 100 pM to
about 20 TM, about 100 pM to about 15 TM, about 100 pM to about 10 TM, about 100 pM
to about 5 TM, about 100 pM to about 1 TM, about 100 pM to about 900 nM, about 100
pM to about 800 nM, about 100 pM to about 700 nM, about 100 pM to about 600 nM, about
100 pM to about 500 nM, about 100 pM to about 450 nM, about 100 pM to about 400 nM,
about 100 pM to about 350 nM, about 100 pM to about 300 nM, about 100 pM to about
250 nM, about 100 pM to about 200 nM, about 100 pM to about 150 nM, about 100 pM to
about 100 nM, about 100 pM to about 50 nM, about 100 pM to about 40 nM, about 100
pM to about 30 nM, about 100 pM to about 20 nM, about 100 pM to about 10 nM, about
100 pM to about 5 nM, about 100 pM to about 1 nM, about 100 pM to about 800 pM, about
100 pM to about 600 pM, about 100 pM to about 400 pM, about 100 pM to about 200 pM,
about 200 pM to about 25 TM, about 200 pM to about 20 TM, about 200 pM to about 15
TM, about 200 pM to about 10 TM, about 200 pM to about 5 TM, about 200 pM to about
1 TM, about 200 pM to about 900 nM, about 200 pM to about 800 nM, about 200 pM to
about 700 nM, about 200 pM to about 600 nM, about 200 pM to about 500 nM, about 200
pM to about 450 nM, about 200 pM to about 400 nM, about 200 pM to about 350 nM, about
200 pM to about 300 nM, about 200 pM to about 250 nM, about 200 pM to about 200 nM,
about 200 pM to about 150 nM, about 200 pM to about 100 nM, about 200 pM to about
50 nM, about 200 pM to about 40 nM, about 200 pM to about 30 nM, about 200 pM to about
20 nM, about 200 pM to about 10 nM, about 200 pM to about 5 nM, about 200 pM to about
1 nM, about 200 pM to about 800 pM, about 200 pM to about 600 pM, about 200 pM to
about 400 pM, about 400 pM to about 25 TM, about 400 pM to about 20 TM, about 400
pM to about 15 TM, about 400 pM to about 10 TM, about 400 pM to about 5 TM, about
400 pM to about 1 TM, about 400 pM to about 900 nM, about 400 pM to about 800 nM,
about 400 pM to about 700 nM, about 400 pM to about 600 nM, about 400 pM to about
500 nM, about 400 pM to about 450 nM, about 400 pM to about 400 nM, about 400 pM to
about 350 nM, about 400 pM to about 300 nM, about 400 pM to about 250 nM, about 400
pM to about 200 nM, about 400 pM to about 150 nM, about 400 pM to about 100 nM, about
400 pM to about 50 nM, about 400 pM to about 40 nM, about 400 pM to about 30 nM, about
400 pM to about 20 nM, about 400 pM to about 10 nM, about 400 pM to about 5 nM, about
400 pM to about 1 nM, about 400 pM to about 800 pM, about 400 pM to about 600 pM,
about 600 pM to about 25 TM, about 600 pM to about 20 TM, about 600 pM to about 15
TM, about 600 pM to about 10 TM, about 600 pM to about 5 TM, about 600 pM to about
1 TM, about 600 pM to about 900 nM, about 600 pM to about 800 nM, about 600 pM to
about 700 nM, about 600 pM to about 600 nM, about 600 pM to about 500 nM, about 600
pM to about 450 nM, about 600 pM to about 400 nM, about 600 pM to about 350 nM, about
600 pM to about 300 nM, about 600 pM to about 250 nM, about 600 pM to about 200 nM,
about 600 pM to about 150 nM, about 600 pM to about 100 nM, about 600 pM to about
50 nM, about 600 pM to about 40 nM, about 600 pM to about 30 nM, about 600 pM to about
20 nM, about 600 pM to about 10 nM, about 600 pM to about 5 nM, about 600 pM to about
1 nM, about 600 pM to about 800 pM, about 800 pM to about 25 TM, about 800 pM to about
20 TM, about 800 pM to about 15 TM, about 800 pM to about 10 TM, about 800 pM to about
5 TM, about 800 pM to about 1 TM, about 800 pM to about 900 nM, about 800 pM to about
800 nM, about 800 pM to about 700 nM, about 800 pM to about 600 nM, about 800 pM to
about 500 nM, about 800 pM to about 450 nM, about 800 pM to about 400 nM, about 800
pM to about 350 nM, about 800 pM to about 300 nM, about 800 pM to about 250 nM, about
800 pM to about 200 nM, about 800 pM to about 150 nM, about 800 pM to about 100 nM,
about 800 pM to about 50 nM, about 800 pM to about 40 nM, about 800 pM to about 30
nM, about 800 pM to about 20 nM, about 800 pM to about 10 nM, about 800 pM to about
5 nM, about 800 pM to about 1 nM, about 1 nM to about 25 TM, about 1 nM to about 20
TM, about 1 nM to about 15 TM, about 1 nM to about 10 TM, about 1 nM to about 5 TM,
about 1 nM to about 1 TM, about 1 nM to about 900 nM, about 1 nM to about 800 nM,
about 1 nM to about 700 nM, about 1 nM to about 600 nM, about 1 nM to about 500 nM,
about 1 nM to about 450 nM, about 1 nM to about 400 nM, about 1 nM to about 350 nM,
about 1 nM to about 300 nM, about 1 nM to about 250 nM, about 1 nM to about 200 nM,
about 1 nM to about 150 nM, about 1 nM to about 100 nM, about 1 nM to about 50 nM,
about 1 nM to about 40 nM, about 1 nM to about 30 nM, about 1 nM to about 20 nM, about
1 nM to about 10 nM, about 1 nM to about 5 nM, about 5 nM to about 25 TM, about 5
nM to about 20 TM, about 5 nM to about 15 TM, about 5 nM to about 10 TM, about 5 nM
to about 5 TM, about 5 nM to about 1 TM, about 5 nM to about 900 nM, about 5 nM to
about 800 nM, about 5 nM to about 700 nM, about 5 nM to about 600 nM, about 5 nM to
about 500 nM, about 5 nM to about 450 nM, about 5 nM to about 400 nM, about 5 nM to
about 350 nM, about 5 nM to about 300 nM, about 5 nM to about 250 nM, about 5 nM to
about 200 nM, about 5 nM to about 150 nM, about 5 nM to about 100 nM, about 5 nM to
about 50 nM, about 5 nM to about 40 nM, about 5 nM to about 30 nM, about 5 nM to about
20 nM, about 5 nM to about 10 nM, about 10 nM to about 25 TM, about 10 nM to about
20 TM, about 10 nM to about 15 TM, about 10 nM to about 10 TM, about 10 nM to about
5 TM, about 10 nM to about 1 TM, about 10 nM to about 900 nM, about 10 nM to about
800 nM, about 10 nM to about 700 nM, about 10 nM to about 600 nM, about 10 nM to about
500 nM, about 10 nM to about 450 nM, about 10 nM to about 400 nM, about 10 nM to about
350 nM, about 10 nM to about 300 nM, about 10 nM to about 250 nM, about 10 nM to about
200 nM, about 10 nM to about 150 nM, about 10 nM to about 100 nM, about 10 nM to about
50 nM, about 10 nM to about 40 nM, about 10 nM to about 30 nM, about 10 nM to about
20 nM, about 20 nM to about 25 TM, about 20 nM to about 20 TM, about 20 nM to about
15 TM, about 20 nM to about 10 TM, about 20 nM to about 5 TM, about 20 nM to about
1 TM, about 20 nM to about 900 nM, about 20 nM to about 800 nM, about 20 nM to about
700 nM, about 20 nM to about 600 nM, about 20 nM to about 500 nM, about 20 nM to about
450 nM, about 20 nM to about 400 nM, about 20 nM to about 350 nM, about 20 nM to about
300 nM, about 20 nM to about 250 nM, about 20 nM to about 200 nM, about 20 nM to about
150 nM, about 20 nM to about 100 nM, about 20 nM to about 50 nM, about 20 nM to about
40 nM, about 20 nM to about 30 nM, about 30 nM to about 25 TM, about 30 nM to about
20 TM, about 30 nM to about 15 TM, about 30 nM to about 10 TM, about 30 nM to about
5 TM, about 30 nM to about 1 TM, about 30 nM to about 900 nM, about 30 nM to about
800 nM, about 30 nM to about 700 nM, about 30 nM to about 600 nM, about 30 nM to about
500 nM, about 30 nM to about 450 nM, about 30 nM to about 400 nM, about 30 nM to about
350 nM, about 30 nM to about 300 nM, about 30 nM to about 250 nM, about 30 nM to about
200 nM, about 30 nM to about 150 nM, about 30 nM to about 100 nM, about 30 nM to about
50 nM, about 30 nM to about 40 nM, about 40 nM to about 25 TM, about 40 nM to about
20 TM, about 40 nM to about 15 TM, about 40 nM to about 10 TM, about 40 nM to about
5 TM, about 40 nM to about 1 TM, about 40 nM to about 900 nM, about 40 nM to about
800 nM, about 40 nM to about 700 nM, about 40 nM to about 600 nM, about 40 nM to about
500 nM, about 40 nM to about 450 nM, about 40 nM to about 400 nM, about 40 nM to about
350 nM, about 40 nM to about 300 nM, about 40 nM to about 250 nM, about 40 nM to about
200 nM, about 40 nM to about 150 nM, about 40 nM to about 100 nM, about 40 nM to about
50 nM, about 50 nM to about 25 TM, about 50 nM to about 20 TM, about 50 nM to about
15 TM, about 50 nM to about 10 TM, about 50 nM to about 5 TM, about 50 nM to about
1 TM, about 50 nM to about 900 nM, about 50 nM to about 800 nM, about 50 nM to about
700 nM, about 50 nM to about 600 nM, about 50 nM to about 500 nM, about 50 nM to about
450 nM, about 50 nM to about 400 nM, about 50 nM to about 350 nM, about 50 nM to about
300 nM, about 50 nM to about 250 nM, about 50 nM to about 200 nM, about 50 nM to about
150 nM, about 50 nM to about 100 nM, about 100 nM to about 25 TM, about 100 nM to
about 20 TM, about 100 nM to about 15 TM, about 100 nM to about 10 TM, about 100 nM
to about 5 TM, about 100 nM to about 1 TM, about 100 nM to about 900 nM, about 100
nM to about 800 nM, about 100 nM to about 700 nM, about 100 nM to about 600 nM, about
100 nM to about 500 nM, about 100 nM to about 450 nM, about 100 nM to about 400 nM,
about 100 nM to about 350 nM, about 100 nM to about 300 nM, about 100 nM to about
250 nM, about 100 nM to about 200 nM, about 100 nM to about 150 nM, about 150 nM to
about 25 TM, about 150 nM to about 20 TM, about 150 nM to about 15 TM, about 150 nM
to about 10 TM, about 150 nM to about 5 TM, about 150 nM to about 1 TM, about 150
nM to about 900 nM, about 150 nM to about 800 nM, about 150 nM to about 700 nM, about
150 nM to about 600 nM, about 150 nM to about 500 nM, about 150 nM to about 450 nM,
about 150 nM to about 400 nM, about 150 nM to about 350 nM, about 150 nM to about
300 nM, about 150 nM to about 250 nM, about 150 nM to about 200 nM, about 200 nM to
about 25 TM, about 200 nM to about 20 TM, about 200 nM to about 15 TM, about 200 nM
to about 10 TM, about 200 nM to about 5 TM, about 200 nM to about 1 TM, about 200
nM to about 900 nM, about 200 nM to about 800 nM, about 200 nM to about 700 nM, about
200 nM to about 600 nM, about 200 nM to about 500 nM, about 200 nM to about 450 nM,
about 200 nM to about 400 nM, about 200 nM to about 350 nM, about 200 nM to about
300 nM, about 200 nM to about 250 nM, about 250 nM to about 25 TM, about 250 nM to
about 20 TM, about 250 nM to about 15 TM, about 250 nM to about 10 TM, about 250 nM
to about 5 TM, about 250 nM to about 1 TM, about 250 nM to about 900 nM, about 250
nM to about 800 nM, about 250 nM to about 700 nM, about 250 nM to about 600 nM, about
250 nM to about 500 nM, about 250 nM to about 450 nM, about 250 nM to about 400 nM,
about 250 nM to about 350 nM, about 250 nM to about 300 nM, about 300 nM to about
25 TM, about 300 nM to about 20 TM, about 300 nM to about 15 TM, about 300 nM to about
10 TM, about 300 nM to about 5 TM, about 300 nM to about 1 TM, about 300 nM to about
900 nM, about 300 nM to about 800 nM, about 300 nM to about 700 nM, about 300 nM to
about 600 nM, about 300 nM to about 500 nM, about 300 nM to about 450 nM, about 300
nM to about 400 nM, about 300 nM to about 350 nM, about 350 nM to about 25 TM, about
350 nM to about 20 TM, about 350 nM to about 15 TM, about 350 nM to about 10 TM, about
350 nM to about 5 TM, about 350 nM to about 1 TM, about 350 nM to about 900 nM, about
350 nM to about 800 nM, about 350 nM to about 700 nM, about 350 nM to about 600 nM,
about 350 nM to about 500 nM, about 350 nM to about 450 nM, about 350 nM to about
400 nM, about 400 nM to about 25 TM, about 400 nM to about 20 TM, about 400 nM to
about 15 TM, about 400 nM to about 10 TM, about 400 nM to about 5 TM, about 400 nM
to about 1 TM, about 400 nM to about 900 nM, about 400 nM to about 800 nM, about 400
nM to about 700 nM, about 400 nM to about 600 nM, about 400 nM to about 500 nM, about
400 nM to about 450 nM, about 450 nM to about 25 TM, about 450 nM to about 20 TM,
about 450 nM to about 15 TM, about 450 nM to about 10 TM, about 450 nM to about 5
TM, about 450 nM to about 1 TM, about 450 nM to about 900 nM, about 450 nM to about
800 nM, about 450 nM to about 700 nM, about 450 nM to about 600 nM, about 450 nM to
about 500 nM, about 500 nM to about 25 TM, about 500 nM to about 20 TM, about 500
nM to about 15 TM, about 500 nM to about 10 TM, about 500 nM to about 5 TM, about
500 nM to about 1 TM, about 500 nM to about 900 nM, about 500 nM to about 800 nM,
about 500 nM to about 700 nM, about 500 nM to about 600 nM, about 600 nM to about
25 TM, about 600 nM to about 20 TM, about 600 nM to about 15 TM, about 600 nM to about
10 TM, about 600 nM to about 5 TM, about 600 nM to about 1 TM, about 600 nM to about
900 nM, about 600 nM to about 800 nM, about 600 nM to about 700 nM, about 700 nM to
about 25 TM, about 700 nM to about 20 TM, about 700 nM to about 15 TM, about 700 nM
to about 10 TM, about 700 nM to about 5 TM, about 700 nM to about 1 TM, about 700
nM to about 900 nM, about 700 nM to about 800 nM, about 800 nM to about 25 TM, about
800 nM to about 20 TM, about 800 nM to about 15 TM, about 800 nM to about 10 TM, about
800 nM to about 5 TM, about 800 nM to about 1 TM, about 800 nM to about 900 nM, about
900 nM to about 25 TM, about 900 nM to about 20 TM, about 900 nM to about 15 TM, about
900 nM to about 10 TM, about 900 nM to about 5 TM, about 900 nM to about 1 TM, about
1 TM to about 25 TM, about 1 TM to about 20 TM, about 1 TM to about 15 TM, about 1
TM to about 10 TM, about 1 TM to about 5 TM, about 5 TM to about 25 TM, about 5 TM
to about 20 TM, about 5 TM to about 15 TM, about 5 TM to about 10 TM, about 10 TM
to about 25 TM, about 10 TM to about 20 TM, about 10 TM to about 15 TM, about 15 TM
to about 25 TM, about 15 TM to about 20 TM, or about 20 TM to about 25 TM.
[0131] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator can inhibit one or more upstream activities
or downstream activities of one or more of S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, and S1P5, each
individually with an IC
50 of about 10 pM to about 25 TM, about 10 pM to about 20 TM, about 10 pM to about 15
TM, about 10 pM to about 10 TM, about 10 pM to about 5 TM, about 10 pM to about 1
TM, about 10 pM to about 900 nM, about 10 pM to about 800 nM, about 10 pM to about
700 nM, about 10 pM to about 600 nM, about 10 pM to about 500 nM, about 10 pM to about
450 nM, about 10 pM to about 400 nM, about 10 pM to about 350 nM, about 10 pM to about
300 nM, about 10 pM to about 250 nM, about 10 pM to about 200 nM, about 10 pM to about
150 nM, about 10 pM to about 100 nM, about 10 pM to about 50 nM, about 10 pM to about
40 nM, about 10 pM to about 30 nM, about 10 pM to about 20 nM, about 10 pM to about
10 nM, about 10 pM to about 5 nM, about 10 pM to about 1 nM, about 10 pM to about
800 pM, about 10 pM to about 600 pM, about 10 pM to about 400 pM, about 10 pM to about
200 pM, about 10 pM to about 100 pM, about 100 pM to about 25 TM, about 100 pM to
about 20 TM, about 100 pM to about 15 TM, about 100 pM to about 10 TM, about 100 pM
to about 5 TM, about 100 pM to about 1 TM, about 100 pM to about 900 nM, about 100
pM to about 800 nM, about 100 pM to about 700 nM, about 100 pM to about 600 nM, about
100 pM to about 500 nM, about 100 pM to about 450 nM, about 100 pM to about 400 nM,
about 100 pM to about 350 nM, about 100 pM to about 300 nM, about 100 pM to about
250 nM, about 100 pM to about 200 nM, about 100 pM to about 150 nM, about 100 pM to
about 100 nM, about 100 pM to about 50 nM, about 100 pM to about 40 nM, about 100
pM to about 30 nM, about 100 pM to about 20 nM, about 100 pM to about 10 nM, about
100 pM to about 5 nM, about 100 pM to about 1 nM, about 100 pM to about 800 pM, about
100 pM to about 600 pM, about 100 pM to about 400 pM, about 100 pM to about 200 pM,
about 200 pM to about 25 TM, about 200 pM to about 20 TM, about 200 pM to about 15
TM, about 200 pM to about 10 TM, about 200 pM to about 5 TM, about 200 pM to about
1 TM, about 200 pM to about 900 nM, about 200 pM to about 800 nM, about 200 pM to
about 700 nM, about 200 pM to about 600 nM, about 200 pM to about 500 nM, about 200
pM to about 450 nM, about 200 pM to about 400 nM, about 200 pM to about 350 nM, about
200 pM to about 300 nM, about 200 pM to about 250 nM, about 200 pM to about 200 nM,
about 200 pM to about 150 nM, about 200 pM to about 100 nM, about 200 pM to about
50 nM, about 200 pM to about 40 nM, about 200 pM to about 30 nM, about 200 pM to about
20 nM, about 200 pM to about 10 nM, about 200 pM to about 5 nM, about 200 pM to about
1 nM, about 200 pM to about 800 pM, about 200 pM to about 600 pM, about 200 pM to
about 400 pM, about 400 pM to about 25 TM, about 400 pM to about 20 TM, about 400
pM to about 15 TM, about 400 pM to about 10 TM, about 400 pM to about 5 TM, about
400 pM to about 1 TM, about 400 pM to about 900 nM, about 400 pM to about 800 nM,
about 400 pM to about 700 nM, about 400 pM to about 600 nM, about 400 pM to about
500 nM, about 400 pM to about 450 nM, about 400 pM to about 400 nM, about 400 pM to
about 350 nM, about 400 pM to about 300 nM, about 400 pM to about 250 nM, about 400
pM to about 200 nM, about 400 pM to about 150 nM, about 400 pM to about 100 nM, about
400 pM to about 50 nM, about 400 pM to about 40 nM, about 400 pM to about 30 nM, about
400 pM to about 20 nM, about 400 pM to about 10 nM, about 400 pM to about 5 nM, about
400 pM to about 1 nM, about 400 pM to about 800 pM, about 400 pM to about 600 pM,
about 600 pM to about 25 TM, about 600 pM to about 20 TM, about 600 pM to about 15
TM, about 600 pM to about 10 TM, about 600 pM to about 5 TM, about 600 pM to about
1 TM, about 600 pM to about 900 nM, about 600 pM to about 800 nM, about 600 pM to
about 700 nM, about 600 pM to about 600 nM, about 600 pM to about 500 nM, about 600
pM to about 450 nM, about 600 pM to about 400 nM, about 600 pM to about 350 nM, about
600 pM to about 300 nM, about 600 pM to about 250 nM, about 600 pM to about 200 nM,
about 600 pM to about 150 nM, about 600 pM to about 100 nM, about 600 pM to about
50 nM, about 600 pM to about 40 nM, about 600 pM to about 30 nM, about 600 pM to about
20 nM, about 600 pM to about 10 nM, about 600 pM to about 5 nM, about 600 pM to about
1 nM, about 600 pM to about 800 pM, about 800 pM to about 25 TM, about 800 pM to about
20 TM, about 800 pM to about 15 TM, about 800 pM to about 10 TM, about 800 pM to about
5 TM, about 800 pM to about 1 TM, about 800 pM to about 900 nM, about 800 pM to about
800 nM, about 800 pM to about 700 nM, about 800 pM to about 600 nM, about 800 pM to
about 500 nM, about 800 pM to about 450 nM, about 800 pM to about 400 nM, about 800
pM to about 350 nM, about 800 pM to about 300 nM, about 800 pM to about 250 nM, about
800 pM to about 200 nM, about 800 pM to about 150 nM, about 800 pM to about 100 nM,
about 800 pM to about 50 nM, about 800 pM to about 40 nM, about 800 pM to about 30
nM, about 800 pM to about 20 nM, about 800 pM to about 10 nM, about 800 pM to about
5 nM, about 800 pM to about 1 nM, about 1 nM to about 25 TM, about 1 nM to about 20
TM, about 1 nM to about 15 TM, about 1 nM to about 10 TM, about 1 nM to about 5 TM,
about 1 nM to about 1 TM, about 1 nM to about 900 nM, about 1 nM to about 800 nM,
about 1 nM to about 700 nM, about 1 nM to about 600 nM, about 1 nM to about 500 nM,
about 1 nM to about 450 nM, about 1 nM to about 400 nM, about 1 nM to about 350 nM,
about 1 nM to about 300 nM, about 1 nM to about 250 nM, about 1 nM to about 200 nM,
about 1 nM to about 150 nM, about 1 nM to about 100 nM, about 1 nM to about 50 nM,
about 1 nM to about 40 nM, about 1 nM to about 30 nM, about 1 nM to about 20 nM, about
1 nM to about 10 nM, about 1 nM to about 5 nM, about 5 nM to about 25 TM, about 5
nM to about 20 TM, about 5 nM to about 15 TM, about 5 nM to about 10 TM, about 5 nM
to about 5 TM, about 5 nM to about 1 TM, about 5 nM to about 900 nM, about 5 nM to
about 800 nM, about 5 nM to about 700 nM, about 5 nM to about 600 nM, about 5 nM to
about 500 nM, about 5 nM to about 450 nM, about 5 nM to about 400 nM, about 5 nM to
about 350 nM, about 5 nM to about 300 nM, about 5 nM to about 250 nM, about 5 nM to
about 200 nM, about 5 nM to about 150 nM, about 5 nM to about 100 nM, about 5 nM to
about 50 nM, about 5 nM to about 40 nM, about 5 nM to about 30 nM, about 5 nM to about
20 nM, about 5 nM to about 10 nM, about 10 nM to about 25 TM, about 10 nM to about
20 TM, about 10 nM to about 15 TM, about 10 nM to about 10 TM, about 10 nM to about
5 TM, about 10 nM to about 1 TM, about 10 nM to about 900 nM, about 10 nM to about
800 nM, about 10 nM to about 700 nM, about 10 nM to about 600 nM, about 10 nM to about
500 nM, about 10 nM to about 450 nM, about 10 nM to about 400 nM, about 10 nM to about
350 nM, about 10 nM to about 300 nM, about 10 nM to about 250 nM, about 10 nM to about
200 nM, about 10 nM to about 150 nM, about 10 nM to about 100 nM, about 10 nM to about
50 nM, about 10 nM to about 40 nM, about 10 nM to about 30 nM, about 10 nM to about
20 nM, about 20 nM to about 25 TM, about 20 nM to about 20 TM, about 20 nM to about
15 TM, about 20 nM to about 10 TM, about 20 nM to about 5 TM, about 20 nM to about
1 TM, about 20 nM to about 900 nM, about 20 nM to about 800 nM, about 20 nM to about
700 nM, about 20 nM to about 600 nM, about 20 nM to about 500 nM, about 20 nM to about
450 nM, about 20 nM to about 400 nM, about 20 nM to about 350 nM, about 20 nM to about
300 nM, about 20 nM to about 250 nM, about 20 nM to about 200 nM, about 20 nM to about
150 nM, about 20 nM to about 100 nM, about 20 nM to about 50 nM, about 20 nM to about
40 nM, about 20 nM to about 30 nM, about 30 nM to about 25 TM, about 30 nM to about
20 TM, about 30 nM to about 15 TM, about 30 nM to about 10 TM, about 30 nM to about
5 TM, about 30 nM to about 1 TM, about 30 nM to about 900 nM, about 30 nM to about
800 nM, about 30 nM to about 700 nM, about 30 nM to about 600 nM, about 30 nM to about
500 nM, about 30 nM to about 450 nM, about 30 nM to about 400 nM, about 30 nM to about
350 nM, about 30 nM to about 300 nM, about 30 nM to about 250 nM, about 30 nM to about
200 nM, about 30 nM to about 150 nM, about 30 nM to about 100 nM, about 30 nM to about
50 nM, about 30 nM to about 40 nM, about 40 nM to about 25 TM, about 40 nM to about
20 TM, about 40 nM to about 15 TM, about 40 nM to about 10 TM, about 40 nM to about
5 TM, about 40 nM to about 1 TM, about 40 nM to about 900 nM, about 40 nM to about
800 nM, about 40 nM to about 700 nM, about 40 nM to about 600 nM, about 40 nM to about
500 nM, about 40 nM to about 450 nM, about 40 nM to about 400 nM, about 40 nM to about
350 nM, about 40 nM to about 300 nM, about 40 nM to about 250 nM, about 40 nM to about
200 nM, about 40 nM to about 150 nM, about 40 nM to about 100 nM, about 40 nM to about
50 nM, about 50 nM to about 25 TM, about 50 nM to about 20 TM, about 50 nM to about
15 TM, about 50 nM to about 10 TM, about 50 nM to about 5 TM, about 50 nM to about
1 TM, about 50 nM to about 900 nM, about 50 nM to about 800 nM, about 50 nM to about
700 nM, about 50 nM to about 600 nM, about 50 nM to about 500 nM, about 50 nM to about
450 nM, about 50 nM to about 400 nM, about 50 nM to about 350 nM, about 50 nM to about
300 nM, about 50 nM to about 250 nM, about 50 nM to about 200 nM, about 50 nM to about
150 nM, about 50 nM to about 100 nM, about 100 nM to about 25 TM, about 100 nM to
about 20 TM, about 100 nM to about 15 TM, about 100 nM to about 10 TM, about 100 nM
to about 5 TM, about 100 nM to about 1 TM, about 100 nM to about 900 nM, about 100
nM to about 800 nM, about 100 nM to about 700 nM, about 100 nM to about 600 nM, about
100 nM to about 500 nM, about 100 nM to about 450 nM, about 100 nM to about 400 nM,
about 100 nM to about 350 nM, about 100 nM to about 300 nM, about 100 nM to about
250 nM, about 100 nM to about 200 nM, about 100 nM to about 150 nM, about 150 nM to
about 25 TM, about 150 nM to about 20 TM, about 150 nM to about 15 TM, about 150 nM
to about 10 TM, about 150 nM to about 5 TM, about 150 nM to about 1 TM, about 150
nM to about 900 nM, about 150 nM to about 800 nM, about 150 nM to about 700 nM, about
150 nM to about 600 nM, about 150 nM to about 500 nM, about 150 nM to about 450 nM,
about 150 nM to about 400 nM, about 150 nM to about 350 nM, about 150 nM to about
300 nM, about 150 nM to about 250 nM, about 150 nM to about 200 nM, about 200 nM to
about 25 TM, about 200 nM to about 20 TM, about 200 nM to about 15 TM, about 200 nM
to about 10 TM, about 200 nM to about 5 TM, about 200 nM to about 1 TM, about 200
nM to about 900 nM, about 200 nM to about 800 nM, about 200 nM to about 700 nM, about
200 nM to about 600 nM, about 200 nM to about 500 nM, about 200 nM to about 450 nM,
about 200 nM to about 400 nM, about 200 nM to about 350 nM, about 200 nM to about
300 nM, about 200 nM to about 250 nM, about 250 nM to about 25 TM, about 250 nM to
about 20 TM, about 250 nM to about 15 TM, about 250 nM to about 10 TM, about 250 nM
to about 5 TM, about 250 nM to about 1 TM, about 250 nM to about 900 nM, about 250
nM to about 800 nM, about 250 nM to about 700 nM, about 250 nM to about 600 nM, about
250 nM to about 500 nM, about 250 nM to about 450 nM, about 250 nM to about 400 nM,
about 250 nM to about 350 nM, about 250 nM to about 300 nM, about 300 nM to about
25 TM, about 300 nM to about 20 TM, about 300 nM to about 15 TM, about 300 nM to about
10 TM, about 300 nM to about 5 TM, about 300 nM to about 1 TM, about 300 nM to about
900 nM, about 300 nM to about 800 nM, about 300 nM to about 700 nM, about 300 nM to
about 600 nM, about 300 nM to about 500 nM, about 300 nM to about 450 nM, about 300
nM to about 400 nM, about 300 nM to about 350 nM, about 350 nM to about 25 TM, about
350 nM to about 20 TM, about 350 nM to about 15 TM, about 350 nM to about 10 TM, about
350 nM to about 5 TM, about 350 nM to about 1 TM, about 350 nM to about 900 nM, about
350 nM to about 800 nM, about 350 nM to about 700 nM, about 350 nM to about 600 nM,
about 350 nM to about 500 nM, about 350 nM to about 450 nM, about 350 nM to about
400 nM, about 400 nM to about 25 TM, about 400 nM to about 20 TM, about 400 nM to
about 15 TM, about 400 nM to about 10 TM, about 400 nM to about 5 TM, about 400 nM
to about 1 TM, about 400 nM to about 900 nM, about 400 nM to about 800 nM, about 400
nM to about 700 nM, about 400 nM to about 600 nM, about 400 nM to about 500 nM, about
400 nM to about 450 nM, about 450 nM to about 25 TM, about 450 nM to about 20 TM,
about 450 nM to about 15 TM, about 450 nM to about 10 TM, about 450 nM to about 5
TM, about 450 nM to about 1 TM, about 450 nM to about 900 nM, about 450 nM to about
800 nM, about 450 nM to about 700 nM, about 450 nM to about 600 nM, about 450 nM to
about 500 nM, about 500 nM to about 25 TM, about 500 nM to about 20 TM, about 500
nM to about 15 TM, about 500 nM to about 10 TM, about 500 nM to about 5 TM, about
500 nM to about 1 TM, about 500 nM to about 900 nM, about 500 nM to about 800 nM,
about 500 nM to about 700 nM, about 500 nM to about 600 nM, about 600 nM to about
25 TM, about 600 nM to about 20 TM, about 600 nM to about 15 TM, about 600 nM to about
10 TM, about 600 nM to about 5 TM, about 600 nM to about 1 TM, about 600 nM to about
900 nM, about 600 nM to about 800 nM, about 600 nM to about 700 nM, about 700 nM to
about 25 TM, about 700 nM to about 20 TM, about 700 nM to about 15 TM, about 700 nM
to about 10 TM, about 700 nM to about 5 TM, about 700 nM to about 1 TM, about 700
nM to about 900 nM, about 700 nM to about 800 nM, about 800 nM to about 25 TM, about
800 nM to about 20 TM, about 800 nM to about 15 TM, about 800 nM to about 10 TM, about
800 nM to about 5 TM, about 800 nM to about 1 TM, about 800 nM to about 900 nM, about
900 nM to about 25 TM, about 900 nM to about 20 TM, about 900 nM to about 15 TM, about
900 nM to about 10 TM, about 900 nM to about 5 TM, about 900 nM to about 1 TM, about
1 TM to about 25 TM, about 1 TM to about 20 TM, about 1 TM to about 15 TM, about 1
TM to about 10 TM, about 1 TM to about 5 TM, about 5 TM to about 25 TM, about 5 TM
to about 20 TM, about 5 TM to about 15 TM, about 5 TM to about 10 TM, about 10 TM
to about 25 TM, about 10 TM to about 20 TM, about 10 TM to about 15 TM, about 15 TM
to about 25 TM, about 15 TM to about 20 TM, or about 20 TM to about 25 TM.
[0132] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator targets S1P1, S1P4, and/or S1P5. In some embodiments,
the S1P modulator targets S1P1, S1P4, and/or S1P5, and does not target S1P2 and/or
S1P3. In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is an S1P antagonist that reduces the
intracellular concentration of calcium ions and reduces Rho activation.
Small Molecule Modulators
[0133] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator is a small molecule (less than 900 daltons).
For example, the S1P modulator can be fingolimod (FTY720; Gilenya
®) or a variant thereof (
Brinkmann et al., J. Biol. Chem. 277:21453-21457, 2002;
Santos-Gallego et al., Circulation 133(10): 954-966, 2016;
Matloubian et al., Nature 427:355-360, 2004;
Fujita et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett. 5(8):847-852, 1995;
Adachi, et al., Perspect. Med. Chem. 1:11-23, 2007;
Fujita et al., J. Med. Chem. 39(22): 4451-4459, 1996;
Kiuchi et al., J. Med. Chem. 43(15):2946-2961, 2000). The structure of fingolimod is shown below:

[0138] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is SYL-933 (SYL-933-P) or a variant thereof.
In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is S 1PAGT or a variant thereof.
[0139] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is cenerimod (e.g., ACT-334441) or a variant
thereof (
Piali et al., Pharmacol. Res. Perspect. 5(6): doi: 10.1002/prp2.370, 2017;
Juif et al., Int. J. Mol. Sci. 18(12): pii: E2636, 2017;
Schmidt et al., Org. Process Res. Dev. 20(9):1637-1646, 2016;
Bolli et al., Eur. J. Med. Chem. 115:326-341, 2016). The structure of ACT-334441 is shown below:

[0140] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is NIBR-785 or a variant thereof. In some
embodiments, the S1P modulator is BMS-520 (BMS-54) or a variant thereof (
Hou et al., Org. Process Res. Dev. 20(5): 989-995, 2016). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is GSK-2018682 (2018682, PPI-4621, PPI-4667,
PPI-4667-P, PPI-4939, PPI-4955, or PPI-5955-P) or a variant thereof (
Xu et al., Clin. Pharmacol. Drug Dev. 3(3): 170-178, 2014). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is GSK1842799 (PPI-4691) or a variant thereof
(
Deng et al., ACSMed. Chem. Lett. 4(10): 942-947, 2013). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is KRP-107 or a variant thereof. In some
embodiments, the S1P modulator is AMG-247 (also called AMG-277, AMG-369, and PRX-13038)
or a variant thereof.
[0141] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is ponesimod (ACT-128800, Actelion-2, R-3477,
RG-3477) or a variant thereof (
Krause et al., J. Pharmacokinet. Pharmacodym. 41(3): 261-278, 2014;
You et al., PLoS One 8(10): e77296, 2013;
Piali et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 337(2):547-556, 2011;
Bolli, et al., J. Med. Chem. 53(10):4198-4211, 2010). The structure of ponesimod is shown below:

[0142] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is YP-005 or a variant thereof. In some embodiments,
the S1P modulator is mocravimod dihydrochloride (also called KNF-299, KRP-203, KRP-203-P
prodrug, and mocravimod) or a variant thereof (
Ogawa et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 361(3): 621-628, 2007;
Fujishiro et al., Transplantation 82(6):804-812, 2006;
Song et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 324:276-283, 2008). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is SAR-247799 or a variant thereof (
Watterson et al., J. Med. Chem. 59(6):2820-2840, 2016). In some embodiments, the S1P1 modulator is SEW2871 or a variant thereof (Lien et
al. 69(9):1601-1608, 2006).
[0144] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is siponimod (BAF-312) or a variant thereof
(
Pan et al., ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 4(3):333-337, 2013;
O'Sullivan et al., J. Neuroinflammation 13:31, 2016;
Gergely et al., Mult. Scler. 15:S125, 2009;
Gergely, et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 167(5):1035-1047, 2012). The structure of siponimod is shown below:

[0147] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is ASP4058 or a variant thereof (
Yamamoto et al., PLoS One 9(1):e110819, 2014;
Astellas R&D Pipeline; Astellas: Tokyo, August 2010; https://www.astellas.com/en/ir/library/pdf/1q2011_rd_en.pdf
(accessed Sept 21, 2016)). The structure of ASP4058 is shown below:

[0150] In some embodiments, the S1P1 modulator modulates the activity of sphingosine 1-phosphate
phosphatase 1. In some embodiments, the S1P modulator agonizes the activity of S1P1
(e.g., LAS-189913). For example, a sphingosine 1 phosphate phosphatase 1 modulator
can have the structure of:

[0152] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator can modulate the activity and/or expression
of S1P3 (e.g., a S1P1/S1P3 agonist).
[0153] In some embodiments, the S1P1 modulator can modulate the activity and/or expression
of S1P2 (e.g., a S1P1/S1P2 agonist).
[0154] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator can modulate the activity and/or expression
of S1P5 (e.g., a S1P5 agonist) (e.g., LC-51-SPA, LC-510201, A-971432, ABT-363, ozanimod
(RPC-1063 or RPC1063 HCl) (
Scott et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 173(11):1778-1792, 2016;
Meadows et al., PLoS One 13(4): e0193236, 2018), ceralifimod (ONO-4641) (
Kurata et al., J. Med. Chem. 60(23):9508-9530, 2017,
Krosser et al., J. Clin. Pharmacol. 55(9):1051-1060, 2015), siponimod (BAF-312) (
Pan et al., ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 4(3):333-337, 2013;
O'Sullivan et al., J. Neuroinflammation 13:31, 2016;
Gergely et al., Mult. Scler. 15:S125, 2009), OBT-893 (SH-BC-893) (
Kim et al., J. Clin. Invest. 126(11):4088-4102, 2016), or RP-1859 (RP-1865)).
[0155] In some embodiments, S1P modulator (e.g., a S1P1 and S1P5 agonist) is 5-{5-[3-(trifluoromethyl)-4-{[(2S)-1,1,1-trifluoropropan-2-yl]oxy}phenyl]-1,2,4-oxadiazol-3-yl}-1H-benzimidazole
(ASP4085) or a variant thereof (
Yamamoto et al., PLoS One 9(10):e110819, 2014;
Yamamoto et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 174(13):2085-2101, 2017).
[0156] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a partial agonist. For example, a S1P partial
agonist can be BMS-986166 and have the structure:

[0158] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is FP-253 or a variant thereof. In some embodiments,
the S1P modulator is CP-1050 (e.g., CP-9531) or a variant thereof.
[0160] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine 1 phosphate lyase inhibitor.
In some embodiments, the sphingosine 1 phosphate lyase inhibitor is LX-2932, LX-2931
(LX-3305), or a variant thereof (
Bagdanoff et al., J. Med. Chem. 53(24): 8650-8662, 2010). In some embodiments, the sphingosine 1 phosphate lyase inhibitor is 6-[(2R)-4-(4-benzyl-7-chlorophthalazin-1-yl)-2-methylpiperazin-1-yl]pyridine-3-carbonitrile
or a variant thereof (
Harris et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 359(1): 151-158, 2016;
Weiler et al., J. Med. Chem. 57: 5074-5084, 2014).
[0161] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is KDS-1059 or a variant thereof. In some
embodiments, the S1P modulator is KSI-6666 or a variant thereof. In some embodiments,
the S1P modulator is an ozanimod metabolite (e.g., RP-101074, RP-101442, RP-101988,
RPC-101075, and RPC-1063) or a variant thereof. The structure of ozanimod is shown
below:

[0162] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is TASP-0251078 (TASP-0277308) or a variant
thereof (
Fujii et al., J. Immunol. 188: 206-215, 2012). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is 1-(4-chlorophenylhydrazono)-1-(4-chlorophenylamino)-3,3-dimethyl-
2-butanone (TY-52156) or a variant thereof (
Murakami et al., Mol. Pharmacol. 77(4): 704-713, 2010). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is amiselimod (e.g., MT-1303) or a variant
thereof (
Sugahara et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 174(1):15-27, 2017;
Fyfe, Nat. Rev. Neurol. 12(10):554, 2016;
Kappos et al., Lancet Neurol. 15(11):1148-1159, 2016). The structure of amiselimod is shown below:

[0163] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is NOX-S91 (NOX-S92, NOX-S93) or a variant
thereof (
Purschke et al., Biochem J. 462(1):153-162, 2014;
Schneider et al., Mol. Cancer Res. 11(7):793-807, 2013). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is EXEL-4541 (XI,-541) or a variant thereof.
In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is (R)-phosphoric acid mono-[2-amino-2-(3-octyl-phenylcarbamoyl)-ethyl]
ester (VPC23019) or a variant thereof (
Davis et al., J. Biol. Chem. 280: 9833-9841, 2005).
[0165] The structure of etrasimod is shown below:

[0167] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine kinase 1 inhibitor (e.g.,
SPG-104, BML-258, PF-543, NV-06 (idronoxil, phenoxidiol), or SKI-349). In some embodiments,
the sphingosine kinase 1 inhibitor is B-5354a, B-5354b, B-5354c, or a variant thereof
(
Kono et al., J. Antibiot. 53(8):753-758, 2000). In some embodiments, the sphingosine kinase 1 inhibitor is F-12509A or a variant
thereof (
Kono et al., J. Antibiot. 53(5):459-466, 2000). In some embodiments, the sphingosine kinase 1 inhibitor is (S)-N-(1-amino-1-iminopropan-2-yl)-4-octylbenzamide
hydrochloride (VPC-94075) or a variant thereof (
Pyne et al., Cancer Res. 71(21):6576-6582, 2012).
[0168] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine kinase 2 inhibitor (e.g.,
SCL-5081308 (SRX-224014). In some embodiments, the sphingosine kinase 2 inhibitor
is ABC-294640 (ABC-294735, ABC-747080, SKI-I, SKI-II, SKI-V, Yeliva
®, or opaganib) or a variant thereof (
Ding et al., Oncotarget 7(15):20080-20092, 2016;
Liu et al., PLoS One 7(7):r41834, 2012). In some embodiments, the sphingosine kinase 2 inhibitor is SLR080811 or a variant
thereof (
Kharel et al., Biochem. J. 447(1):149-157, 2012). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine kinase 1/2 inhibitor. For
example, a sphingosine kinase 1/2 inhibitor can have the following structure:

[0169] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine-1-phosphate receptor 2 (S1P2)
antagonist (e.g., AB-22, ONO-1266). In some embodiments, the SIP modulator targets
S1P2 and EDG5 antagonist. In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a sphingosine-1-phosphate
receptor 3 (S1P3) antagonist. For example, a S1P3 antagonist can be a small molecule
that has the following structure:

[0170] In some embodiments, a S1P modulator can also be a cannabinoid receptor antagonist
(e.g., oxfenmino hydrochloric acid).
Peptide and Fusion Protein Modulators
[0171] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a peptide (e.g., R-002L103 (R-002L106)).
In some embodiments, the S1P modulator can be a S1P1 agonist and a S1P3 agonist (e.g.,
R-002L103).
Inhibitory Nucleic Acids
[0173] An antisense nucleic acid molecule can be complementary to all or part of a non-coding
region of the coding strand of a nucleotide sequence encoding a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3,
S1P4, or S1P5 protein. Non-coding regions (5' and 3' untranslated regions) are the
5' and 3' sequences that flank the coding region in a gene and are not translated
into amino acids.
[0174] Based upon the sequences disclosed herein, one of skill in the art can easily choose
and synthesize any of a number of appropriate antisense nucleic acids to target a
nucleic acid encoding a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 protein described herein.
Antisense nucleic acids targeting a nucleic acid encoding a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4,
or S1P5 protein can be designed using the software available at the Integrated DNA
Technologies website.
[0175] An antisense nucleic acid can be, for example, about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40,
45, or 50 nucleotides or more in length. An antisense oligonucleotide can be constructed
using chemical synthesis and enzymatic ligation reactions using procedures known in
the art. For example, an antisense nucleic acid can be chemically synthesized using
naturally occurring nucleotides or variously modified nucleotides designed to increase
the biological stability of the molecules or to increase the physical stability of
the duplex formed between the antisense and sense nucleic acids, e.g., phosphorothioate
derivatives and acridine substituted nucleotides can be used.
[0176] Examples of modified nucleotides which can be used to generate an antisense nucleic
acid include 5-fluorouracil, 5-bromouracil, 5-chlorouracil, 5-iodouracil, hypoxanthine,
xanthine, 4-acetylcytosine, 5-(carboxyhydroxylmethyl) uracil, 5-carboxymethylaminomethyl-2-thiouridine,
5-carboxymethylaminomethyluracil, dihydrouracil, beta-D-galactosylqueosine, inosine,
N6-isopentenyladenine, 1-methylguanine, 1-methylinosine, 2,2-dimethylguanine, 2-methyladenine,
2-methylguanine, 3-methylcytosine, 5-methylcytosine, N6-adenine, 7-methylguanine,
5-methylaminomethyluracil, 5-methoxyaminomethyl-2-thiouracil, beta-D-mannosylqueosine,
5'-methoxycarboxymethyluracil, 5-methoxyuracil, 2-methylthio-N6-isopentenyladenine,
uracil-5-oxyacetic acid (v), wybutoxosine, pseudouracil, queosine, 2-thiocytosine,
5-methyl-2-thiouracil, 2-thiouracil, 4-thiouracil, 5-methyluracil, uracil-5-oxyacetic
acid methylester, uracil-5-oxyacetic acid (v), 5-methyl-2-thiouracil, 3-(3-amino-3-N-2-
carboxypropyl) uracil, (acp3)w, and 2,6-diaminopurine. Alternatively, the antisense
nucleic acid can be produced biologically using an expression vector into which a
nucleic acid has been subcloned in an antisense orientation (i.e., RNA transcribed
from the inserted nucleic acid will be of an antisense orientation to a target nucleic
acid of interest).
[0177] The antisense nucleic acid molecules described herein can be prepared in vitro and
administered to a mammal, e.g., a human. Alternatively, they can be generated in situ
such that they hybridize with or bind to cellular mRNA and/or genomic DNA encoding
a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 protein to thereby inhibit expression, e.g., by
inhibiting transcription and/or translation. The hybridization can be by conventional
nucleotide complementarities to form a stable duplex, or, for example, in the case
of an antisense nucleic acid molecule that binds to DNA duplexes, through specific
interactions in the major groove of the double helix. The antisense nucleic acid molecules
can be delivered to a mammalian cell using a vector (e.g., a lentivirus, a retrovirus,
or an adenovirus vector).
[0179] Another example of an inhibitory nucleic acid is a ribozyme that has specificity
for a nucleic acid encoding a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 protein (e.g., specificity
for a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA, e.g., specificity for any one of SEQ ID
NOs: 2, 4, 6, 8, and 10). Ribozymes are catalytic RNA molecules with ribonuclease
activity that are capable of cleaving a single-stranded nucleic acid, such as an mRNA,
to which they have a complementary region. Thus, ribozymes (e.g., hammerhead ribozymes
(described in
Haselhoff and Gerlach, Nature 334:585-591, 1988)) can be used to catalytically cleave mRNA transcripts to thereby inhibit translation
of the protein encoded by the mRNA.
[0180] A ribozyme having specificity for a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA can be designed
based upon the nucleotide sequence of any of the S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 cDNA
sequences disclosed herein. For example, a derivative of a Tetrahymena L-19 IVS RNA
can be constructed in which the nucleotide sequence of the active site is complementary
to the nucleotide sequence to be cleaved in a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA
(see, e.g.,
U.S. Patent. Nos. 4,987,071 and
5,116,742). Alternatively, a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA can be used to select a catalytic
RNA having a specific ribonuclease activity from a pool of RNA molecules. See, e.g.,
Bartel et al., Science 261:1411-1418, 1993. An inhibitory nucleic acid can also be a nucleic acid molecule that forms triple
helical structures. For example, expression of a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 polypeptide
can be inhibited by targeting nucleotide sequences complementary to the regulatory
region of the gene encoding the S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 polypeptide (e.g.,
the promoter and/or enhancer, e.g., a sequence that is at least 1 kb, 2 kb, 3 kb,
4 kb, or 5 kb upstream of the transcription initiation start state) to form triple
helical structures that prevent transcription of the gene in target cells. See generally
Helene, Anticancer Drug Des. 6(6):569-84, 1991;
Helene, Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 660:27-36, 1992; and
Maher, Bioassays 14(12):807-15, 1992.In various aspects of the disclosure, inhibitory nucleic acids can be modified at
the base moiety, sugar moiety, or phosphate backbone to improve, e.g., the stability,
hybridization, or solubility of the molecule. For example, the deoxyribose phosphate
backbone of the nucleic acids can be modified to generate peptide nucleic acids (see,
e.g.,
Hyrup et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. 4(1):5-23, 1996). Peptide nucleic acids (PNAs) are nucleic acid mimics, e.g., DNA mimics, in which
the deoxyribose phosphate backbone is replaced by a pseudopeptide backbone and only
the four natural nucleobases are retained. The neutral backbone of PNAs allows for
specific hybridization to DNA and RNA under conditions of low ionic strength. The
synthesis of PNA oligomers can be performed using standard solid phase peptide synthesis
protocols (see, e.g.,
Perry-O'Keefe et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 93:14670-675, 1996). PNAs can be used as antisense or antigene agents for sequence-specific modulation
of gene expression by, e.g., inducing transcription or translation arrest or inhibiting
replication.
[0181] PNAs can be modified, e.g., to enhance their stability or cellular uptake, by attaching
lipophilic or other helper groups to PNA, by the formation of PNA-DNA chimeras, or
by the use of liposomes or other techniques of drug delivery known in the art. For
example, PNA-DNA chimeras can be generated which may combine the advantageous properties
of PNA and DNA. Such chimeras allow DNA recognition enzymes, e.g., RNAse H and DNA
polymerases, to interact with the DNA portion while the PNA portion would provide
high binding affinity and specificity. PNA-DNA chimeras can be linked using linkers
of appropriate lengths selected in terms of base stacking, number of bonds between
the nucleobases, and orientation.
[0182] The synthesis of PNA-DNA chimeras can be performed as described in
Finn et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 24:3357-63, 1996. For example, a DNA chain can be synthesized on a solid support using standard phosphoramidite
coupling chemistry and modified nucleoside analogs. Compounds such as 5'-(4-methoxytrityl)amino-5'-deoxy-thymidine
phosphoramidite can be used as a link between the PNA and the 5' end of DNA (
Mag et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 17:5973-88, 1989). PNA monomers are then coupled in a stepwise manner to produce a chimeric molecule
with a 5' PNA segment and a 3' DNA segment (
Finn et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 24:3357-63, 1996). Alternatively, chimeric molecules can be synthesized with a 5' DNA segment and
a 3' PNA segment (
Peterser et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett. 5:1119-11124, 1975).
[0183] In some cases, the inhibitory nucleic acids can include other appended groups such
as peptides, or agents facilitating transport across the cell membrane (see,
Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 86:6553-6556, 1989;
Lemaitre et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 84:648-652, 1989; and
WO 88/09810). In addition, the inhibitory nucleic acids can be modified with hybridization-triggered
cleavage agents (see, e.g.,
Krol et al., Bio/Techniques 6:958-976, 1988) or intercalating agents (see, e.g.,
Zon, Pharm. Res. 5:539-549, 1988). To this end, the oligonucleotide may be conjugated to another molecule, e.g., a
peptide, hybridization triggered cross-linking agent, transport agent, hybridization-triggered
cleavage agent, etc.
[0184] Another means by which expression of a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA can be
decreased in a mammalian cell is by RNA interference (RNAi). RNAi is a process in
which mRNA is degraded in host cells. To inhibit an mRNA, double-stranded RNA (dsRNA)
corresponding to a portion of the gene to be silenced (e.g., a gene encoding a CD40
or CD40L polypeptide) is introduced into a mammalian cell. The dsRNA is digested into
21-23 nucleotide-long duplexes called short interfering RNAs (or siRNAs), which bind
to a nuclease complex to form what is known as the RNA-induced silencing complex (or
RISC). The RISC targets the homologous transcript by base pairing interactions between
one of the siRNA strands and the endogenous mRNA. It then cleaves the mRNA about 12
nucleotides from the 3' terminus of the siRNA (see
Sharp et al., Genes Dev. 15:485-490, 2001, and
Hammond et al., Nature Rev. Gen. 2:110-119, 2001).
[0185] RNA-mediated gene silencing can be induced in a mammalian cell in many ways, e.g.,
by enforcing endogenous expression of RNA hairpins (see,
Paddison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 99:1443-1448, 2002) or, as noted above, by transfection of small (21-23 nt) dsRNA (reviewed in
Caplen, Trends Biotech. 20:49-51, 2002). Methods for modulating gene expression with RNAi are described, e.g., in
U.S. Patent No. 6,506,559 and
US 2003/0056235A1.
[0186] Standard molecular biology techniques can be used to generate siRNAs. Short interfering
RNAs can be chemically synthesized, recombinantly produced, e.g., by expressing RNA
from a template DNA, such as a plasmid, or obtained from commercial vendors, such
as Dharmacon. The RNA used to mediate RNAi can include synthetic or modified nucleotides,
such as phosphorothioate nucleotides. Methods of transfecting cells with siRNA or
with plasmids engineered to make siRNA are routine in the art.
[0187] The siRNA molecules used to decrease expression of a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5
mRNA can vary in a number of ways. For example, they can include a 3' hydroxyl group
and strands of 21, 22, or 23 consecutive nucleotides. They can be blunt ended or include
an overhanging end at either the 3' end, the 5' end, or both ends. For example, at
least one strand of the RNA molecule can have a 3' overhang from about 1 to about
6 nucleotides (e.g., 1-5, 1-3, 2-4 or 3-5 nucleotides (whether pyrimidine or purine
nucleotides) in length. Where both strands include an overhang, the length of the
overhangs may be the same or different for each strand.
[0188] To further enhance the stability of the RNA duplexes, the 3' overhangs can be stabilized
against degradation (by, e.g., including purine nucleotides, such as adenosine or
guanosine nucleotides or replacing pyrimidine nucleotides by modified analogues (e.g.,
substitution of uridine 2-nucleotide 3' overhangs by 2'-deoxythymidine is tolerated
and does not affect the efficiency of RNAi). Any siRNA can be used in the methods
of decreasing a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 mRNA, provided it has sufficient homology
to the target of interest (e.g., a sequence present in any one of SEQ ID NOs: 2, 4,
6, 8, and 10, e.g., a target sequence encompassing the translation start site or the
first exon of the mRNA). There is no upper limit on the length of the siRNA that can
be used (e.g., the siRNA can range from about 21 base pairs of the gene to the full
length of the gene or more (e.g., about 20 to about 30 base pairs, about 50 to about
60 base pairs, about 60 to about 70 base pairs, about 70 to about 80 base pairs, about
80 to about 90 base pairs, or about 90 to about 100 base pairs).
[0189] Non-limiting examples of inhibitory nucleic acids targeting S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4,
or S1P5 include antisense DNA (e.g.,
Kim et al., J. Biol. Chem. 278(34):31731-31736, 2003), short interfering RNA (siRNA) (e.g.,
Li et al., Beijing Da Xue Bao Yi Xue Ban 48(6):987-993, 2016;
Hu et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 343(4):1038-1044, 2006;
Chiyo et al., Am. J. Transplant. 8(3):537-546, 2008), or combinations thereof.
[0190] In some disclosures, a therapeutically effective amount of an inhibitory nucleic
acid targeting a nucleic acid encoding a S1P1, S1P2, S1P3, S1P4, or S1P5 protein can
be administered to a subject (e.g., a human subject) in need thereof.
[0191] In some cases, the inhibitory nucleic acid can be about 10 nucleotides to about 40
nucleotides (e.g., about 10 to about 30 nucleotides, about 10 to about 25 nucleotides,
about 10 to about 20 nucleotides, about 10 to about 15 nucleotides, 10 nucleotides,
11 nucleotides, 12 nucleotides, 13 nucleotides, 14 nucleotides, 15 nucleotides, 16
nucleotides, 17 nucleotides, 18 nucleotides, 19 nucleotides, 20 nucleotides, 21 nucleotides,
22 nucleotides, 23 nucleotides, 24 nucleotides, 25 nucleotides, 26 nucleotides, 27
nucleotides, 28 nucleotides, 29 nucleotides, 30 nucleotides, 31 nucleotides, 32 nucleotides,
33 nucleotides, 34 nucleotides, 35 nucleotides, 36 nucleotides, 37 nucleotides, 38
nucleotides, 39 nucleotides, or 40 nucleotides) in length. One skilled in the art
will appreciate that inhibitory nucleic acids may comprise at least one modified nucleic
acid at either the 5' or 3'end of DNA or RNA.
[0193] As is known in the art, the term "thermal melting point (Tm)" refers to the temperature,
under defined ionic strength, pH, and inhibitory nucleic acid concentration, at which
50% of the inhibitory nucleic acids complementary to the target sequence hybridize
to the target sequence at equilibrium. In some cases, an inhibitory nucleic acid can
bind specifically to a target nucleic acid under stringent conditions, e.g., those
in which the salt concentration is at least about 0.01 to 1.0 M Na ion concentration
(or other salts) at pH 7.0 to 8.3 and the temperature is at least about 30 °C. for
short oligonucleotides (e.g., 10 to 50 nucleotide). Stringent conditions can also
be achieved with the addition of destabilizing agents such as formamide.
[0194] In some cases of the inhibitory nucleic acids described herein, the inhibitory nucleic
acid binds to a target nucleic acid (e.g., a nucleic acid encoding CD40 or CD40L)
with a T
m of greater than 20 °C, greater than 22 °C, greater than 24 °C, greater than 26 °C,
greater than 28 °C, greater than 30 °C, greater than 32 °C, greater than 34 °C, greater
than 36 °C, greater than 38 °C, greater than 40 °C, greater than 42 °C, greater than
44 °C, greater than 46 °C, greater than 48 °C, greater than 50 °C, greater than 52
°C, greater than 54 °C, greater than 56 °C, greater than 58 °C, greater than 60 °C,
greater than 62 °C, greater than 64 °C, greater than 66 °C, greater than 68 °C, greater
than 70 °C, greater than 72 °C, greater than 74 °C, greater than 76 °C, greater than
78 °C, or greater than 80 °C, e.g., as measured in phosphate buffered saline using
a UV spectrophotometer.
[0195] In some cases of the inhibitor nucleic acids described herein, the inhibitory nucleic
acid binds to a target nucleic acid (e.g., a nucleic acid encoding CD40 or CD40L)
with a T
m of about 20 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C,
about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about
58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C,
about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C, about 38 °C, about 36 °C, about 34 °C, about
32 °C, about 30 °C, about 28 °C, about 26 °C, about 24 °C, or about 22 °C (inclusive);
about 22 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about
70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C,
about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about
44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C, about 38 °C, about 36 °C, about 34 °C, about 32 °C,
about 30 °C, about 28 °C, about 26 °C, or about 24 °C (inclusive); about 24 °C to
about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about
68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C,
about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about
42 °C, about 40 °C, about 38 °C, about 36 °C, about 34 °C, about 32 °C, about 30 °C,
about 28 °C, or about 26 °C (inclusive); about 26 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C,
about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about
64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C,
about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C, about
38 °C, about 36 °C, about 34 °C, about 32 °C, about 30 °C, or about 28 °C (inclusive);
about 28 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about
70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C,
about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about
44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C, about 38 °C, about 36 °C, about 34 °C, about 32 °C,
or about 30 °C (inclusive); about 30 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C,
about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about
62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C,
about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C, about 38 °C, about
36 °C, about 34 °C, or about 32 °C (inclusive); about 32 °C to about 80 °C, about
78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C,
about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about
52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C,
about 38 °C, about 36 °C, or about 34 °C (inclusive); about 34 °C to about 80 °C,
about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about
66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C,
about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about
40 °C, about 38 °C, or about 36 °C (inclusive); about 36 °C to about 80 °C, about
78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C,
about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about
52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, about 40 °C,
or about 38 °C (inclusive); about 38 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C,
about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about
62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C,
about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about 44 °C, about 42 °C, or about 40 °C (inclusive); about
40 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70
°C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C,
about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, about
44 °C, or about 42 °C (inclusive); about 42 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about
76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C,
about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about
50 °C, about 48 °C, about 46 °C, or about 44 °C (inclusive); about 44 °C to about
80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C,
about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about
54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, about 48 °C, or about 46 °C (inclusive); about 46
°C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C,
about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about
56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, about 50 °C, or about 48 °C (inclusive); about 48
°C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C,
about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about
56 °C, about 54 °C, about 52 °C, or about 50 °C (inclusive); about 50 °C to about
80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C,
about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, about
54 °C, or about 52 °C (inclusive); about 52 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about
76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C,
about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C, about 56 °C, or about 54 °C (inclusive); about
54 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70
°C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about 62 °C, about 60 °C, about 58 °C,
or about 56 °C (inclusive); about 56 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C,
about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C, about 64 °C, about
62 °C, about 60 °C, or about 58 °C (inclusive); about 58 °C to about 80 °C, about
78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C,
about 64 °C, about 62 °C, or about 60 °C (inclusive); about 60 °C to about 80 °C,
about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about
66 °C, about 64 °C, or about 62 °C (inclusive); about 62 °C to about 80 °C, about
78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, about 66 °C,
or about 64 °C (inclusive); about 64 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C,
about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70 °C, about 68 °C, or about 66 °C (inclusive); about
66 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, about 70
°C, or about 68 °C (inclusive); about 68 °C to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76
°C, about 74 °C, about 72 °C, or about 70 °C (inclusive); about 70 °C to about 80
°C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, about 74 °C, or about 72 °C (inclusive); about 72 °C
to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, about 76 °C, or about 74 °C (inclusive); about 74 °C
to about 80 °C, about 78 °C, or about 76 °C (inclusive); about 76 °C to about 80 °C
or about 78 °C (inclusive); or about 78 °C to about 80 °C (inclusive),
[0196] In some cases, the inhibitory nucleic acid can be formulated in a nanoparticle (e.g.,
a nanoparticle including one or more synthetic polymers, e.g.,
Patil et al., Pharmaceutical Nanotechnol. 367:195-203, 2009;
Yang et al., ACS Appl. Mater. Interfaces, doi: 10.1021/acsami.6b16556, 2017;
Perepelyuk et al., Mol. Ther. Nucleic Acids 6:259-268, 2017). In some cases, the nanoparticle can be a mucoadhesive particle (e.g., nanoparticles
having a positively-charged exterior surface) (
Andersen et al., Methods Mol. Biol. 555:77-86, 2009). In some cases, the nanoparticle can have a neutrally-charged exterior surface.
[0197] In some cases, the inhibitory nucleic acid can be formulated, e.g., as a liposome
(
Buyens et al., J. Control Release 158(3): 362-370, 2012;
Scarabel et al., Expert Opin. Drug Deliv. 17:1-14, 2017), a micelle (e.g., a mixed micelle) (
Tangsangasaksri et al., BioMacromolecules 17:246-255, 2016;
Wu et al., Nanotechnology, doi: 10.1088/1361-6528/aa6519, 2017), a microemulsion (
WO 11/004395), a nanoemulsion, or a solid lipid nanoparticle
(Sahay et al., Nature Biotechnol. 31:653-658, 2013; and
Lin et al., Nanomedicine 9(1):105-120, 2014). Additional exemplary structural features of inhibitory nucleic acids and formulations
of inhibitory nucleic acids are described in
US 2016/0090598.
[0198] In some embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition can include a sterile saline solution
and one or more inhibitory nucleic acid (e.g., any of the inhibitory nucleic acids
described herein). In some examples, a pharmaceutical composition consists of a sterile
saline solution and one or more inhibitory nucleic acid (e.g., any of the inhibitory
nucleic acids described herein). In certain embodiments, the sterile saline is a pharmaceutical
grade saline. In certain embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition can include one
or more inhibitory nucleic acid (e.g., any of the inhibitory nucleic acids described
herein) and sterile water. In certain embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition consists
of one or more inhibitory nucleic acid (e.g., any of the inhibitory nucleic acids
described herein) and sterile water. In certain embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition
includes one or more inhibitory nucleic acid (e.g., any of the inhibitory nucleic
acids described herein) and phosphate-buffered saline (PBS). In certain embodiments,
a pharmaceutical composition consists of one or more inhibitory nucleic acids (e.g.,
any of the inhibitory nucleic acids described herein) and sterile phosphate-buffered
saline (PBS). In some examples, the sterile saline is a pharmaceutical grade PBS.
[0199] In certain cases, one or more inhibitory nucleic acids (e.g., any of the inhibitory
nucleic acids described herein) may be admixed with pharmaceutically acceptable active
and/or inert substances for the preparation of pharmaceutical compositions or formulations.
Compositions and methods for the formulation of pharmaceutical compositions depend
on a number of criteria, including, but not limited to, route of administration, extent
of disease, or dose to be administered.
[0200] Pharmaceutical compositions including one or more inhibitory nucleic acids encompass
any pharmaceutically acceptable salts, esters, or salts of such esters. Non-limiting
examples of pharmaceutical compositions include pharmaceutically acceptable salts
of inhibitory nucleic acids. Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but
are not limited to, sodium and potassium salts.
[0201] Also provided herein are prodrugs that can include additional nucleosides at one
or both ends of an inhibitory nucleic acid which are cleaved by endogenous nucleases
within the body, to form the active inhibitory nucleic acid.
[0202] Lipid moieties can be used to formulate an inhibitory nucleic acid. In certain such
methods, the inhibitory nucleic acid is introduced into preformed liposomes or lipoplexes
made of mixtures of cationic lipids and neutral lipids. In certain methods, inhibitory
nucleic acid complexes with mono- or poly-cationic lipids are formed without the presence
of a neutral lipid. In certain cases, a lipid moiety is selected to increase distribution
of an inhibitory nucleic acid to a particular cell or tissue in a mammal. In some
examples, a lipid moiety is selected to increase distribution of an inhibitory nucleic
acid to fat tissue in a mammal. In certain cases, a lipid moiety is selected to increase
distribution of an inhibitory nucleic acid to muscle tissue.
[0203] In certain cases, pharmaceutical compositions provided herein can include one or
more inhibitory nucleic acid and one or more excipients. In certain such cases, excipients
are selected from water, salt solutions, alcohol, polyethylene glycols, gelatin, lactose,
amylase, magnesium stearate, talc, silicic acid, viscous paraffin, hydroxymethylcellulose,
and polyvinylpyrrolidone.
[0204] In some examples, a pharmaceutical composition provided herein includes liposomes
and emulsions. Liposomes and emulsions can be used to formulate hydrophobic compounds.
In some examples, certain organic solvents, such as dimethylsulfoxide, are used.
[0205] In some examples, a pharmaceutical composition provided herein includes one or more
tissue-specific delivery molecules designed to deliver one or more inhibitory nucleic
acids to specific tissues or cell types in a mammal. For example, a pharmaceutical
composition can include liposomes coated with a tissue-specific antibody.
[0206] In some embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition provided herein can include a co-solvent
system. Examples of such co-solvent systems include benzyl alcohol, a nonpolar surfactant,
a water-miscible organic polymer, and an aqueous phase. A non-limiting example of
such a co-solvent system is the VPD co-solvent system, which is a solution of absolute
ethanol comprising 3% w/v benzyl alcohol, 8% w/v of the nonpolar surfactant Polysorbate
80
™ and 65% w/v polyethylene glycol 300. As can be appreciated, other surfactants may
be used instead of Polysorbate 80
™; the fraction size of polyethylene glycol may be varied; other biocompatible polymers
may replace polyethylene glycol, e.g., polyvinyl pyrrolidone; and other sugars or
polysaccharides may substitute for dextrose. Any of the pharmaceutical compositions
described herein can be delivered locally to a subject using any of the devices described
herein.
[0207] In some examples, an inhibitory nucleic acid can be formulated to include a carrier
and is formulated in aqueous solution, such as water or physiologically compatible
buffers such as Hanks's solution, Ringer's solution, or physiological saline buffer.
In some examples, other ingredients are included (e.g., ingredients that aid in solubility
or serve as preservatives). In some examples, an inhibitory nucleic acid can be formulated
as a suspension and can be prepared using appropriate liquid carriers, suspending
agents, and the like. An inhibitory nucleic acid can be formulated as a suspension,
solution, or emulsion in oily or aqueous vehicles prior to intrathecal administration
using any of the devices described herein, and may contain formulatory agents such
as suspending, stabilizing, and/or dispersing agents. Solvents suitable for formulating
an inhibitory nucleic acid include, but are not limited to, lipophilic solvents and
fatty oils, such as sesame oil, synthetic fatty acid esters, such as ethyl oleate
or triglycerides, and liposomes.
Antibodies
[0208] In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment/portion
thereof (e.g., a Fab or a scFv). In some embodiments, the S1P modulator is a humanized
antibody, a chimeric antibody, a multivalent antibody, or a fragment thereof. In some
embodiments, the S1P modulator is a monoclonal antibody. In some embodiments, the
S1P modulator is a humanized monoclonal antibody. In some embodiments, the S1P modulator
is an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment/portion thereof (e.g., a Fab or a scFv)
that is a S1P antagonist.
[0209] In some embodiments, the antibody can be a humanized antibody, a chimeric antibody,
a multivalent antibody, or a fragment thereof. In some embodiments, an antibody can
be a scFv-Fc (
Sokolowska-Wedzina et al., Mol. Cancer Res. 15(8):1040-1050, 2017), a VHH domain (
Li et al., Immunol. Lett. 188:89-95, 2017), a VNAR domain (
Hasler et al., Mol. Immunol. 75:28-37, 2016), a (scFv)
2, a minibody (
Kim et al., PLoS One 10(1):e113442, 2014), or a BiTE. In some embodiments, an antibody can be a DVD-Ig (
Wu et al., Nat. Biotechnol. 25(11):1290-1297, 2007;
WO 08/024188;
WO 07/024715), and a dual-affinity re-targeting antibody (DART) (
Tsai et al., Mol. Ther. Oncolytics 3:15024, 2016), a triomab (
Chelius et al., MAbs 2(3):309-319, 2010), kih IgG with a common LC (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), a crossmab (
Regula et al., EMBO Mol. Med. 9(7):985, 2017), an ortho-Fab IgG (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), a 2-in-1-IgG (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), IgG-scFv (
Cheal et al., Mol. Cancer Ther. 13(7):1803-1812, 2014), scFv2-Fc (
Natsume et al., J. Biochem. 140(3):359-368, 2006), a bi-nanobody (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), tandem antibody (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), a DART-Fc (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), a scFv-HSA-scFv (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), DNL-Fab3 (
Kontermann et al., Drug Discovery Today 20(7):838-847, 2015), DAF (two-in-one or four-in-one), DutaMab, DT-IgG, knobs-in-holes common LC, knobs-in-holes
assembly, charge pair antibody, Fab-arm exchange antibody, SEEDbody, Triomab, LUZ-Y,
Fcab, kλ-body, orthogonal Fab, DVD-IgG, IgG(H)-scFv, scFv-(H)IgG, IgG(L)-scFv, scFv-(L)-IgG,
IgG (L,H)-Fc, IgG(H)-V, V(H)-IgG, IgG(L)-V, V(L)-IgG, KIH IgG-scFab, 2scFv-IgG, IgG-2scFv,
scFv4-Ig, Zybody, DVI-IgG, nanobody (e.g., antibodies derived from
Camelus bactriamus, Calelus dromaderius, or
Lama paccos) (
U.S. Patent No. 5,759,808;
Stijlemans et al., J. Biol. Chem. 279:1256-1261, 2004;
Dumoulin et al., Nature 424:783-788, 2003; and
Pleschberger et al., Bioconjugate Chem. 14:440-448, 2003), nanobody-HSA, a diabody (e.g.,
Poljak, Structure 2(12): 1121-1123, 1994;
Hudson et al., J. Immunol. Methods 23(1-2):177-189, 1999), a TandAb (
Reusch et al., mAbs 6(3):727-738, 2014), scDiabody (
Cuesta et al., Trends in Biotechnol. 28(7):355-362, 2010), scDiabody-CH3 (
Sanz et al., Trends in Immunol. 25(2):85-91, 2004), Diabody-CH3 (Guo et al., , Triple Body, miniantibody, minibody, TriBi minibody,
scFv-CH3 KIH, Fab-scFv, scFv-CH-CL-scFv, F(ab')2-scFV2, scFv-KIH, Fab-scFv-Fc, tetravalent
HCAb, scDiabody-Fc, diabody-Fc, tandem scFv-Fc, intrabody (
Huston et al., Human Antibodies 10(3-4):127-142, 2001;
Wheeler et al., Mol. Ther. 8(3):355-366, 2003;
Stocks, Drug Discov. Today 9(22):960-966, 2004), dock and lock bispecific antibody, ImmTAC, HSAbody, scDiabody-HSA, tandem scFv,
IgG-IgG, Cov-X-Body, and scFv 1-PEG-scFv2.
[0210] Non-limiting examples of an antigen-binding fragment of an antibody include an Fv
fragment, a Fab fragment, a F(ab')
2 fragment, and a Fab' fragment. Additional examples of an antigen-binding fragment
of an antibody is an antigen-binding fragment of an IgG (e.g., an antigen-binding
fragment of IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, or IgG4) (e.g., an antigen-binding fragment of a human
or humanized IgG, e.g., human or humanized IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, or IgG4); an antigen-binding
fragment of an IgA (e.g., an antigen-binding fragment of IgA1 or IgA2) (e.g., an antigen-binding
fragment of a human or humanized IgA, e.g., a human or humanized IgA1 or IgA2); an
antigen-binding fragment of an IgD (e.g., an antigen-binding fragment of a human or
humanized IgD); an antigen-binding fragment of an IgE (e.g., an antigen-binding fragment
of a human or humanized IgE); or an antigen-binding fragment of an IgM (e.g., an antigen-binding
fragment of a human or humanized IgM).
[0211] In some embodiments, an antibody can be an IgNAR, a bispecific antibody (
Milstein and Cuello, Nature 305:537-539, 1983;
Suresh et al., Methods in Enzymology 121:210, 1986;
WO 96/27011;
Brennan et al., Science 229:81, 1985;
Shalaby et al., J. Exp. Med. 175:217-225, 1992;
Kolstelny et al., J. Immunol. 148(5):1547-1553, 1992;
Hollinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 90:6444-6448, 1993;
Gruber et al., J. Immunol. 152:5368, 1994;
Tutt et al., J. Immunol. 147:60, 1991), a bispecific diabody, a triabody (
Schoonooghe et al., BMC Biotechnol. 9:70, 2009), a tetrabody, scFv-Fc knobs-into-holes, a scFv-Fc-scFv, a (Fab'scFv)
2, a V-IgG, a IvG-V, a dual V domain IgG, a heavy chain immunoglobulin or a camelid
(
Holt et al., Trends Biotechnol. 21(11):484-490, 2003), an intrabody, a monoclonal antibody (e.g., a human or humanized monoclonal antibody),
a heteroconjugate antibody (e.g.,
U.S. Patent No. 4,676,980), a linear antibody (
Zapata et al., Protein Eng. 8(10:1057-1062, 1995), a trispecific antibody (
Tutt et al., J. Immunol. 147:60, 1991), a Fabs-in-Tandem immunoglobulin (
WO 15/103072), or a humanized camelid antibody.
[0212] In some embodiments, the antibody is a humanized antibody, a chimeric antibody, a
multivalent antibody, or a fragment thereof. In some embodiments, the antibody is
a monoclonal antibody. In some embodiments, the antibody is a humanized monoclonal
antibody. See e.g.,
Hunter & Jones, Nat. Immunol. 16:448-457, 2015;
Heo et al., Oncotarget 7(13):15460-15473, 2016. Additional examples of antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof are described
in
U.S. Patent Nos. 8,440,196;
7,842,144;
8,034,344; and
8,529,895;
US 2013/0317203;
US 2014/0322239;
US 2015/0166666;
US 2016/0152714; and
US 2017/0002082, each of which is incorporated by reference in its entirety.
[0213] In certain embodiments, the S1P modulator is an S1P antagonist that comprises or
consists of an antigen-binding fragment or portion of EDD7H9 (7H9). In certain embodiments,
the S1P modulator is an S1P antagonist that comprises or consists of an antigen-binding
fragment or portion of sphingomab
™ (sonepcizumab, iSONEP, ASONEP, LT-1002, LT-1009) (
Pal et al., Cancer 123(4):576-582, 2017;
Lukowski et al., J. Glaucoma 22(2): 145-151, 2013).
[0214] In some embodiments, any of the antibodies or antigen-binding fragments described
herein has a dissociation constant (K
D) of less than 1 × 10
-5 M (e.g., less than 0.5 × 10
-5 M, less than 1 × 10
-6 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-6 M, less than 1 × 10
-7 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-7 M, less than 1 × 10
-8 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-8 M, less than 1 × 10
-9 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-9 M, less than 1 × 10
-10 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-10 M, less than 1 × 10
-11 M, less than 0.5 × 10
-11 M, or less than 1 × 10
-12 M), e.g., as measured in phosphate buffered saline using surface plasmon resonance
(SPR).
[0215] In some embodiments, any of the antibodies or antigen-binding fragments described
herein has a K
D of about 1 × 10
-12 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, about 1 × 10
-9 M, about 0.5 × 10
-9 M, about 1 × 10
-10 M, about 0.5 × 10
-10 M, about 1 × 10
-11 M, or about 0.5 × 10
-11 M (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-11 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, about 1 × 10
-9 M, about 0.5 × 10
-9 M, about 1 × 10
-10 M, about 0.5 × 10
-10 M, or about 1 × 10
-11 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-11 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, about 1 × 10
-9 M, about 0.5 × 10
-9 M, about 1 × 10
-10 M, or about 0.5 × 10
-10 M (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-10 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, about 1 × 10
-9 M, about 0.5 × 10
-9 M, or about 1 × 10
-10 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-10 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, about 1 × 10
-9 M, or about 0.5 × 10
-9 M (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-9 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, about 0.5 × 10
-8 M, or about 1 × 10
-9 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-9 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, about 1 × 10
-8 M, or about 0.5 × 10
-8 M (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-8 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7 M, about 0.5 × 10
-7 M, or about 1 × 10
-8 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-8 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, about 1 × 10
-7M, or about 0.5 × 10
-7 M
[0216] (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-7 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, about 0.5 × 10
-6 M, or about 1 × 10
-7 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-7 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, about 1 × 10
-6 M, or about 0.5 × 10
-6 M (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-6 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M, about 0.5 × 10
-5 M, or about 1 × 10
-6 M (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-6 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M or about 0.5 × 10
-5 M (inclusive); or about 0.5 × 10
-5 M to about 1 × 10
-5 M (inclusive), e.g., as measured in phosphate buffered saline using surface plasmon
resonance (SPR).
[0217] In some embodiments, any of the antibodies or antigen-binding fragments described
herein has a K
off of about 1 × 10
-6 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 1 × 10
-4 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-4 s
-1, about 1 × 10
-5 s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
-5 s
-1 (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-5 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 1 × 10
-4 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-4 s
-1, or about 1 × 10
-5 s
-1 (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-5 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 1 × 10
-4 s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
-4 s
-1 (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
-4 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
-3 s
-1, or about 1 × 10
-4 s
-1 (inclusive); about 1 × 10
-4 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
-3 s
-1 (inclusive); or about 0.5 × 10
-5 s
-1 to about 1 × 10
-3 s
-1 (inclusive), e.g., as measured in phosphate buffered saline using surface plasmon
resonance (SPR).
[0218] In some embodiments, any of the antibodies or antigen-binding fragments described
herein has a K
on of about 1 × 10
2 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
3 M
-1s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
3 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
3 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1, or about 1 × 10
3 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 1 × 10
3 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1 , about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1, or about 1 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 1 × 10
4 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 1 × 10
5M
-1s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 0.5 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, or about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); about 1 × 10
5 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1, or about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1 (inclusive); or about 0.5 × 10
6 M
-1s
-1 to about 1 × 10
6M
-1s
-1 (inclusive), e.g., as measured in phosphate buffered saline using surface plasmon
resonance (SPR).
Co-Administration
[0219] In some embodiments of any of the methods described herein, the S1P modulator can
be co-administered with a different therapeutic agent. For example, a S1P modulator
can be co-administered with an interferon beta agonist (e.g., avonex, betaseron, Rebif
®), an anti-TNFα agent, an immunomodulatory agent (e.g., copaxone), or an IL-12/IL-23
agonist. Additional examples of agents that can be co-administered with a S1P modulator
are described herein.
via an Ingestible Devices
[0220] As discussed herein, in some cases, a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal
tract comprises administering to the subject a pharmaceutical formulation wherein
the pharmaceutical formulation is delivered to the cecum by one of various methods.
For example, the pharmaceutical formulation may be delivered via an ingestible device
; the pharmaceutical formulation may be a solid dosage form, a liquid dosage form,
a suppository or an enema for rectal administration with different types of release
such as sustained or delayed release.
[0221] In one cases, the pharmaceutical formulation is delivered to the cecum by an ingestible
device containing the pharmaceutical formulation.
[0222] The GI tract can be imaged using endoscopes, or more recently, by ingestible devices
that are swallowed. Direct visualization of the GI mucosa is useful to detect subtle
mucosal alterations, as in inflammatory bowel diseases, as well as any flat or sessile
lesions.
[0223] As discussed herein, in some embodiments, the method of treating a disease of the
gastrointestinal tract comprises administering to the subject a pharmaceutical formulation.
In some cases, the pharmaceutical formulation is delivered to the cecum by one of
various methods. For example, the pharmaceutical formulation may be delivered via
a medical device such as an ingestible device; the pharmaceutical formulation may
be a solid dosage form, a liquid dosage form, a suppository or an enema for rectal
administration with different types of release such as sustained or delayed release.
[0224] In one case, the pharmaceutical formulation is delivered to the cecum by an ingestible
device containing the pharmaceutical formulation .
[0225] Ingestible devices are advantageous over spray catheters in that they are less invasive,
thereby allowing for regular dosing more frequently than spray catheters. Another
advantage of ingestible devices is the greater ease with which they can access, relative
to a catheter, certain sections of the GI tract such as the ascending colon, the cecum,
and all portions of the small intestine.
Methods and Mechanisms for Localization
[0226] In addition to, or as an alternative, to directly visualizing the GI tract, one or
more different mechanisms can be used to determine the location of an ingestible device
within the GI tract. Various implementations may be used for localization of ingestible
devices within the GI tract.
[0227] For example, certain implementations can include one or more electromagnetic sensor
coils, magnetic fields, electromagnetic waves, electric potential values, ultrasound
positioning systems, gamma scintigraphy techniques or other radio-tracker technology
have been described by others. Alternatively, imaging can be used to localize, for
example, using anatomical landmarks or more complex algorithms for 3D reconstruction
based on multiple images. Other technologies rely on radio frequency, which relies
on sensors placed externally on the body to receive the strength of signals emitted
by the capsule. Ingestible devices may also be localized based on reflected light
in the medium surrounding the device; pH; temperature; time following ingestion; and/or
acoustic signals.
[0228] The disclosure provides an ingestible device, as well as related systems and methods
that provide for determining the position of the ingestible device within the GI tract
of a subject with very high accuracy. In some embodiments, the ingestible device can
autonomously determine its position within the GI tract of the subject.
[0229] Typically, the ingestible device includes one or more processing devices, and one
more machine readable hardware storage devices. In some cases, the one or more machine
readable hardware storage devices store instructions that are executable by the one
or more processing devices to determine the location of the ingestible device in a
portion of a GI tract of the subject. In certain cases, the one or more machine readable
hardware storage devices store instructions that are executable by the one or more
processing devices to transmit data to an external device (e.g., a base station external
to the subject, such as a base station carried on an article worn by the subject)
capable of implementing the data to determine the location of the device within the
GI tract of the subject.
[0230] In some disclosures, the location of the ingestible device within the cecum of the
subject can be determined to an accuracy of at least 85%, e.g., at least 90%, at least
95%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, 100%. An exemplary and non-limiting
disclosure is provided below in Example 14.
[0231] As used herein, the term "reflectance" refers to a value derived from light emitted
by the device, reflected back to the device, and received by a detector in or on the
device. For example, in some cases this refers to light emitted by the device, wherein
a portion of the light is reflected by a surface external to the device, and the light
is received by a detector located in or on the device.
[0232] As used herein, the term "illumination" refers to any electromagnetic emission. In
some cases, an illumination may be within the range of Infrared Light (IR), the visible
spectrum and ultraviolet light (UV), and an illumination may have a majority of its
power centered at a particular wavelength in the range of 100nm to 1000nm. In some
cases, it may be advantageous to use an illumination with a majority of its power
limited to one of the infrared (750nm-1000nm), red (600nm-750nm), green (495nm-600nm),
blue (400nm-495nm), or ultraviolet (100nm-400nm) spectrums. In some cases a plurality
of illuminations with different wavelengths may be used. One option is to use green
or blue spectrums of light. However, it is understood that one may use any suitable
light having a wavelength that is substantially or approximately within the green
or blue spectra defined above, and the localization systems and methods described
herein may use any suitable spectra of light.
[0233] Referring now to FIG. 1, shown therein is a view of an example of an ingestible device
100, which may be used to identify a location within a gastrointestinal (GI) tract.
In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may be configured to autonomously determine
whether it is located in the stomach, a particular portion of the small intestine
such as a duodenum, jejunum, or ileum, or the large intestine by utilizing sensors
operating with different wavelengths of light. Additionally, ingestible device 100
may be configured to autonomously determine whether it is located within certain portions
of the small intestine or large intestine, such as the duodenum, the jejunum, the
cecum, or the colon.
[0234] Ingestible device 100 may have a housing 102 shaped similar to a pill or capsule.
The housing 102 of ingestible device 100 may have a first end portion 104, and a second
end portion 106. The first end portion 104 may include a first wall portion 108, and
second end portion 106 may include a second wall portion 110. In some cases, the first
end portion 104 and second end portion 106 of ingestible device 100 may be manufactured
separately, and may be affixed together by a connecting portion 112.
[0235] In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may include an optically transparent window
114. Optically transparent window 114 may be transparent to various types of illumination
in the visible spectrum, infrared spectrum, or ultraviolet light spectrum, and ingestible
device 100 may have various sensors and illuminators located within the housing 102,
and behind the transparent window 114. This may allow ingestible device 100 to be
configured to transmit illumination at different wavelengths through transparent window
114 to an environment external to housing 102 of ingestible device 100, and to detect
a reflectance from a portion of the illumination that is reflected back through transparent
window 114 from the environment external to housing 102. Ingestible device 100 may
then use the detected level of reflectance in order to determine a location of ingestible
device 100 within a GI tract. In some cases, the optically transparent window 114
may be of any shape and size, and may wrap around the circumference of ingestible
device 100. In this case, ingestible device 100 may have multiple sets of sensors
and illuminators positioned at different locations azimuthally behind window 114.
[0236] In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may optionally include an opening 116 in
the second wall portion 110. In some cases, the second wall portion 110 may be configured
to rotate around the longitudinal axis of ingestible device 100 (e.g., by means of
a suitable motor or other actuator housed within ingestible device 100). This may
allow ingestible device 100 to release a substance into the GI tract, through opening
116.
[0237] FIG. 2 shows an exploded view of ingestible device 100. In some cases, the ingestible
device 100 may optionally include a rotation assembly 118. Optional rotation assembly
118 may include a motor 118-1 driven by a microcontroller (e.g., a microcontroller
coupled to printed circuit board 120), a rotation position sensing ring 118-2, and
a storage sub-unit 118-3 configured to fit snugly within the second end portion 104.
In some cases, the rotation assembly 118 may cause second end portion 104, and opening
116, to rotate relative to the storage sub-unit 118-3. In some cases, there may be
cavities on the side of storage sub-unit 118-3 that function as storage chambers.
When the opening 116 is aligned with a cavity on the side of the storage sub-unit
118-3, the cavity on the side of the storage sub-unit 118-3 may be exposed to the
environment external to the housing 102 of ingestible device 100. In some cases, the
storage sub-unit 118-3 may be loaded with a medicament or other substance prior to
the ingestible device 100 being administered to a subject. In this case, the medicament
or other substance may be released from the ingestible device 100 by aligning opening
116 with the cavity within storage sub-unit 118-3. Other ingestible devices capable
of releasing substances are discussed in commonly-assigned
PCT Application WO/2013/120184filed February 15, 2013, commonly-assigned U.S. Provisional publication
US2018/0070857A1. It is understood that any suitable method of releasing substances may be incorporated
into some of the examples of the ingestible devices disclosed herein, and that the
systems and methods for determining a location of an ingestible device may be incorporated
into any suitable type of ingestible device.
[0238] Ingestible device 100 may include a printed circuit board (PCB) 120, and a battery
128 configured to power PCB 120. PCB 120 may include a programmable microcontroller,
and control and memory circuitry for holding and executing firmware or software for
coordinating the operation of ingestible device 100, and the various components of
ingestible device 100. For example, PCB 120 may include memory circuitry for storing
data, such as data sets of measurements collected by sensing sub-unit 126, or instructions
to be executed by control circuitry to implement a localization process, such as,
for example, one or more of the processes, discussed herein, including those discussed
below in connection with one or more of the associated flow charts. PCB 120 may include
a detector 122 and an illuminator 124, which together form sensing sub-unit 126. In
some cases, the control circuitry within PCB 120 may include processing units, communication
circuitry, or any other suitable type of circuitry for operating ingestible device
100. For illustrative purposes, only a single detector 122 and a single illuminator
124 forming a single sensing sub-unit 126 are shown. However, it is understood that
in some cases there may be multiple sensing sub-units, each with a separate illuminator
and detector, within ingestible device 100. For example, there may be several sensing
sub-units spaced azimuthally around the circumference of the PCB 120, which may enable
ingestible device 100 to transmit illumination and detect reflectances or ambient
light in all directions around the circumference of the device. In some cases, the
sensing sub-unit 126 may be configured to generate an illumination using illuminator
124, which is directed through the window 114 in a radial direction away from ingestible
device 100. This illumination may reflect off of the environment external to ingestible
device 100, and the reflected light coming back into ingestible device 100 through
window 114 may be detected as a reflectance by detector 122.
[0239] In some cases, the window 114 may be of any suitable shape and size. For example,
window 114 may extend around a full circumference of ingestible device 100. In some
cases there may be a plurality of sensing sub-units (e.g., similar to sensing sub-unit
126) located at different positions behind the window. For example, three sensing
sub-units may be positioned behind the window at the same longitudinal location, but
spaced 120 degrees apart azimuthally. This may enable ingestible device 100 to transmit
illuminations in all directions radially around ingestible device 100, and to measure
each of the corresponding reflectances.
[0240] In some cases, the illuminator 124 may be capable of producing illumination at a
variety of different wavelengths in the ultraviolet, infrared, or visible spectrum.
For example, illuminator 124 may be implemented by using Red-Green-Blue Light-Emitting
diode packages (RGB-LED). These types of RGB-LED packages are able to transmit red,
blue, or green illumination, or combinations of red, blue, or green illumination.
Similarly, detector 122 may be configured to sense reflected light of the same wavelengths
as the illumination produced by illuminator 124. For example, if illuminator 124 is
configured to produce red, blue, or green illumination, detector 122 may be configured
to detect different reflectances produced by red, blue, or green illumination (e.g.,
through the use of an appropriately configured photodiode). These detected reflectances
may be stored by ingestible device 100 (e.g., within memory circuitry of PCB 120),
and may then be used by ingestible device 100 in determining a location of ingestible
device 100 within the GI tract (e.g., through the use of process 500 (FIG. 5), process
600 (FIG. 6), or process 900 (FIG. 9)).
[0241] It is understood that ingestible device 100 is intended to be illustrative, and not
limiting. It will be understood that modifications to the general shape and structure
of the various devices and mechanisms described in relation to FIG. 1 and FIG. 2 may
be made without significantly changing the functions and operations of the devices
and mechanisms. For example, ingestible device 100 may have a housing formed from
a single piece of molded plastic, rather than being divided into a first end portion
104 and a second end portion 106. As an alternate example, the location of window
114 within ingestible device 100 may be moved to some other location, such as the
center of ingestible device 100, or to one of the ends of ingestible device 100. Moreover,
the systems and methods discussed in relation to FIGS. 1-10 may be implemented on
any suitable type of ingestible device, provided that the ingestible device is capable
of detecting reflectances or levels of illumination in some capacity. For example,
in some cases the ingestible device 100 may be modified to replace detector 122 with
an image sensor, and the ingestible device may be configured to measure relative levels
of red, blue, or green light by decomposing a recorded image into its individual spectral
components. Other examples of ingestible devices with localization capabilities, which
may be utilized in order to implement the systems and methods discussed in relation
to FIG. 1-11, are discussed in co-owned
PCT Application WO/2016/049602filed on September 25, 2015.
[0242] FIG. 3 is a diagram of an ingestible device during an example transit through a gastrointestinal
(GI) tract, in accordance with some aspects of the disclosure. Ingestible device 300
may include any portion of any other ingestible device discussed in this disclosure
(e.g., ingestible device 100 (FIG. 1)), and may be any suitable type of ingestible
device with localization capabilities. For example, ingestible device 300 may be one
of an ingestible device 100 without the optional opening 116 (FIG. 1) or optional
rotation assembly 118 (FIG. 2)). In some cases, the ingestible device 300 may be ingested
by a subject, and as ingestible device 300 traverses the GI tract, ingestible device
300 may be configured to determine its location within the GI tract. For example,
the movement of ingestible device 300 and the amount of light detected by ingestible
device 300 (e.g., via detector 122 (FIG. 2)) may vary substantially depending on the
location of ingestible device 300 within the GI tract, and ingestible device 300 may
be configured to use this information to determine a location of ingestible device
300 within the GI tract. For instance, ingestible device 300 may detect ambient light
from the surrounding environment, or reflectances based on illumination generated
by ingestible device 300 (e.g., generated by illuminator 124 (FIG. 1)), and use this
information to determine a location of ingestible device 300 through processes, such
as described herein. The current location of ingestible device 300, and the time that
ingestible device 300 detected each transition between the various portions of the
GI tract, may then be stored by ingestible device 300 (e.g., in memory circuitry of
PCB 120 (FIG. 2)), and may be used for any suitable purpose.
[0243] Shortly after ingestible device 300 is ingested, ingestible device will traverse
the esophagus 302, which may connect the subject's mouth to a stomach 306. In some
cases ,the ingestible device 300 may be configured to determine that it has entered
the esophagus portion GI tract by measuring the amount and type of light (e.g., via
detector 122 (FIG. 2)) in the environment surrounding the ingestible device 300. For
instance, ingestible device 300 may detect higher levels of light in the visible spectrum
(e.g., via detector 122 (FIG. 2)) while outside the subject's body, as compared to
the levels of light detected while within the GI tract. In some cases, the ingestible
device 300 may have previously stored data (e.g., on memory circuitry of PCB 120 (FIG.
2)) indicating a typical level of light detected when outside of the body, and the
ingestible device 300 may be configured to determine that entry to the body has occurred
when a detected level of light (e.g., detected via detector 122 (FIG. 2)) has been
reduced beyond a threshold level (e.g., at least a 20-30% reduction) for a sufficient
period of time (e.g., 5.0 seconds).
[0244] In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may also be configured to monitor for one
or more transitions. Such transitions can include an ileoceacal transition from the
ileum to the cecum, a transition from the cecum to the colon, or detect exit from
the body (e.g., by measuring reflectances, temperature, or levels of ambient light).
[0245] FIG. 7 is a plot illustrating data collected during an example operation of an ingestible
device (e.g., ingestible device 100, 300, or 400), which may be used when determining
a location of an ingestible device as it transits through a gastrointestinal (GI)
tract, in accordance with some aspects of the disclosure.
[0246] Although FIG. 7 may be described in connection with ingestible device 100 for illustrative
purposes, this is not intended to be limiting, and plot 700 and data set 702 may be
typical of data gathered by any device discussed in this application. Plot 700 depicts
the ratios of the measured green reflectance levels to the measured blue reflectance
levels over time. For example, ingestible device 100 may have computed the value for
each point in the data set 702 by transmitting green and blue illumination at a given
time (e.g., via illuminator 124 (FIG. 2)), measuring the resulting green and blue
reflectances (e.g., via detector 122 (FIG. 2)), calculating the ratio of the resulting
reflectances, and storing the ratio in the data set along with a timestamp indicating
the time that the reflectances were gathered.
[0247] At 704, shortly after ingestible device 100 begins operation, ingestible device 100
determines that it has reached at least the stomach (e.g., as a result of making a
determination similar to the determination discussed in relation to 506 in process
500 (FIG. 5)). Ingestible device 100 continues to gather additional measurements of
green and blue reflectance levels, and at 706 ingestible device 100 determines that
a pyloric transition has occurred from the stomach to the duodenum (e.g., as a result
of making a determination similar to the determinations discussed in relation to 616-624
of process 600 (FIG. 6)). Notably, the values in data set 702 around 706 jump up precipitously,
which is indicative of the higher ratios of measured green reflectance levels to measured
blue reflectance levels typical of the duodenum.
[0248] The remainder of the data set 702 depicts the ratios of the measured green reflectance
levels to the measured blue reflectance levels throughout the remainder of the GI
tract. At 708, ingestible device 100 has reached the jejunum (e.g., as determined
through measurements of muscle contractions, as discussed in relation to FIG. 9),
and by 710, ingestible device 100 has reached the cecum. It is understood that, in
some cases, the overall character and appearance of data set 702 changes within the
small intestine (i.e., the duodenum, jejunum, and ileum) versus the cecum. Within
the jejunum and ileum, there may typically be a wide variation in the ratios of the
measured green reflectance levels to the measured blue reflectance levels, resulting
in relatively noisy data with a high standard deviation. By comparison, within the
cecum ingestible device 100 may measure a relatively stable ratio of the measured
green reflectance levels to the measured blue reflectance levels. In some cases, the
ingestible device 100 may be configured to determine transitions from the small intestine
to the cecum based on these differences. For example, ingestible device 100 may compare
recent windows of data to past windows of data, and detect a transition to the cecum
in response to determining that the standard deviation of the ratios in the recent
window of data is substantially less than the standard deviation of the ratios in
the past window of data.
[0249] FIG. 8 is another plot illustrating data collected during an example operation of
an ingestible device, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible
device as it transits through a gastrointestinal (GI) tract, in accordance with some
aspects of the disclosure. Similar to FIG. 7, FIG. 8 may be described in connection
with the ingestible device 100 for illustrative purposes. However, this is not intended
to be limiting, and plot 800 and data set 802 may be typical of data gathered by any
device discussed in this application.
[0250] At 804, shortly after ingestible device 100 begins operation, ingestible device 100
determines that it has reached at least the stomach (e.g., as a result of making a
determination similar to the determination discussed in relation to 506 in process
500 (FIG. 5)). Ingestible device 100 continues to gather additional measurements of
green and blue reflectance levels (e.g., via sensing sub-unit 126 (FIG. 2)), and at
806 ingestible device 100 determines that a pyloric transition has occurred from the
stomach to the duodenum (e.g., as a result of making a determination similar to the
determinations discussed in relation to 616-624 of process 600 (FIG. 6)). Notably,
the values in data set 802 around 806 jump up precipitously, which is indicative of
the higher ratios of measured green reflectance levels to measured blue reflectance
levels typical of the duodenum, before falling shortly thereafter. As a result of
the reduced values in data set 802, ingestible device 100 determines that a reverse
pyloric transition has occurred from the duodenum back to the stomach at 808 (e.g.,
as a result of making a determination similar to the determinations discussed in relation
to 610-612 of process 600 (FIG. 6)). At 810, as a result of the values in data set
802 increasing again, ingestible device 100 determines that another pyloric transition
has occurred from the stomach to the duodenum, and shortly thereafter ingestible device
100 proceeds onwards to the jejunum, ileum, and cecum.
[0251] The remainder of the data set 802 depicts the ratios of the measured green reflectance
levels to the measured blue reflectance levels throughout the remainder of the GI
tract. Notably, at 812, ingestible device reaches the transition point between the
ileum and the cecum. As discussed above in relation to FIG. 7, the transition to the
cecum is marked by a reduced standard deviation in the ratios of measured green reflectances
and measured blue reflectances over time, and ingestible device 100 may be configured
to detect a transition to the cecum based on determining that the standard deviation
of a recent set of measurements is substantially smaller than the standard deviation
of past measurements taken from the jejunum or ileum.
[0252] In some cases, the ingestible device (e.g., ingestible device 100, 300, or 400) may
be configured to deliver a dispensable substance that is pre-stored within the ingestible
device from the ingestible device into the cecum in response to identifying the change
in the location of the ingestible device. For example, ingestible device 100 may have
a dispensable substance pre-stored within the ingestible device 100 (e.g., within
a storage chamber or cavity on optional storage sub-unit 118-3 (FIG. 2)), and ingestible
device 100 may be configured to dispense the substance into the cecum (e.g., through
the use of optional opening 116 and optional rotating assembly 118 (FIG. 2)) when
the ingestible device 100 detects that the ingestible device 100 is located within
the cecum.
[0253] In some cases, the ingestible device (e.g., ingestible device 100, 300, or 400) may
be configured to perform an action based on the total number of detected muscle contractions.
For example, ingestible device 100 may be configured to retrieve data indicative of
the total number of muscle contractions (e.g., from memory circuitry of PCB 120 (FIG.
2)), and compare that to an expected number of muscle contractions in a healthy individual.
In response, the ingestible device may dispense a substance into the cecum (e.g.,
through the use of optional opening 116 and optional rotating assembly 118 (FIG. 2))As
an example, ingestible device 100 may be configured to deliver a substance into the
cecum (such as a medicament), in response to determining that the detected muscle
contractions are inconsistent with a functioning GI tract in a healthy individual.
[0254] It will be understood that the steps and descriptions of the flowcharts of this disclosure,
, are merely illustrative. Any of the steps and descriptions of the flowcharts, ,
may be modified, omitted, rearranged, performed in alternate orders or in parallel,
two or more of the steps may be combined, or any additional steps may be added, without
departing from the scope of the present disclosure. For example, the ingestible device
100 may calculate the mean and the standard deviation of multiple data sets in parallel
(e.g., multiple data sets, each one corresponding to a different wavelength of reflectance
or different sensing sub-unit used to detect the reflectance) in order to speed up
the overall computation time.
[0255] FIG. 11 is a plot illustrating muscle contractions detected by an ingestible device
over time, which may be used when determining a location of an ingestible device as
it transits through a gastrointestinal (GI) tract, in accordance with some aspects
of the disclosure.In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may be configured to detect
muscle contractions, and store data indicative of when each muscle contraction is.
Plot 1100 depicts the detected muscle contractions 1106 over time, with each muscle
contraction being represented by a vertical line reaching from "0" to "1" on the y-axis.
[0256] At 1102, around the 10-minute mark, ingestible device 100 first enters the duodenum.
Shortly thereafter, at 1108, ingestible device 100 begins to detect several muscle
contractions 1106 in quick succession, which may be indicative of the strong peristaltic
waves that form in the jejunum (e.g., jejunum 314 (FIG. 3)). Later, around 1110, ingestible
device 100 continues to detect intermittent muscle contractions, which may be consistent
with an ingestible device 100 within the ileum. Finally, at 1104, ingestible device
100 transitions out of the small intestine, and into the cecum. Notably, ingestible
device 100 detects more frequent muscle contractions in the jejunum portion of the
small intestine as compared to the ileum portion of the small intestine, and ingestible
device 100 does not measure any muscle contractions after having exited the small
intestine. In some cases, the ingestible device 100 may incorporate this information
into a localization process. For example, ingestible device 100 may be configured
to detect a transition from a jejunum to an ileum in response to determining that
a frequency of detected muscle contractions (e.g., the number of muscle contractions
measured in a given 10-minute window) has fallen below a threshold number. As another
example, ingestible device 100 may be configured to detect a transition from an ileum
to a cecum in response to determining that no muscle contractions have been detected
for a threshold period of time. It is understood that these examples are intended
to be illustrative, and not limiting, and that measurements of muscle contractions
may be combined with any of the other processes, systems, or methods discussed in
this disclosure.
[0257] FIG. 14 is a flowchart 1400 for an exemplary process for determining a transition
of the device from the ileum to the cecum. In general, the process involves detecting
changes in the reflected optical signal (e.g., red light, blue light, green light,
ratio of red light to green light, ratio of red light to blue light, and/or ratio
of green light to blue light). In some cases, the process includes detecting changes
in the ratio of reflected red light to reflected green light, and also detecting changes
in the ratio of reflected green light to reflected blue light. Generally, in the process
1400, the sliding window analysis (first and second windows) discussed with respect
to process 600 is continued.
[0258] Step 1410 includes setting a first threshold in a detected signal, e.g., ratio of
detected red light to detected green light, and setting a second threshold for the
coefficient of variation for a detected signal, e.g., the coefficient of variation
for the ratio of detected green light to detected blue light. The first threshold
can be set to a fraction (e.g., from 0.5 to 0.9, from 0.6 to 0.8) of the average signal
(e.g., ratio of detected red light to detected green light) in the first window, or
a fraction (e.g., from 0.4 to 0.8, from 0.5 to 0.7) of the mean difference between
the detected signal (e.g., ratio of detected red light to detected green light) in
the two windows. The second threshold can be set to 0.1 (e.g., 0.05, 0.02).
[0259] Step 1420 includes detecting the signals in the first and second windows that are
to be used for comparing to the first and second thresholds.
[0260] Step 1430 includes comparing the detected signals to the first and second thresholds.
If the corresponding value is not below the first threshold or the corresponding value
is not below the second threshold, then it is determined that the device has not left
the ileum and entered the cecum, and the process returns to step 1420. If the corresponding
value is below the first threshold and the corresponding value is below the second
threshold, then it is determined that the device has left the ileum and entered the
cecum, and the proceeds to step 1440.
[0261] Step 1450 includes determining whether it is the first time that that the device
was determined to leave the ileum and enter the cecum. If it is the first time that
the device was determined to leave the ileum and enter the cecum, then the process
proceeds to step 1460. If it is not the first time that the device has left the ileum
and entered the cecum, then the process proceeds to step 1470.
[0262] Step 1460 includes setting a reference signal. In this step the optical signal (e.g.,
ratio of detected red light to detected green light) as a reference signal.
[0263] Step 1470 includes determining whether the device may have left the cecum and returned
to the ileum. The device is determined to have left the cecum and returned to the
ileum if the corresponding detected signal (e.g., ratio of detected red light to detected
green light) is statistically comparable to the reference signal (determined in step
1460) and the coefficient of variation for the corresponding detected signal (e.g.,
ratio of detected green light to detected blue light) exceeds the second threshold.
If it is determined that the device may have left the cecum and returned to the ileum,
the process proceeds to step 1480.
[0264] Step 1480 includes continuing to detect the relevant optical signals for a period
of time (e.g., at least one minute, from five minutes to 15 minutes).
[0265] Step 1490 includes determining whether the signals determined in step 1480 indicate
(using the methodology discussed in step 1470) that the device re-entered the ileum.
If the signals indicate that the device re-entered the ileum, the process proceeds
to step 1420. If the signals indicate that the device is in the cecum, the process
proceeds to step 1492.
[0266] Step 1492 includes continuing to monitor the relevant optical signals for a period
of time (e.g., at least 30 minutes, at least one hour, at least two hours).
[0267] Step 1494 includes determining whether the signals determined in step 1492 indicate
(using the methodology discussed in step 1470) that the device re-entered the ileum.
If the signals indicate that the device re-entered the ileum, the process proceeds
to step 1420. If the signals indicate that the device is in the cecum, the process
proceeds to step 1496.
[0268] At step 1496, the process determines that the device is in the cecum.
[0269] For illustrative purposes the disclosure focuses primarily on a number of different
examples of an ingestible device, and methods for determining a location of an ingestible
device within a GI tract. However, the possible ingestible devices that may be constructed
are not limited to these examples, and variations in the shape and design may be made
without significantly changing the functions and operations of the device. Similarly,
the possible procedures for determining a location of the ingestible device within
the GI tract are not limited to the specific procedures and disclosed(e.g., process
1400 (FIG. 14)).
[0270] At least some of the elements of the ingestible device described herein which are
implemented via software (e.g., software executed by control circuitry within PCB
120 (FIG. 2)) may be written in a high-level procedural language such as object oriented
programming, a scripting language or both. Accordingly, the program code may be written
in C, C
++ or any other suitable programming language and may comprise modules or classes, as
is known to those skilled in object oriented programming. Alternatively, or in addition,
at least some of the elements of the of the ingestible device described herein that
are implemented via software may be written in assembly language, machine language
or firmware as needed. In either case, the language may be a compiled or an interpreted
language.
[0271] At least some of the program code used to implement the ingestible device can be
stored on a storage media or on a computer readable medium that is readable by a general
or special purpose programmable computing device having a processor, an operating
system and the associated hardware and software that is necessary to implement the
functionality of at least one of the elements described herein. The program code,
when read by the computing device, configures the computing device to operate in a
new, specific and predefined manner in order to perform at least one of the methods
described herein.
[0272] Furthermore, at least some of the programs associated with the systems, devices,
and methods described herein are capable of being distributed in a computer program
product comprising a computer readable medium that bears computer usable instructions
for one or more processors. The medium may be provided in various forms, including
non-transitory forms such as, but not limited to, one or more diskettes, compact disks,
tapes, chips, and magnetic and electronic storage. In some cases, the medium may be
transitory in nature such as, but not limited to, wire-line transmissions, satellite
transmissions, internet transmissions (e.g. downloads), media, digital and analog
signals, and the like. The computer useable instructions may also be in various formats,
including compiled and non-compiled code.
[0273] The techniques described above can be implemented using software for execution on
a computer. For instance, the software forms procedures in one or more computer programs
that execute on one or more programmed or programmable computer systems (which may
be of various architectures such as distributed, client/server, or grid) each including
at least one processor, at least one data storage system (including volatile and non-volatile
memory and/or storage elements), at least one input device or port, and at least one
output device or port.
[0274] The software may be provided on a storage medium, such as a CD-ROM, readable by a
general or special purpose programmable computer or delivered (encoded in a propagated
signal) over a communication medium of a network to the computer where it is executed.
All of the functions may be performed on a special purpose computer, or using special-purpose
hardware, such as coprocessors. The software may be implemented in a distributed manner
in which different parts of the computation specified by the software are performed
by different computers. Each such computer program is preferably stored on or downloaded
to a storage media or device (e.g., solid state memory or media, or magnetic or optical
media) readable by a general or special purpose programmable computer, for configuring
and operating the computer when the storage media or device is read by the computer
system to perform the procedures described herein. The inventive system may also be
considered to be implemented as a computer-readable storage medium, configured with
a computer program, where the storage medium so configured causes a computer system
to operate in a specific and predefined manner to perform the functions described
herein.
Methods and Mechanisms of Delivery
[0275] FIG. 16 provides an example mock-up diagram illustrating aspects of a structure of
an ingestible device 1600 for delivering a dispensable substance, such as a formulation
of a therapeutic agent described herein, according to some cases described herein.
In some cases, the ingestible device 1600 may generally be in the shape of a capsule,
a pill or any swallowable form that may be orally consumed by an individual. In this
way, the ingestible device 1600 may be ingested by a patient and may be prescribed
by healthcare practitioners and patients.
[0276] The ingestible device 1600 includes a housing 1601 that may take a shape similar
to a capsule, a pill, and/or the like, which may include two ends 1602a-b. The housing
1601 may be designed to withstand the chemical and mechanical environment of the GI
tract (e.g., effects of muscle contractile forces and concentrated hydrochloric acid
in the stomach). A broad range of materials that may be used for the housing 1601.
Examples of these materials include, but are not limited to, thermoplastics, fluoropolymers,
elastomers, stainless steel and glass complying with ISO 10993 and USP Class VI specifications
for biocompatibility; and any other suitable materials and combinations thereof.
[0277] In some cases, the wall of the housing 1601 may have a thickness of 0.5mm-1mm, which
is sufficient to sustain an internal explosion (e.g., caused by hydrogen ignition
or over pressure inside the housing).
[0278] The housing 1601 may or may not have a pH-sensitive enteric coating to detect or
otherwise be sensitive to a pH level of the environment external to the ingestible
device. As discussed elsewhere in the application in more detail, the ingestible device
1600 may additionally or alternatively include one more sensors, e.g., temperature
sensor, optical sense.
[0279] The housing 1601 may be formed by coupling two enclosure portions together. The ingestible
device 1600 may include an electronic component within the housing 1600. The electronic
component may be placed proximally to an end 1602b of the housing, and includes a
printed circuit board (PCB), a battery, an optical sensing unit, and/or the like.
[0280] The ingestible device 1600 further includes a gas generating cell 1603 that is configured
to generate gas and thus cause an internal pressure within the housing 1601. In some
cases, the gas generating cell may include or be connected to a separate channel or
valve of the ingestible device such that gas may be release through the channel or
valve to create a motion to alter the position of the ingestible device within the
GI tract. Such gas release can also be used to position the ingestible device relative
to the intestinal lining. In another cases, gas may be released through the separate
channel or valve to alter the surface orientation of the intestinal tissue prior to
delivery of the dispensable substance.
[0281] A traveling plunger 1604 may be placed on top of the gas generating cell 1603 within
the housing 1601. The traveling plunger 1604 is a membrane that separates the gas
generating cell 1603 and a storage reservoir that stores the dispensable substance
1605. In some cases, the traveling plunger 1604 may be a movable piston. In some cases,
the traveling plunger 1604 may instead be a flexible membrane such as but not limited
to a diaphragm. In some cases, the traveling plunger 1604, which may have the form
of a flexible diaphragm, may be placed along an axial direction of the housing 1601,
instead of being placed on top of the gas generating cell 1603. The traveling plunger
or the membrane 1604 may move (when the membrane 1604 is a piston) or deform (when
the membrane 1604 is a diaphragm) towards a direction of the end 1602a of the housing,
when the gas generating cell 1603 generates gas to create an internal pressure that
pushes the membrane 1604. In this way, the membrane or traveling plunger 1604 may
push the dispensable substance 1605 out of the housing via a dispensing outlet 1607.
[0282] The housing 1601 may include a storage reservoir storing one or more dispensable
substances 1605 adjacent to the traveling plunger 1604. The dispensable substance
1605 may be a therapeutic or medical agent that may take a form of a powder, a compressed
powder, a fluid, a semi-liquid gel, or any other dispensable or deliverable form.
The delivery of the dispensable substance 1605 may take a form such as but not limited
to bolus, semi-bolus, continuous, burst drug delivery, and/or the like. In some cases,
a single bolus is delivered to the cecum. In some cases, more than one bolus is released
to the cecum. In some cases the release of more than one bolus is triggered according
to a pre-programmed algorithm. In some cases the release profile is continuous. In
some cases the release profile is time-based. In some disclosures the release profile
is location-based. In some cases, the amount delivered is based on the severity and/or
extent of the disease in the following manner.
[0283] In some cases the dispensable substance is a small molecule therapeutic that is released
in the cecum. Small molecules that are administered by typical oral routes are primarily
absorbed in the small intestine, with much lower absorption taking place in the large
intestine (outside of the rectum). Accordingly, an ingestible device that is capable
of releasing a small molecule selectively in the cecum with resulting low systemic
levels (even when high doses are used) is attractive for subjects with inflammatory
bowel disease in the large intestine.
[0284] In some cases, the storage reservoir may include multiple chambers, and each chamber
stores a different dispensable substance. For example, the different dispensable substances
can be released at the same time via the dispensing outlet 1607. Alternatively, the
multiple chambers may take a form of different layers within the storage reservoir
such that the different dispensable substance from each chamber is delivered sequentially
in an order. In one example, each of the multiple chambers is controlled by a separate
traveling plunger, which may be propelled by gas generation. The electronic component
may control the gas generating cell 1603 to generate gas to propel a specific traveling
plunger, e.g., via a separate gas generation chamber, etc., to deliver the respective
substance. In some cases, the content of the multiple chambers may be mixed or combined
prior to release, for example, to activate the drug.
[0285] The ingestible device 1600 may include a dispensing outlet 1607 at one end 1602a
of the housing 1601 to direct the dispensable substance 105 out of the housing. The
dispensing outlet 1607 may include an exit valve, a slit or a hole, a jet injection
nozzle with a syringe, and/or the like. When the traveling plunger 1604 moves towards
the end 1602a of the housing 1601, an internal pressure within the storage reservoir
may increase and push the dispensing outlet to be open to let the dispensable substance
1605 be released out of the housing 1601.
[0286] In some cases, a pressure relief device 1606 may be placed within the housing 1601,
e.g., at the end 1602a of the housing 1601.
[0287] In some cases, the housing 1601 may include small holes (e.g., with a diameter smaller
than 2 mm), e.g., on the side of the housing 1601, or at the end 1602a to facilitate
loading the dispensable substance into the storage reservoir.
[0288] In some cases, a feedback control circuit (e.g., a feedback resistor, etc.) may be
added to send feedback from the gas generating cell 1603 to the electronic component
such that when the internal pressure reaches a threshold level, the electronic component
may control the gas generating cell 1603 to turn off gas generation, or to activate
other safety mechanism (e.g., feedback-controlled release valve, etc.). For example,
an internal pressure sensor may be used to measure the internal pressure within the
ingestible device and generate feedback to the feedback control circuit.
[0289] FIG. 17 provides an example diagram illustrating aspects of a mechanism for a gas
generating cell 1603 configured to generate a gas to dispense a substance, according
to some cases described herein. As shown in FIG. 17, the gas generating cell 1603
generates a gas 1611 which can propel the dispensable substance 1605 out of the dispensing
outlet 1607. A variable resistor 1608 may be connected to a circuit with the gas generating
cell 1603 such that the variable resistor 1608 may be used to control an intensity
and/or an amount of gas 1611 (e.g., hydrogen) generated by the cell 1603. Specifically,
the gas generating cell 1603 may be a battery form factor cell that is capable of
generating hydrogen when a resistor is applied. In this way, as the gas generating
cell 1603 only needs the use of a resistor only without any active power requirements,
the gas generating cell 1603 may be integrated into an ingestible device such as a
capsule with limited energy/power available. For example, the gas generating cell
1603 may be compatible with a capsule at a size of 26mm × 13mm or smaller.
[0290] In some cases, based on the elution rate of gas from the cell, and an internal volume
of the ingestible device, it may take time to generate sufficient gas 1611 to deliver
the substance 1605, and the time required may be 30 seconds or longer. For example,
the time to generate a volume of hydrogen equivalent to 500µL of fluid would be approximately
5 minutes. A longer period of time may be needed based upon non-ideal conditions within
the ingestible device, such as friction, etc. Thus, given that the production of gas
(e.g., hydrogen) may take time, gas generation may need to start prior to the ingestible
device arriving at the site of delivery to build pressure up within the device. The
ingestible device may then need to know when it is approaching the site of delivery.
For example, the device may start producing gas on an "entry transition," which is
determined by temperature, so as to produce enough gas to be close to the pressure
high enough to deliver the dispensable substance. The ingestible device may then only
start producing gas again when it arrives at the site of delivery, which will cause
the internal pressure within the ingestible device to reach a level required by the
dispensing outlet to release the dispensable substance. Also, for regio-specific delivery,
the ingestible device may estimate the time it takes to build up enough pressure to
deliver the dispensable substance before the ingestible device arrives at a specific
location, to activate gas generation.
[0291] The gas 1611 that may be generated for a continuous delivery of drug (e.g., 1cc H
2 in 4 hours, 16 breaths per minute at 0.5L tidal volume) may equate to 1 cc hydrogen
in approximately 2000 L of exhaled air, or approximately 0.5 ppm H2, which is below
physiologic values of exhaled hydrogen. Reducing this time to 10 minutes equates to
approximately 13 ppm hydrogen. Thus, due to the length of intestine that may be covered
during this time period, the ingestible device may possess a higher localized value
than physiologic.
[0292] FIGs. 18 and 19, disclosed in US patent publication
US2018/0070857A1, illustrates an example of an ingestible device for localized delivery of pharmaceutical
compositions disclosed herein, in accordance with particular implementations. The
ingestible device 1600 includes a piston or drive element 1634 to push for drug delivery,
in accordance with particular implementations described herein. The ingestible device
1600 may have one or more batteries 1631 placed at one end 1602a of a housing 1601
to provide power for the ingestible device 1600. A printed circuit board (PCB) 1632
may be placed adjacent to a battery or other power source 1631, and a gas generating
cell 1603 may be mounted on or above the PCB 1632. The gas generating cell 1603 may
be sealed from the bottom chamber (e.g., space including 1631 and 1632) of the ingestible
device 1600. A movable piston 1634 may be placed adjacent to the gas generating cell
1603. In this way, gas generation from the gas generating cell 1603 may propel a piston
1634 to move towards another end 1602b of the housing 1601 such that the dispensable
substance in a reservoir compartment 1635 can be pushed out of the housing through
a dispensing outlet 1607, e.g., the movement is shown at 1636, with the piston 1634
at a position after dispensing the substance. The dispensing outlet 1607 may comprise
a plug. The reservoir compartment 1635 can store the dispensable substance (e.g.,
drug substance), or alternatively the reservoir compartment can house a storage reservoir
1661 which comprises the dispensable substance. The reservoir compartment 1635 or
storage reservoir 1661 may have a volume of approximately 600 µL or even more dispensable
substance, which may be dispensed in a single bolus, or gradually over a period of
time.
[0293] The battery cells 1631 may have a height of 1.65 mm each, and one to three batteries
may be used. The height of the piston may be reduced with custom molded part for around
1.5mm to save space. If the gas generating cell 1603 is integrated with the piston
1634, the overall height of the PCB, batteries and gas generating cell in total can
be reduced to around 5 mm, thus providing more space for drug storage. For example,
for an ingestible device of 7.8 mm in length (e.g., from end 1602a to the other end
1602b), a reservoir compartment 1635 or a storage reservoir 1661 of approximately
600 µL may be used for drug delivery. For another example, for an ingestible device
of 17.5 mm in length, a reservoir compartment 1635 or a storage reservoir 1661 of
approximately 1300 µL may be used for drug release.
[0294] In some implementations, the reservoir 1635 or 1661 for storing a therapeutically
effective amount of the S1P modulator forms at least a portion of the device housing
1601. The therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator can be stored in the
reservoir 1635 or 1661 at a particular pressure, for example, determined to be higher
than a pressure inside the GI tract so that once the reservoir 1635 or 1661 is in
fluid communication with the GI tract, the S1P modulator is automatically released.
In certain implementations, the reservoir compartment 1635 includes a plurality of
chambers, and each of the plurality of the chambers stores a different dispensable
substance or a different storage reservoir 1661.
[0295] In certain cases, the storage reservoir 1661 is a compressible component or has compressible
side walls. In particular cases, the compressible component can be composed, at least
in part, or coated (e.g., internally) with polyvinyl chloride (PVC), silicone, DEHP
(di-2-ethylhexyl phthalate), Tyvek, polyester film, polyolefin, polyethylene, polyurethane,
or other materials that inhibit the S1P modulator from sticking to the reservoir and
provide a sterile reservoir environment for the S1P modulator. The storage reservoir
1661 can be hermetically sealed. The reservoir compartment 1635 or storage reservoir
1661 can be configured to store S1P modulator in quantities in the range of 0.01 mL
- 2 mL, such as 0.05 mL - 2 mL, such as 0.05 mL - 2 mL, such as 0.6mL - 2 mL. In some
disclosures, the storage reservoir 1661 is attachable to the device housing 1601,
for example, in the reservoir compartment. Accordingly, the storage reservoir 1635
can be loaded with the S1P modulator prior to being positioned in and/or coupled to
the ingestible device housing 1601. The ingestible device housing 1601 includes one
or more openings configured as a loading port to load the dispensable substance into
the reservoir compartment. In another case, the ingestible device housing 1601 includes
one or more openings configured as a vent.
[0296] As noted above, in some cases, a storage reservoir (optionally, containing a S1P
modulator) is attachable to an ingestible device. In general, in such cases the storage
reservoir and ingestible device can be designed in any appropriate fashion so that
the storage reservoir can attach to the ingestible device when desired. Examples of
designs include a storage reservoir that fits entirely within the ingestible device
(e.g., in the ingestible device so that the storage reservoir is sealed within the
device at the time the device is ingested by a subject), a storage reservoir that
fits partially within the ingestible device, and a storage reservoir that is carried
by the housing of the device. In some cases, the storage reservoir snap fits with
the ingestible device. In certain cases, the storage reservoir is friction fit with
the ingestible device. In some cases, the storage reservoir is held together with
the ingestible device via a biasing mechanism, such as one or more springs, one or
more latches, one or more hooks, one or more magnets, and/or electromagnetic radiation.
In certain cases, the storage reservoir can be a pierceable member. In some cases,
the ingestible device has a sleeve into which the storage reservoir securely fits.
In some cases, the storage reservoir is disposed in/on a slidable track/groove so
that it can move onto a piercing needle when delivery of the therapeutic agent is
desired. In certain cases, the storage reservoir is made of a soft plastic coating,
which is contacted with a needle at any orientation to deliver the therapeutic agent
when desired. Generally, the storage reservoir can be made of one or more appropriate
materials, such as, for example, one or more plastics and/or one or more metals or
alloys. Exemplary materials include silicone, polyvinyl chloride, polycarbonate and
stainless steel. Optionally, the design may be such that the storage reservoir carries
some or all of the electrical componentry to be used by the ingestible device. Although
the foregoing discussion relates to one storage reservoir, it is to be understood
that an ingestible device can be designed to carry any desired number (e.g., two,
three, four, five) storage reservoirs. Different storage reservoirs can have the same
or different designs. In some cases, the ingestible device (when fully assembled and
packaged) satisfies the regulatory requirements for marketing a medical device in
one or more jurisdictions selected from the United States of America, the European
Union or any member state thereof, Japan, China, Brazil, Canada, Mexico, Colombia,
Argentina, Chile, Peru, Russia, the UK, Switzerland, Norway, Turkey, Israel, any member
state of the Gulf Cooperative Council, South Africa, India, Australia, New Zealand,
South Korea, Singapore, Thailand, the Philippines, Malaysia, Viet Nam, Indonesia,
Taiwan and Hong Kong.
[0297] In certain cases, the ingestible device housing 1601 includes one or more actuation
systems (e.g., gas generating cell 1603) for pumping the S1P modulator from the reservoir
1635. In some cases, the actuation system can include a mechanical, electrical, electromechanical,
hydraulic, and/or fluid actuation system. For example, a chemical actuation means
may use chemical reaction of mixing one or more reagents to generate a sufficient
volume of gas to propel the piston or drive element 1634 for drug release. The actuation
system can be integrated into the reservoir compartment 1635 or can be an auxiliary
system acting on or outside of the reservoir compartment 1635. For example, the actuation
system can include pumping system for pushing/pulling the S1P modulator out of the
reservoir compartment 1635 or the actuation system can be configured to cause the
reservoir compartment 1635 to change structurally so that the volume inside of the
reservoir compartment 1635 changes, thereby dispensing the S1P modulator from the
reservoir compartment 1635. The actuation system can include an energy storage component
such as a battery or a capacitor for powering the actuation system. The actuation
system can be actuated via gas pressure or a system storing potential energy, such
as energy from an elastic reservoir component being expanded during loading of the
reservoir and after being positioned in the ingestible device housing 1601 being subsequently
released from the expanded state when the ingestible device housing is at the location
for release within the cecum. In certain cases, the reservoir compartment 1635 can
include a membrane portion, whereby the S1P modulator is dispensed from the reservoir
compartment 1635 or storage reservoir 1661 via osmotic pressure.
[0298] In particular cases the storage reservoir 1661 is in a form of a bellow that is configured
to be compressed via a pressure from the gas generating cell. The S1P modulator may
be loaded into the bellow, which may be compressed by gas generation from the gas
generating cell or other actuation means to dispense the dispensable substance through
the dispensing outlet 1607 and out of the housing 1601. In some cases, the ingestible
device includes a capillary plate placed between the gas generating cell and the first
end of the housing, and a wax seal between the gas generating cell and the reservoir,
wherein the wax seal is configured to melt and the dispensable substance is pushed
through the capillary plate by a pressure from the gas generating cell. The shape
of the bellow may aid in controlled delivery. The reservoir compartment 1635 includes
a dispensing outlet, such as a valve or dome slit 1662 extending out of an end of
the housing 1601, in accordance with particular implementations. Thus when the bellow
is being compressed, the dispensable substance may be propelled out of the bellow
through the valve or the dome slit.
[0299] In certain cases, the reservoir compartment 1635 includes one or more valves (e.g.
a valve in the dispensing outlet 1607) that are configured to move or open to fluidly
couple the reservoir compartment 1635 to the GI tract. In certain cases, a housing
wall of the housing 1601 can form a portion of the reservoir compartment 1635. In
certain cases, the housing walls of the reservoir serve as a gasket. One or more of
the one or more valves are positioned in the housing wall of the device housing 1601,
in accordance with particular implementations. One or more conduits may extend from
the reservoir 1635 to the one or more valves, in certain implementations.
[0300] In certain cases, a housing wall of the housing 1601 can be formed of a material
that is configured to dissolve, for example, in response to contact at the disease
site. In certain cases, a housing wall of the housing 1601 can be configured to dissolve
in response to a chemical reaction or an electrical signal. The one or more valves
and/or the signals for causing the housing wall of the housing 1601 to dissolve or
dissipate can be controlled by one or more processors or controllers positioned on
PCB 1632 in the device housing 1601. The controller is communicably coupled to one
or more sensors or detectors configured to determine when the device housing 1601
is in the cecum. The sensors or detectors comprise a plurality of electrodes comprising
a coating, in certain implementations. Releasing of the S1P modulator from the reservoir
compartment 1635 is triggered by an electric signal from the electrodes resulting
from the interaction of the coating with the one or more sites of disease site. The
one or more sensors can include a chemical sensor, an electrical sensor, an optical
sensor, an electromagnetic sensor, a light sensor, and/or a radiofrequency sensor.
[0301] In particular cases, the device housing 1601 can include one or more pumps configured
to pump the therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator from the reservoir
compartment 1635. The pump is communicably coupled to the one or more controllers.
The controller is configured to activate the pump in response to detection by the
one or more detectors of the disease site and activation of the valves to allow the
reservoir 1635 to be in fluid communication with the GI tract. The pump can include
a fluid actuated pump, an electrical pump, or a mechanical pump.
[0302] FIG. 20 provides an example structural diagram having a flexible diaphragm 1665 that
may deform towards the dispensing outlet 1607 when the gas generating cell 1603 generates
gas. The dispensable substance may then be propelled by the deformed diaphragm out
of the housing through the dispensing outlet 1607. The dispensing outlet 1607 shown
at FIG. 20 is in the form of a ring valve, however, any outlet design can be applied.
[0303] In some cases, an ingestible device can have an umbrella-shaped exit valve structure
as a dispensing outlet of the ingestible device. Optionally, an ingestible device
can have a flexible diaphragm to deform for drug delivery, and/or an integrated piston
and gas generating cell such that the gas generating cell is movable with the piston
to push for drug delivery.
[0304] In some cases, when the gas generating cell generates gas to propel the piston to
move towards the nozzle such that the dispensable substance can be pushed under the
pressure to break a burst disc to be injected via the nozzle.
[0305] In some cases, an ingestible device has a jet delivery mechanism with enhanced usable
volume of dispensable substance. For example, the nozzle may be placed at the center
of the ingestible device, and gas channels may be placed longitudinally along the
wall of the ingestible device to transport gas from the gas generating cell to propel
the piston, which is placed at an end of the ingestible device.
[0306] In certain embodiments, the reservoir is attachable to an ingestible device. In certain
embodiments, the ingestible device comprises a housing and the reservoir is attachable
to the housing.
[0307] Accordingly, in certain cases, provided herein is a S1P modulator for use in a method
of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract as disclosed herein, wherein the
S1P modulator is contained in a reservoir suitable for attachment to a device housing,
and wherein the method comprises attaching the reservoir to the device housing to
form the ingestible device, prior to orally administering the ingestible device to
the subject.
[0308] In certain cases, provided herein is an attachable reservoir containing a S1P modulator
for use in a method of treating a disease of the gastrointestinal tract, wherein the
method comprises attaching the reservoir to a device housing to form an ingestible
device and orally administering the ingestible device to a subject, wherein the S1P
modulator is released by the device in the cecum of the subject wherein the site of
disease is in the colon.
[0309] In certain cases, provided herein is an attachable reservoir containing a S1P modulator,
wherein the reservoir is attachable to a device housing to form an ingestible device
that is suitable for oral administration to a subject and that is capable of releasing
the S1P modulator in the cecum of the subject wherein the site of disease is in the
colon.
[0310] In particular implementation the ingestible device includes cameras (e.g., video
cameras) that affords inspection of the entire GI tract without discomfort or the
need for sedation, thus avoiding many of the potential risks of conventional endoscopy.
Video imaging can be used to help determine one or more characteristics of the GI
tract, including the location of disease (e.g., presence or location of inflamed tissue
and/or lesions associated with inflammatory bowel disease). In some cases, the ingestible
device 101 may comprise a camera for generating video imaging data of the GI tract
which can be used to determine, among other things, the location of the device. Examples
of video imaging capsules include Medtronic's PillCam
™, Olympus' Endocapsule
®, and IntroMedic's MicroCam
™. For a review of imaging capsules, see
Basar et al. "Ingestible Wireless Capsule Technology: A Review of Development and
Future Indication" International Journal of Antennas and Propagation (2012); 1-14). Other imaging technologies implemented with the device 101 can include thermal
imaging cameras, and those that employ ultrasound or Doppler principles to generate
different images (see Chinese patent application
CN10447361 1: "Capsule endoscope system having ultrasonic positioning function".
[0311] Ingestible devices can be equipped with sources for generating reflected light, including
light in the Ultraviolet, Visible, Near-infrared and/or Mid-infrared spectrum, and
the corresponding detectors for spectroscopy and hyperspectral imaging. Likewise,
autofluorescense may be used to characterize GI tissue (e.g., subsurface vessel information),
or low-dose radiation (see Check-Cap
™) can be used to obtain 3D reconstructed images.
Device Components
[0312] An ingestible device may comprise a component made of a non-digestible material and
contain the S1P modulator. In some embodiments, the material is plastic.
[0313] It is envisaged that the device is single-use. The device is loaded with a drug prior
to the time of administration. In some embodiments, it may be preferred that there
is provided a medicinal product comprising the device pre-filled with the drug.
Locomotion components
[0314] Ingestible devices can be active or passive, depending on whether they have controlled
or non-controlled locomotion. Passive (non-controlled) locomotion is more commonly
used among ingestible devices given the challenges of implementing a locomotion module.
Active (controlled) locomotion is more common in endoscopic ingestible capsules. For
example, a capsule may comprise a miniaturized locomotion system (internal locomotion).
Internal locomotion mechanisms may employ independent miniaturized propellers actuated by DC brushed
motors, or the use of water jets. As an example, a mechanism may comprise flagellar
or flap-based swimming mechanisms. As an example, a mechanism may comprise cyclic
compression/extension shape-memory alloy (SMA) spring actuators and anchoring systems
based on directional micro-needles. As an example, a mechanism may comprise six SMA
actuated units, each provided with two SMA actuators for enabling bidirectional motion.
As an example, a mechanism may comprise a motor adapted to electrically stimulating
the GI muscles to generate a temporary restriction in the bowel.
[0315] As an example, a capsule may comprise a magnet and motion of the capsule is caused
by an external magnetic field. For example, a locomotion system may comprise an ingestible
capsule and an external magnetic field source. For example, the system may comprise
an ingestible capsule and magnetic guidance equipment such as, for example, magnetic
resonance imaging and computer tomography, coupled to a dedicated control interface.
In some cases drug release mechanisms may also be triggered by an external condition,
such as temperature, pH, movement, acoustics, or combinations thereof.
[0316] An ingestible device can include an outlet port connected to the volume within housing
of the ingestible device. The outlet port may provide a path for the gas to exit the
ingestible device and be released into the environment surrounding the ingestible
device. This may prevent pressure from building up within the housing of the ingestible
device. In some cases, an ingestible device does not include an outlet port, and the
gas stays inside the volume of the ingestible device. In some cases, the outlet port
may contain a gas permeable membrane, a one-way valve, a hydrophobic channel, or some
other mechanism to avoid unwanted material, (e.g., fluids and solid particulates from
within the GI tract), from entering the ingestible device through the outlet port.
Communication systems
[0317] An ingestible device may be equipped with a communication system adapted to transmit
and/or receive data, including imaging and/or localization data. As an example, a
communication system may employ radiofrequency transmission. Ingestible devices using
radiofrequency communication are attractive because of their efficient transmission
through the layers of the skin. This is especially true for low frequency transmission
(UHF-433 ISM and lower, including the Medical Device Radio Communication Service band
(MDRS) band 402-406MHz). In another possibility, acoustics are used for communications,
including the transmission of data. For example, an ingestible capsule may be able
to transmit information by applying one or more base voltages to an electromechanical
transducer or piezoelectric (e.g., PZT, PVDF, etc.) device to cause the piezoelectric
device to ring at particular frequencies, resulting in an acoustic transmission. A
multi-sensor array for receiving the acoustic transmission may include a plurality
of acoustic transducers that receive the acoustic transmission from a movable device
such as an ingestible capsule as described in US Patent
US8615284B2filed September 6, 2007.
[0318] As an example, a communication system may employ human body communication technology.
Human body communication technology uses the human body as a conductive medium, which
generally requires a large number of sensor electrodes on the skin. As an example,
a communication system may integrate a data storage system.
Environmental Sensors
[0319] In some cases the device may comprise environmental sensors to measure pH, temperature,
transit times, or combinations thereof. Other examples of environmental sensors include,
but are not limited to a capacitance sensor, an impedance sensor, a heart rate sensor,
acoustic sensor such as a microphone or hydrophone, image sensor, and/or a movement
sensor. In one aspect, the ingestible device comprises a plurality of different environmental
sensors for generating different kinds of environmental data.
[0320] In order to avoid the problem of capsule retention, a thorough past medical and surgical
history should be undertaken. In addition, several other steps have been proposed,
including performing investigations such as barium follow-through. In cases where
it is suspected that there is a high risk of retention, the patient is given a patency
capsule a few days before swallowing an ingestible device. Any dissolvable non-endoscopic
capsule may be used to determine the patency of the GI tract. The patency capsule
is usually the same size as the ingestible device and can be made of cellophane. In
some cases, the patency capsule contains a mixture of barium and lactose, which allows
visualization by x-ray. The patency capsule may also include a radiotag or other label,
which allows for it to be detected by radio-scanner externally. The patency capsule
may comprise wax plugs, which allow for intestinal fluid to enter and dissolve the
content, thereby dividing the capsule into small particles.
[0321] Accordingly, in some cases, the methods herein comprise (a) identifying a subject
having a disease of the gastrointestinal tract and (b) evaluating the subject for
suitability to treatment. In some cases, the methods herein comprise evaluating for
suitability to treatment a subject identified as having a disease of the gastrointestinal
tract. In some cases, evaluating the subject for suitability to treatment comprises
determining the patency of the subject's GI tract.
[0322] In some cases, the ingestible device contains an electric energy emitting means,
a radio signal transmitting means, a medicament storage means and a remote actuatable
medicament releasing means. The capsule signals a remote receiver as it progresses
through the alimentary tract in a previously mapped route and upon reaching the cecum
is remotely triggered to release a dosage of medicament. Accordingly, in some cases,
releasing the S1P modulator is triggered by a remote electromagnetic signal.
[0323] In some cases, the ingestible device includes a housing introducible into a body
cavity and of a material insoluble in the body cavity fluids, but formed with an opening
covered by a material which is soluble in body cavity fluids. A diaphragm divides
the interior of the housing into a medication chamber including the opening, and a
control chamber. An electrolytic cell in the control chamber generates a gas when
electrical current is passed therethrough to deliver medication from the medication
chamber through the opening into the body cavity at a rate controlled by the electrical
current. Accordingly, in some cases, releasing the S1P modulator is triggered by generation
in the composition of a gas in an amount sufficient to expel the S1P modulator.
[0324] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an oral drug delivery device having
a housing with walls of water permeable material and having at least two chambers
separated by a displaceable membrane. The first chamber receives drug and has an orifice
through which the drug is expelled under pressure. The second chamber contains at
least one of two spaced apart electrodes forming part of an electric circuit which
is closed by the ingress of an aqueous ionic solution into the second chamber. When
current flows through the circuit, gas is generated and acts on the displaceable membrane
to compress the first chamber and expel the active ingredient through the orifice
for progressive delivery to the gastrointestinal tract.
[0325] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an ingestible device for delivering
a substance to a chosen location in the GI tract of a mammal includes a receiver of
electromagnetic radiation for powering an openable part of the device to an opened
position for dispensing of the substance. The receiver includes a coiled wire that
couples the energy field, the wire having an air or ferrite core. Also disclosed is
an apparatus for generating the electromagnetic radiation, the apparatus including
one or more pairs of field coils supported in a housing. The device optionally includes
a latch defined by a heating resistor and a fusible restraint. The device may also
include a flexible member that may serve one or both the functions of activating a
transmitter circuit to indicate dispensing of the substance; and restraining of a
piston used for expelling the substance.
[0326] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an ingestible device for delivering
a substance to the cecum of a mammal includes a receiver of electromagnetic radiation
for powering an openable part of the device to an opened position for dispensing of
the substance. The receiver includes a coiled wire that couples the energy field,
the wire having an air or ferrite core. A further aspect of the disclosure includes
an apparatus for generating the electromagnetic radiation, the apparatus including
one or more pairs of field coils supported in a housing. The device optionally includes
a latch defined by a heating resistor and a fusible restraint. The device may also
include a flexible member that may serve one or both the functions of activating a
transmitter circuit to indicate dispensing of the substance; and restraining of a
piston used for expelling the substance.
[0327] In some cases, the ingestible device is a device a swallowable capsule. A sensing
module is disposed in the capsule. A bioactive substance dispenser is disposed in
the capsule. A memory and logic component is disposed in the capsule and in communication
with the sensing module and the dispenser.
[0328] In some cases, the ingestible device includes electronic control means for dispensing
the drug substantially to the cecum, according to a pre-determined drug release profile
obtained prior to administration from the specific mammal. Accordingly, in some cases,
releasing the S1P modulator is triggered by an electromagnetic signal generated within
the device. The releasing may occur according to a pre-determined drug release profile.
[0329] The ingestible device can include at least one guide tube, one or more tissue penetrating
members positioned in the guide tube, a delivery member, an actuating mechanism and
a release element. The release element degrades upon exposure to various conditions
in the intestine so as to release and actuate the actuating mechanism. These are particularly
useful for the delivery of drugs which are poorly absorbed, tolerated and/or degraded
within the GI tract.
[0330] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an electronic pill comprising at least
one reservoir with a solid powder or granulate medicament or formulation, a discharge
opening and an actuator responsive to control circuitry for displacing medicine from
the reservoir to the discharge opening. The medicament or formulation comprises a
dispersion of one or more active ingredients--e.g., solids in powder or granulate
form--in an inert carrier matrix. Optionally, the active ingredients are dispersed
using intestinal moisture absorbed into the pill via a semipermeable wall section.
[0331] In some cases, the ingestible device includes a sensor comprising a plurality of
electrodes having a miniature size and a lower power consumption and a coating exterior
to the electrodes, wherein the coating interacts with a target condition thereby producing
a change in an electrical property of the electrodes, wherein the change is transduced
into an electrical signal by the electrodes. Accordingly, in some cases, releasing
the S1P modulator is triggered by an electric signal by the electrodes resulting from
the interaction of the coating with the one or more sites of disease. Further provided
herein is a system for medication delivery comprising such sensor and a pill.
[0332] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an electronic pill comprising a plurality
of reservoirs, each of the reservoirs comprising a discharge opening covered by a
removable cover. The pill comprises at least one actuator responsive to control circuitry
for removing the cover from the discharge opening. The actuator can for example be
a spring loaded piston breaking a foil cover when dispensing the medicament. Alternatively,
the cover can be a rotatable disk or cylinder with an opening which can be brought
in line with the discharge opening of a reservoir under the action of the actuator.
[0333] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an electronically and remotely controlled
pill or medicament delivery system. The pill includes a housing; a reservoir for storing
a medicament; an electronically controlled release valve or hatch for dispensing one
or more medicaments stored in the reservoir while traversing the gastrointestinal
tract; control and timing circuitry for opening and closing the valve; and a battery.
The control and timing circuitry opens and closes the valve throughout a dispensing
time period in accordance with a preset dispensing timing pattern which is programmed
within the control and timing circuitry. RF communication circuitry receives control
signals for remotely overriding the preset dispensing timing pattern, reprogramming
the control and timing circuitry or terminating the dispensing of the medicament within
the body. The pill includes an RFID tag for tracking, identification, inventory and
other purposes.
[0334] In some cases, the ingestible device includes an electronic capsule which has a discrete
drive element comprising: a housing, electronics for making the electronic capsule
operable, a pumping mechanism for dosing and displacing a substance, a power source
for powering the electronic capsule and enabling the electronics and the pumping mechanism
to operate, and a locking mechanism; and a discrete payload element comprising: a
housing, a reservoir for storing the substance, one or more openings in the housing
for releasing the substance from the reservoir and a locking mechanism for engaging
the drive element locking mechanism. Engagement of the drive element locking mechanism
with the payload element locking mechanism secures the drive element to the payload
element, thereby making the electronic capsule operable and specific.
[0335] In some cases, the ingestible device may be a mucoadhesive device configured for
release of an active agent, i.e. a S1P modulator .
[0336] In one aspect of the disclosure the ingestible device may also include one or more
environmental sensors. Environmental sensor may be used to generate environmental
data for the environment external to device in the gastrointestinal (GI) tract of
the subject. In some cases, environmental data is generated at or near the location
within the GI tract of the subject where a drug is delivered. Examples of environmental
sensor include, but are not limited to a capacitance sensor, a temperature sensor,
an impedance sensor, a pH sensor, a heart rate sensor, acoustic sensor, image sensor
(e.g., a hydrophone), and/or a movement sensor (e.g., an accelerometer). In one cases,
the ingestible device comprises a plurality of different environmental sensors for
generating different kinds of environmental data.
[0337] In one cases, the image sensor is a video camera suitable for obtaining images
in vivo of the tissues forming the GI tract of the subject. In one cases, the environmental
data is used to help determine one or more characteristics of the GI tract, including
the location of disease (e.g., presence or location of inflamed tissue and/or lesions
associated with inflammatory bowel disease). In some cases, the ingestible device
may comprise a camera for generating video imaging data of the GI tract which can
be used to determine, among other things, the location of the device.
[0338] In another cases, the ingestible device described herein may be localized using a
gamma scintigraphy technique or other radio-tracker technology as employed by Phaeton
Research's Enterion
™ capsule (See
Teng, Renli, and Juan Maya. "Absolute bioavailability and regional absorption of ticagrelor
in healthy volunteers." Journal of Drug Assessment 3.1 (2014): 43-50), or monitoring the magnetic field strength of permanent magnet in the ingestible
device (see
T. D. Than, et al., "A review of localization systems for robotic endoscopic capsules,"
IEEE Trans. Biomed. Eng., vol. 59, no. 9, pp. 2387-2399, Sep. 2012).
[0339] In one cases, the one or more environmental sensors measure pH, temperature, transit
times, or combinations thereof.
[0340] In some cases, releasing the S1P modulator is dependent on the pH at or in the vicinity
of the location. In some cases, releasing the S1P modulator is not dependent on the
pH at or in the vicinity of the location. In some disclosures, releasing the S1P modulator
is triggered by degradation of a release component located in the capsule. In some
disclo cases sures, the S1P modulator not triggered by degradation of a release component
located in the capsule. In some disclosures, wherein releasing the S1P modulator is
not dependent on enzymatic activity at or in the vicinity of the location. In some
cases, releasing the S1P modulator is not dependent on bacterial activity at or in
the vicinity of the location.
[0341] In any ingestible device disclosed herein, the S1P modulator is present in a therapeutically
effective amount.
Locations of treatment
[0342] The SIP modulator is delivered at a location in the cecum of the subject. In some
embodiments, the location is in the proximal portion of the cecum. In some embodiments,
the location is in the distal portion of the cecum.
[0343] The S1P modulator is delivered at a location in the cecum of the subject and is not
delivered at other locations in the gastrointestinal tract. In some disclosures, the
S1P modulator is delivered at a location in the distal portion of the cecum of the
subject and is not delivered at
other locations in the gastrointestinal tract, wherein a site of disease is in the
colon, and no site of disease is present at other locations in the gastrointestinal
tract.
[0344] The site of disease is in the colon and the S1P modulator is released in the cecum.
In some cases, a site of disease is in the ascending colon and the S1P modulator is
released in the cecum.
[0345] In some cases the subject is diagnosed with colitis throughout the colon and the
S1P modulator is released in the cecum In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered
150 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the S1P modulator
is delivered 125 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases,
the S1P modulator is delivered 100 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease.
In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered 50 cm or less from the one or more sites
of disease. In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered 40 cm or less from the one
or more sites of disease. In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered 30 cm or less
from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered
20 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the S1P modulator
is delivered 10 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the
S1P modulator is delivered 5 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In
some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered 2 cm or less from the one or more sites
of disease. In some disclosures, the method further comprises using an ingestible
device to deliver the S1P modulator and using localization methods disclosed herein
(e.g., such as discussed in Example 14 below) to determine the location of the ingestible
device within the GI tract (e.g., relative to the site of disease). In some cases,
the method further comprises using an ingestible device to deliver the S1P modulator
and determining the period of time since the ingestible device was ingested to determine
the location of the ingestible device within the GI tract (e.g., relative to the site
of disease). In some cases, the method further comprises identifying the one or more
sites of disease by a method comprising imaging of the gastrointestinal tract. In
some cases, imaging of the gastrointestinal tract comprises video imaging. In some
cases, imaging of the gastrointestinal tract comprises thermal imaging. In some cases,
imaging of the gastrointestinal tract comprises ultrasound imaging. In some cases,
imaging of the gastrointestinal tract comprises Doppler imaging.
[0346] In some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least
97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered 150 cm or less from the one
or more sites of disease. In some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at least
95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered
125 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the at least
80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the
S1P modulator is delivered 100 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In
some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%,
or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered 50 cm or less from the one or more
sites of disease. In some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at
least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered 40 cm or
less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the at least 80%, at least
90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator
is delivered 30 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the
at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least
98% of the S1P modulator is delivered 20 cm or less from the one or more sites of
disease. In some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%,
at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered 10 cm or less from
the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the at least 80%, at least 90%, at
least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P modulator is delivered
5 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some cases, the at least 80%,
at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, or at least 98% of the S1P
modulator is delivered 2 cm or less from the one or more sites of disease. In some
cases, the method further comprises using an ingestible device to deliver the S1P
modulator and using localization methods disclosed herein (e.g., such as discussed
in Example 13 below) to determine the location of the ingestible device within the
GI tract (e.g., relative to the site of disease). In some cases, the method further
comprises using an ingestible device to deliver the S1P modulator and determining
the period of time since the ingestible device was ingested to determine the location
of the ingestible device within the GI tract (e.g., relative to the site of disease).
[0347] In some cases, the amount of S1P modulator that is delivered is a Human Equivalent
Dose.
[0348] In some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered to the location by mucosal contact.
[0349] In some examples where the S1P modulator is administered to a subject using any of
the compositions or devices described herein, the S1P modulator can penetrate the
GI tissue of the subj ect.
[0350] As used herein, "GI tissue" refers to tissue in the gastrointestinal (GI) tract,
such as tissue in one or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon,
transverse colon, descending colon, sigmoid colon, and rectum. In one particular cases,
GI tissue refers to tissue in the proximal portion of one or more of duodenum, jejunum,
ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon, descending colon, and sigmoid colon.
In one particular cases , GI tissue refers to tissue in the distal portion of one
or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon, descending
colon, and sigmoid colon. The GI tissue may be, for example, GI tissue proximate to
one or more sites of disease. In some cases the S1P modulator can penetrate the cecum
tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease. For example, a S1P modulator can
penetrate one or more (e.g., two, three, or four) of the lumen/superficial mucosa,
the lamina propria, the submucosa, and the tunica muscularis/serosa.
[0351] In some examples, administration of a S1P modulator using any of the compositions
or devices described herein results in penetration (e.g., a detectable level of penetration)
of GI tissue (e.g., one or more (e.g., two, three, or four) of the lumen/superficial
mucosa, the lamina propria, the submucosa, and the tunica muscularis/serosa) within
a time period of about 10 minutes to about 10 hours. Penetration of GI tissue by a
S1P modulator can be detected by administering a labeled S1P modulator, and performing
imaging on the subject (e.g., ultrasound, computed tomography, or magnetic resonance
imaging). For example, the label can be a radioisotope, a heavy metal, a fluorophore,
or a luminescent agent (e.g., any suitable radioisotopes, heavy metals, fluorophores,
or luminescent agents used for imaging known in the art).
[0352] While not wishing to be bound to a particular theory, the inventors contemplate that
at or near the site of release a concentration gradient of the S1P modulator is generated
in the mucosa, and that administration of a S1P modulator using a device as described
herein advantageously results in a "reverse" concentration gradient when compared
to the concentration gradient resulting from systemic administration. In such "reverse"
concentration gradient, the drug concentration is highest from superficial to deep
with respect to the mucosal surface. Systemic administration instead typically results
in concentrations of the drug being highest from deep to superficial. A "reverse"
concentration gradient as described above aligns more favorably with the pathophysiology
of IBD.
[0353] In some cases, administration of a S1P modulator can provide for treatment (e.g.,
a reduction in the number, severity, and/or duration of one or more symptoms of any
of the disorders described herein in a subject) for a time period of between about
1 hour to about 30 days
in a subject following first administration of a S1P modulator using any of the compositions
or devices described herein. Non-limiting examples of symptoms of a disease described
herein are described below. For example, treatment can result in a decrease (e.g.,
about 1% to about 99% decrease) in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six,
seven, eight, or nine) of: the level of interferon-K in GI tissue, the level of IL-1ϑ
in GI tissue, the level of IL-6 in GI tissue, the level of IL-22 in GI tissue, the
level of IL-17A in the GI tissue, the level of TNFI in GI tissue, the level of IL-2
in GI tissue, the number of Th memory cells in Peyer's patches, and the number of
Th memory cells in mesentery lymph nodes, and endoscopy score in a subject (e.g.,
as compared to the level in the subject prior to treatment or compared to a subject
or population of subjects having a similar disease but receiving a placebo or a different
treatment) (e.g., for a time period of between about 1 hour to about 30 days (e.g.,
or any of the subranges herein) following the first administration of a S1P modulator
using any of the compositions or devices described herein. Exemplary methods for determining
the endoscopy score are described herein and other methods for determining the endoscopy
score are known in the art. Exemplary methods for determining the levels of interferon-K,
IL-1ϑ, IL-6, IL-22, IL-17A, TNFI, and IL-2 are described herein. Additional methods
for determining the levels of these cytokines are known in the art.
[0354] In some examples, treatment can result in an increase (e.g., about 1% to about 500%
increase) in one or both of stool consistency score and weight of a subject (e.g.,
as compared to the level in the subject prior to treatment or compared to a subject
or population of subjects having a similar disease but receiving a placebo or a different
treatment) (e.g., for a time period of between about 1 hour to about 30 days (e.g.,
or any of the subranges herein) following the first administration of a S1P modulator
using any of the compositions or devices described herein. Exemplary methods for determining
stool consistency score are described herein. Additional methods for determining a
stool consistency score are known in the art.
In some examples, administration of a S1P modulator using any of the devices or compositions
described herein can result in a ratio of GI tissue concentration of the S1P modulator
to the blood, serum, or plasma concentration of the S1P modulator that is higher than
the same ratio when the S1P modulator is administered by traditional means (e.g.,
systemically or orally). Examples of a ratio of GI tissue concentration of the S1P
modulator to the blood, serum, or plasma concentration of the S1P modulator include
about 2 to about 600.In some examples, administration of a S1P modulator using any
of the devices or compositions described herein can result in a ratio of GI tissue
concentration of the antibody or the S1P modulator to the blood, serum, or plasma
concentration of the S1P modulator of, e.g., about 2.8 to about 20.Some examples of
any of the methods described herein can, e.g., result in a selective suppression of
a local inflammatory response (e.g., an inflammatory response in local GI tissue),
while maintaining the systemic immune response (e.g., blood). The GI tissue may be,
for example, GI tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease. As used herein,
"GI content" refers to the content of the gastrointestinal (GI) tract, such as the
content of one or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse
colon, descending colon, sigmoid colon, and rectum, more particularly of the proximal
portion of one or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse
colon, descending colon, and sigmoid colon, or of the distal portion of one or more
of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon, descending
colon, and sigmoid colon. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein
can result in a selective suppression of the inflammatory response in the dudodenum
tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune
response. In some cases, the methods described herein can result in a selective suppression
of the inflammatory response in the jejunum tissue proximate to one or more sites
of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune response. In some cases, the methods
described herein can result in a selective suppression of the inflammatory response
in the ileum tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease, while maintaining the
systemic immune response. In some cases, the methods described herein can result in
a selective suppression of the inflammatory response in the cecum tissue proximate
to one or more sites of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune response. In
some cases, the methods described herein can result in a selective suppression of
the inflammatory response in the ascending colon tissue proximate to one or more sites
of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune response. In some cases, the methods
described herein can result in a selective suppression of the inflammatory response
in the transverse colon tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease, while maintaining
the systemic immune response. In some cases, the methods described herein can result
in a selective suppression of the inflammatory response in the descending colon tissue
proximate to one or more sites of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune response.
In some cases, the methods described herein can result in a selective suppression
of the inflammatory response in the sigmoid colon tissue proximate to one or more
sites of disease, while maintaining the systemic immune response. In some examples,
the methods described herein can result in a 1% increase to 500% increase in one or
more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, or ten) of: the plasma,
serum, or blood level of IL-6; the plasma, serum, or blood level of IL-2; the plasma,
serum, or blood level of IL-1ϑ; the plasma, serum, or blood level of TNFα; the plasma,
serum, or blood level of IL-17A; the plasma, serum, or blood level of IL-22; the plasma,
serum, or blood level of interferon-K; the level of blood Th memory cells (CD44
+CD45RB
-CD4
+ cells); and the level of α4ϑ7 expression in blood cells; e.g., each as compared to
the corresponding level in a subject systemically administered the same dose of the
same IL-12/IL-23 inhibitor. Methods for determining the plasma, serum, or blood level
of IL-6; the plasma, serum, or blood level of IL-2; the plasma, serum, or blood level
of IL-1ϑ; the plasma, serum, or blood level of TNFα; the plasma, serum, or blood level
of IL-17A; the plasma, serum, or blood level of IL-22; the plasma, serum, or blood
level of interferon-K; the level of blood Th memory cells (CD44
+CD45RB
-CD4
+ cells); and the level of α4ϑ7 expression in blood cells are known in the art.
[0355] For example, treatment can result in a decrease (e.g., about 1% to about 99% decrease,
about 1% to about 95% decrease, about 1% to about 90% decrease, about 1% to about
85% decrease, about 1% to about 80% decrease, about 1% to about 75% decrease, about
1% to about 70% decrease, about 1% to about 65% decrease, about 1% to about 60% decrease,
about 1% to about 55% decrease, about 1% to about 50% decrease, about 1% to about
45% decrease, about 1% to about 40% decrease, about 1% to about 35% decrease, about
1% to about 30% decrease, about 1% to about 25% decrease, about 1% to about 20% decrease,
about 1% to about 15% decrease, about 1% to about 10% decrease, about 1% to about
5% decrease, about 5% to about 99% decrease, about 5% to about 95% decrease, about
5% to about 90% decrease, about 5% to about 85% decrease, about 5% to about 80% decrease,
about 5% to about 75% decrease, about 5% to about 70% decrease, about 5% to about
65% decrease, about 5% to about 60% decrease, about 5% to about 55% decrease, about
5% to about 50% decrease, about 5% to about 45% decrease, about 5% to about 40% decrease,
about 5% to about 35% decrease, about 5% to about 30% decrease, about 5% to about
25% decrease, about 5% to about 20% decrease, about 5% to about 15% decrease, about
5% to about 10% decrease, about 10% to about 99% decrease, about 10% to about 95%
decrease, about 10% to about 90% decrease, about 10% to about 85% decrease, about
10% to about 80% decrease, about 10% to about 75% decrease, about 10% to about 70%
decrease, about 10% to about 65% decrease, about 10% to about 60% decrease, about
10% to about 55% decrease, about 10% to about 50% decrease, about 10% to about 45%
decrease, about 10% to about 40% decrease, about 10% to about 35% decrease, about
10% to about 30% decrease, about 10% to about 25% decrease, about 10% to about 20%
decrease, about 10% to about 15% decrease, about 15% to about 99% decrease, about
15% to about 95% decrease, about 15% to about 90% decrease, about 15% to about 85%
decrease, about 15% to about 80% decrease, about 15% to about 75% decrease, about
15% to about 70% decrease, about 15% to about 65% decrease, about 15% to about 60%
decrease, about 15% to about 55% decrease, about 15% to about 50% decrease, about
15% to about 45% decrease, about 15% to about 40% decrease, about 15% to about 35%
decrease, about 15% to about 30% decrease, about 15% to about 25% decrease, about
15% to about 20% decrease, about 20% to about 99% decrease, about 20% to about 95%
decrease, about 20% to about 90% decrease, about 20% to about 85% decrease, about
20% to about 80% decrease, about 20% to about 75% decrease, about 20% to about 70%
decrease, about 20% to about 65% decrease, about 20% to about 60% decrease, about
20% to about 55% decrease, about 20% to about 50% decrease, about 20% to about 45%
decrease, about 20% to about 40% decrease, about 20% to about 35% decrease, about
20% to about 30% decrease, about 20% to about 25% decrease, about 25% to about 99%
decrease, about 25% to about 95% decrease, about 25% to about 90% decrease, about
25% to about 85% decrease, about 25% to about 80% decrease, about 25% to about 75%
decrease, about 25% to about 70% decrease, about 25% to about 65% decrease, about
25% to about 60% decrease, about 25% to about 55% decrease, about 25% to about 50%
decrease, about 25% to about 45% decrease, about 25% to about 40% decrease, about
25% to about 35% decrease, about 25% to about 30% decrease, about 30% to about 99%
decrease, about 30% to about 95% decrease, about 30% to about 90% decrease, about
30% to about 85% decrease, about 30% to about 80% decrease, about 30% to about 75%
decrease, about 30% to about 70% decrease, about 30% to about 65% decrease, about
30% to about 60% decrease, about 30% to about 55% decrease, about 30% to about 50%
decrease, about 30% to about 45% decrease, about 30% to about 40% decrease, about
30% to about 35% decrease, about 35% to about 99% decrease, about 35% to about 95%
decrease, about 35% to about 90% decrease, about 35% to about 85% decrease, about
35% to about 80% decrease, about 35% to about 75% decrease, about 35% to about 70%
decrease, about 35% to about 65% decrease, about 35% to about 60% decrease, about
35% to about 55% decrease, about 35% to about 50% decrease, about 35% to about 45%
decrease, about 35% to about 40% decrease, about 40% to about 99% decrease, about
40% to about 95% decrease, about 40% to about 90% decrease, about 40% to about 85%
decrease, about 40% to about 80% decrease, about 40% to about 75% decrease, about
40% to about 70% decrease, about 40% to about 65% decrease, about 40% to about 60%
decrease, about 40% to about 55% decrease, about 40% to about 50% decrease, about
40% to about 45% decrease, about 45% to about 99% decrease, about 45% to about 95%
decrease, about 45% to about 90% decrease, about 45% to about 85% decrease, about
45% to about 80% decrease, about 45% to about 75% decrease, about 45% to about 70%
decrease, about 45% to about 65% decrease, about 45% to about 60% decrease, about
45% to about 55% decrease, about 45% to about 50% decrease, about 50% to about 99%
decrease, about 50% to about 95% decrease, about 50% to about 90% decrease, about
50% to about 85% decrease, about 50% to about 80% decrease, about 50% to about 75%
decrease, about 50% to about 70% decrease, about 50% to about 65% decrease, about
50% to about 60% decrease, about 50% to about 55% decrease, about 55% to about 99%
decrease, about 55% to about 95% decrease, about 55% to about 90% decrease, about
55% to about 85% decrease, about 55% to about 80% decrease, about 55% to about 75%
decrease, about 55% to about 70% decrease, about 55% to about 65% decrease, about
55% to about 60% decrease, about 60% to about 99% decrease, about 60% to about 95%
decrease, about 60% to about 90% decrease, about 60% to about 85% decrease, about
60% to about 80% decrease, about 60% to about 75% decrease, about 60% to about 70%
decrease, about 60% to about 65% decrease, about 65% to about 99% decrease, about
65% to about 95% decrease, about 65% to about 90% decrease, about 65% to about 85%
decrease, about 65% to about 80% decrease, about 65% to about 75% decrease, about
65% to about 70% decrease, about 70% to about 99% decrease, about 70% to about 95%
decrease, about 70% to about 90% decrease, about 70% to about 85% decrease, about
70% to about 80% decrease, about 70% to about 75% decrease, about 75% to about 99%
decrease, about 75% to about 95% decrease, about 75% to about 90% decrease, about
75% to about 85% decrease, about 75% to about 80% decrease, about 80% to about 99%
decrease, about 80% to about 95% decrease, about 80% to about 90% decrease, about
80% to about 85% decrease, about 85% to about 99% decrease, about 85% to about 95%
decrease, about 85% to about 90% decrease, about 90% to about 99% decrease, about
90% to about 95% decrease, or about 95% to about 99% decrease) in one or more (e.g.,
two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, or ten) of: the level of interferon-K
in GI tissue, the level of IL-1ϑ in GI tissue, the level of IL-6 in GI tissue, the
level of IL-22 in GI tissue, the level of IL-17A in the GI tissue, the level of TNFI
in GI tissue, the level of IL-2 in GI tissue, the number of Th memory cells in Peyer's
patches, and the number of Th memory cells in mesentery lymph nodes, in a subject
(e.g., as compared to the level in the subject prior to treatment or compared to a
subject or population of subjects having a similar disease but receiving a placebo
or a different treatment) (e.g., for a time period of between about 1 hour to about
30 days (e.g., or any of the subranges herein) following the first administration
of an immune modulator using any of the compositions or devices described herein.
Exemplary methods for determining the endoscopy score are described herein and other
methods for determining the endoscopy score are known in the art. Exemplary methods
for determining the levels of interferon-K, IL-1ϑ, IL-6, IL-22, IL-17A, TNFI, and
IL-2 are described herein. Additional methods for determining the levels of these
cytokines are known in the art. Exemplary methods for determining the number of Th
memory cells in Peyer's patches and mesentery lymph nodes are described herein. Additional
methods for determining the number of Th memory cells in Peyer's patches and mesentery
lymph nodes are known in the art.
[0356] Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein can result, e.g., in a 1%
to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described herein) in one or
more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K; the
level of IL-1ϑ; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of II,-17A; the level
of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the duodenum tissue proximate to one or more sites
of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein can result, e.g.,
in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described herein) in
one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K;
the level of IL-1ϑ; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the
level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the ileum tissue proximate to one or more
sites of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein can result,
e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described herein)
in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K;
the level of II,-19; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the
level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the jejunum tissue proximate to one or more
sites of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein can result,
e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described herein)
in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K;
the level of IL-1ϑ; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the
level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the cecum tissue proximate to one or more
sites of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein can result,
e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described herein)
in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K;
the level of II,-19; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the
level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the ascending colon tissue proximate to one
or more sites of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods described herein
can result, e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges of this range described
herein) in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level
of interferon-K; the level of IL-1ϑ; the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level
of IL-17A; the level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in the transverse colon tissue
proximate to one or more sites of disease. Accordingly, in some cases, the methods
described herein can result, e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease (or any of the subranges
of this range described herein) in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six,
or seven) of the level of interferon-K; the level of IL-1ϑ; the level of IL-6; the
level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the level of TNFα; and the level of IL-2, in
the descending colon tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease. Accordingly,
in some cases, the methods described herein can result, e.g., in a 1% to 99% decrease
(or any of the subranges of this range described herein) in one or more (e.g., two,
three, four, five, six, or seven) of the level of interferon-K; the level of II,-19;
the level of IL-6; the level of IL-22; the level of IL-17A; the level of TNFα; and
the level of IL-2, in the sigmoid colon tissue proximate to one or more sites of disease.
[0357] In some cases, the amount of the S1P modulator that is administered is from about
1 mg to about 500 mg. In some cases, the amount of the S1P modulator that is administered
is from about 1 mg to about 100 mg. In some cases, the amount of the S1P modulator
that is administered is from about 5 mg to about 40 mg.
[0358] In some cases, the amount of the S1P modulator that is administered is less than
an amount that is effective when the S1P modulator is delivered systemically.
[0359] In some cases, the amount of the S1P modulator that is administered is an induction
dose. In some cases, such induction dose is effective to induce remission of the TNF
and cytokine storm and healing of acute inflammation and lesions. In some cases, the
induction dose is administered once a day. In some cases, the induction dose is administered
once every three days. In some cases, the induction dose is administered once a week.
In some cases, the induction dose is administered once a day, once every three days,
or once a week, over a period of about 6-8 weeks.
[0360] In some cases, the method comprises administering (i) an amount of the S1P modulator
that is an induction dose, and (ii) an amount of the S1P modulator that is a maintenance
dose, in this order. In some cases, step (ii) is repeated one or more times. In some
cases, the induction dose is equal to the maintenance dose. In some cases, the induction
dose is greater than the maintenance dose. In some cases, the induction dose is five
times greater than the maintenance dose. In some cases, the induction dose is two
times greater than the maintenance dose.
[0361] In some cases, the induction dose is the same as or higher than an induction dose
administered systemically for treatment of the same disorder to a subject. In more
particular cases, the induction dose is the same as or higher than an induction dose
administered systemically for treatment of the same disorder to a subject, and the
maintenance dose is lower than the maintenance dose administered systemically for
treatment of the same disorder to a subject. In some cases, the induction dose is
the same as or higher than an induction dose administered systemically for treatment
of the same disorder to a subject, and the maintenance dose is higher than the maintenance
dose administered systemically for treatment of the same disorder to a subject.
[0362] In some cases an induction dose of S1P modulator and a maintenance dose of S1P modulator
are each administered to the subject by administering a pharmaceutical composition
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of the S1P modulator, wherein the pharmaceutical
composition is a device. In some cases an induction dose of S1P modulator is administered
to the subject in a different manner from the maintenance dose. As an example, the
induction dose may be administered systemically. In some cases, the induction dose
may be administered other than orally. As an example, the induction dose may be administered
rectally. As an example, the induction dose may be administered intravenously. As
an example, the induction dose may be administered subcutaneously. In some cases,
the induction dose may be administered by spray catheter.
[0363] In some cases, the concentration of the S1P modulator delivered at the location in
the gastrointestinal tract is 10%, 25%, 50%, 75%, 100%, 200%, 300%, 400%, 500%, 1000%,
2000% greater than the concentration of S1P modulator in plasma.
[0364] In some cases, the method provides a concentration of the S1P modulator at the colon
(a site of disease) that is 2-100 times greater than at a location that is not a site
of disease.
[0365] In some cases, the method comprises delivering the S1P modulator at the cecum as
a single bolus.
[0366] In some cases, the method comprises delivering the S1P modulator at the cecum as
more than one bolus.
[0367] In some cases, the method comprises delivering the S1P modulator at the cecum in
a continuous manner.
[0368] In some cases, the method comprises delivering the S1P modulator at the cecum over
a time period of 20 or more minutes.
[0369] In some cases, the method provides a concentration of the S1P modulator in the plasma
of the subject that is less than 10 µg/ml. In some cases, the method provides a concentration
of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 3 µg/ml. In some
cases, the method provides a concentration of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the
subject that is less than 1 µg/ml. In some cases, the method provides a concentration
of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 0.3 µg/ml. In
some cases, the method provides a concentration of the S1P modulator in the plasma
of the subject that is less than 0.1 µg/ml. In some cases, the method provides a concentration
of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 0.01 µg/ml. In
some cases, the values of the concentration of the S1P modulator in the plasma of
the subject provided herein refer to C
trough, that is, the lowest value of the concentration prior to administration of the next
dose.
[0370] In some cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 10 µg/ml. In
some cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 3 µg/ml.
In some cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 1 µg/ml. In some
cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 0.3 µg/ml. In
some cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 0.1 µg/mL. In
some cases, the method provides a concentration C
max of the S1P modulator in the plasma of the subject that is less than 0.01 µg/mL.
[0371] In some cases, the methods disclosed herein comprise producing a therapeutically
effective degradation product of the S1P modulator in the gastrointestinal tract.
In some cases, a therapeutically effective amount of the degradation product is produced.
[0372] In some embodiments, the methods comprising administering the S1P modulator in the
manner disclosed herein disclosed herein result in a reduced immunosuppressive properties
relative to methods of administration of the S1P modulator systemically.
[0373] In some embodiments, the methods comprising administering the S1P modulator in the
manner disclosed herein disclosed herein result in reduced immunogenicity relative
to methods of administration of the S1P modulator systemically.
[0374] In some cases, the subject is further administered an additional therapeutic agent
(e.g., any of the additional therapeutic agents described herein). The additional
therapeutic agent can be administered to the subject at substantially the same time
as the S1P modulator or pharmaceutical composition comprising it is administered and/or
at one or more other time points. In some cases, the additional therapeutic agent
is formulated together with the S1P modulator (e.g., using any of the examples of
formulations described herein).
[0375] In some cases, the subject is administered a dose of the S1P modulator at least once
a month (e.g., at least twice a month, at least three times a month, at least four
times a month, at least once a week, at least twice a week, three times a week, once
a day, or twice a day). The S1P modulator may be administered to a subject chronically.
Chronic treatments include any form of repeated administration for an extended period
of time, such as repeated administrations for one or more months, between a month
and a year, one or more years, more than five years, more than 10 years, more than
15 years, more than 20 years, more than 25 years, more than 30 years, more than 35
years, more than 40 years, more than 45 years, or longer. Alternatively, or in addition,
chronic treatments may be administered. Chronic treatments can involve regular administrations,
for example one or more times a day, one or more times a week, or one or more times
a month. For example, chronic treatment can include administration (e.g., intravenous
administration) about every two weeks (e.g., between about every 10 to 18 days).
[0376] A suitable dose may be the amount that is the lowest dose effective to produce a
desired therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the
factors described herein. If desired, an effective daily dose of S1P modulator can
be administered as two, three, four, five, or six or more sub-doses administered separately
at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms. In
some examples, administration of an S1P modulator using any of the compositions or
devices described herein can result in the onset of treatment (e.g., a reduction in
the number, severity, or duration of one or more symptoms and/or markers of any of
the diseases described herein) or drug-target engagement in a subject within a time
period of about 10 minutes to about 10 hours of administration of a dose of a S1P
modulator using any of the devices or compositions described herein. Drug-target engagement
may be determined, for example, as disclosed in
Simon GM, Niphakis MJ, Cravatt BF, Nature chemical biology. 2013;9(4):200-205.
In some cases, administration of a S1P modulator using any of the devices or compositions
described herein can provide for treatment (e.g., a reduction in the number, severity,
and/or duration of one or more symptoms and/or markers of any of the disorders described
herein in a subject) for a time period of between about 1 hour to about 30 days in
a subject following first administration of a S1P modulator using any of the compositions
or devices described herein. Non-limiting examples of symptoms and/or markers of a
disease described herein are described below.
[0377] For example, treatment can result in a decrease (e.g., about 1% to about 99% decrease)
in one or more (e.g., two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, or nine) of: the
level of interferon-K in GI tissue, the level of IL-1ϑ in GI tissue, the level of
IL-6 in GI tissue, the level of IL-22 in GI tissue, the level of IL-17A in the GI
tissue, the level of TNFI in GI tissue, the level of IL-2 in GI tissue, and endoscopy
score in a subject (e.g., as compared to the level in the subject prior to treatment
or compared to a subject or population of subjects having a similar disease but receiving
a placebo or a different treatment) (e.g., for a time period of between about 1 hour
to about 30 days (e.g., or any of the subranges herein) following the first administration
of a S1P modulator using any of the compositions or devices described herein. As used
herein, "GI tissue" refers to tissue in the gastrointestinal (GI) tract, such as tissue
in one or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon,
descending colon, sigmoid colon, and rectum, more particularly in the proximal portion
of one or more of duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon,
descending colon, and sigmoid colon, or in the distal portion of one or more of duodenum,
jejunum, ileum, cecum, ascending colon, transverse colon, descending colon, and sigmoid
colon. The GI tissue may be, for example, GI tissue proximate to one or more sites
of disease. Exemplary methods for determining the endoscopy score are described herein
and other methods for determining the endoscopy score are known in the art. Exemplary
methods for determining the levels of interferon-K, IL-1ϑ, IL-6, IL-22, IL-17A, TNFI,
and IL-2 are described herein. Additional methods for determining the levels of these
cytokines are known in the art.
[0378] In some examples, treatment can result in an increase (e.g., about 1% to about 500%
increase) in one or both of stool consistency score and weight of a subject (e.g.,
as compared to the level in the subject prior to treatment or compared to a subject
or population of subjects having a similar disease but receiving a placebo or a different
treatment) (e.g., for a time period of between about 1 hour to about 30 days (e.g.,
or any of the subranges herein) following the first administration of a S1P modulator
using any of the compositions or devices described herein. Exemplary methods for determining
stool consistency score are described herein. Additional methods for determining a
stool consistency score are known in the art.
Combination therapy
[0379] The S1P modulator disclosed herein may be optionally used with additional agents
in the treatment of the diseases disclosed herein. Nonlimiting examples of such agents
for treating or preventing inflammatory bowel disease in such adjunct therapy (e.g.,
Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis) include substances that suppress cytokine production,
down-regulate or suppress self-antigen expression, or mask the MHC antigens. Examples
of such agents include 2- amino-6-aryl-5 -substituted pyrimidines (see
U.S. Patent No. 4,665,077); non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs); ganciclovir; tacrolimus; glucocorticoids
such as Cortisol or aldosterone; anti-inflammatory agents such as a cyclooxygenase
inhibitor; a 5 -lipoxygenase inhibitor; or a leukotriene receptor antagonist; purine
antagonists such as azathioprine or mycophenolate mofetil (MMF); alkylating agents
such as cyclophosphamide; bromocryptine; danazol; dapsone; glutaraldehyde (which masks
the MHC antigens, as described in
U.S. Patent No. 4,120,649); anti-idiotypic antibodies for MHC antigens and MHC fragments; cyclosporine; 6-mercaptopurine;
steroids such as corticosteroids or glucocorticosteroids or glucocorticoid analogs,
e.g., prednisone, methylprednisolone, including SOLU-MEDROL
®, methylprednisolone sodium succinate, and dexamethasone; dihydrofolate reductase
inhibitors such as methotrexate (oral or subcutaneous); anti-malarial agents such
as chloroquine and hydroxychloroquine; sulfasalazine; leflunomide; cytokine or cytokine
receptor antibodies or antagonists including anti-interferon-alpha, -beta, or -gamma
antibodies, a TNF inhibitor, such as anti-tumor necrosis factor(TNF)-alpha antibodies
(infliximab (REMICADE
®) or adalimumab), anti-TNF- alpha immunoadhesin (etanercept), anti-TNF-beta antibodies,
anti-interleukin-2 (IL-2) antibodies and anti-IL-2 receptor antibodies, and anti-interleukin-6
(IL-6) receptor antibodies and antagonists; anti-LFA-1 antibodies, including anti-CD
1la and anti-CD 18 antibodies; anti- L3T4 antibodies; heterologous anti-lymphocyte
globulin; pan-T antibodies, anti-CD3 or anti-CD4/CD4a antibodies; soluble peptide
containing a LFA-3 binding domain (
WO 90/08187 published Jul. 26, 1990); streptokinase; transforming growth factor-beta (TGF-beta); streptodomase; RNA or
DNA from the host; FK506; RS-61443; chlorambucil; deoxyspergualin; rapamycin; T-cell
receptor (
Cohen et al., U.S. Patent No. 5,114,721); T-cell receptor fragments (
Offner et al., Science, 251:430-432 (1991);
WO 90/11294;
Ianeway, Nature, 341:482 (1989); and
WO 91/01133); BAFF antagonists such as BAFF or BR3 antibodies or immunoadhesins and zTNF4 antagonists
(for review, see
Mackay and Mackay, Trends Immunol, 23: 113-5 (2002) and see also definition below); biologic agents that interfere with T cell helper
signals, such as anti-CD40 receptor or anti-CD40 ligand (CD 154), including blocking
antibodies to CD40-CD40 ligand (e.g.,
Durie et al., Science, 261:1328-30 (1993);
Mohan et al., J. Immunol., 154: 1470-80 (1995)) and CTLA4-Ig (
Finck et al., Science, 265: 1225-7 (1994)); and T-cell receptor antibodies (
EP 340,109) such as T10B9. Non-limiting examples of adjunct agents also include the following:
budenoside; epidermal growth factor; aminosalicylates; metronidazole; mesalamine;
olsalazine; balsalazide; antioxidants; thromboxane inhibitors; IL-1 receptor antagonists;
anti-IL-1 monoclonal antibodies; growth factors; elastase inhibitors; pyridinyl-imidazole
compounds; TNF antagonists; IL-4, IL-10, IL-13 and/or TGFβ cytokines or agonists thereof
(e.g., agonist antibodies); IL-11; glucuronide- or dextran-conjugated prodrugs of
prednisolone, dexamethasone or budesonide; ICAM-I antisense phosphorothioate oligodeoxynucleotides
(ISIS 2302; Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc.); soluble complement receptor 1 (TPlO; T Cell
Sciences, Inc.); slow-release mesalazine; antagonists of platelet activating factor
(PAF); ciprofloxacin; and lignocaine. Examples of agents for UC are sulfasalazine
and related salicylate-containing drugs for mild cases and corticosteroid drugs in
severe cases. Topical administration of either salicylates or corticosteroids is sometimes
effective, particularly when the disease is limited to the distal bowel, and is associated
with decreased side effects compared with systemic use. Supportive measures such as
administration of iron and antidiarrheal agents are sometimes indicated. Azathioprine,
6-mercaptopurine and methotrexate are sometimes also prescribed for use in refractory
corticosteroid-dependent cases.
[0380] A S1P modulator as described herein may be administered with one or more of: a CHST15
inhibitor, a IL-6 receptor inhibitor, a TNF inhibitor, an integrin inhibitor, a JAK
inhibitor, a SMAD7 inhibitor, a IL-13 inhibitor, an IL-1 receptor inhibitor, a TLR
agonist, an immunosuppressant, a live biotherapeutic such as a stem cell, IL-10 or
an IL-10 agonist, copaxone, a CD40/CD40L inhibitor, a CD3 inhibitor (as defined herein),
a CD14 inhibitor (as defined agent), a CD20 inhibitor (as defined herein), a CD25
inhibitor (as defined herein), a CD28 inhibitor (as defined herein), a CD49 inhibitor
(as defined herein), and a CD89 inhibitor.
[0382] In some disclosures, the methods disclosed herein comprise administering (i) the
S1P modulator as disclosed herein, and (ii) a second agent orally, intravenously or
subcutaneously, wherein the second agent in (ii) is the same S1P modulator in (i);
a different S1P modulator; or an agent having a different biological target from the
S1P modulator.
[0383] In some cases, the methods disclosed herein comprise administering (i) the S1P modulator
in the manner disclosed herein, and (ii) a second agent orally, intravenously or subcutaneously,
wherein the second agent in (ii) is an agent suitable for treating an inflammatory
bowel disease.
[0384] In some cases, the S1P modulator is administered prior to the second agent. In some
cases, S1P modulator is administered after the second agent. In some cases, the S1P
modulator and the second agent are administered substantially at the same time. In
some cases, the S1P modulator is delivered prior to the second agent. In some cases,
the S1P modulator is delivered after the second agent. In some cases, the S1P modulator
and the second agent are delivered substantially at the same time.
[0385] In some cases, the second agent is an agent suitable for the treatment of a disease
of the gastrointestinal tract. In some cases, the second agent is an agent suitable
for the treatment of an inflammatory bowel disease. In some cases, the second agent
is administered intravenously. In some cases, the second agent is administered subcutaneously.
In some cases, the second agent is methotrexate.
[0386] In some cases, delivery of the S1P modulator to the cecum, such as delivery to the
cecum by mucosal contact, results in systemic immunogenicity levels at or below systemic
immunogenicity levels resulting from administration of the S1P modulator systemically.
In some cases comprising administering the S1P modulator in the manner disclosed herein
and a second agent systemically, delivery of the S1P modulator to the cecum, such
as delivery to the cecum by mucosal contact, results in systemic immunogenicity levels
at or below systemic immunogenicity levels resulting from administration of the S1P
modulator systemically and the second agent systemically. In some disclosures, the
method comprises administering the S1P modulator in the manner disclosed herein and
a second agent, wherein the amount of the second agent is less than the amount of
the second agent when the S1P modulator and the second agent are both administered
systemically. In some aspects of these cases, the second agent is a S1P modulator.
[0387] In some cases, the method comprises administering the S1P modulator in the manner
disclosed herein and does not comprise administering a second agent.
EXAMPLES
Example 1 - Preclinical Murine Colitis Model
Experimental Induction of Colitis
[0388] Colitis is experimentally induced to mice via the dextran sulfate sodium (DSS)-induced
colitis model. This model is widely used because of its simplicity and many similarities
with human ulcerative colitis. Briefly, mice are subjected to DSS via cecal catheterization,
which is thought to be directly toxic to colonic epithelial cells of the basal crypts,
for several days until colitis is induced.
Groups
[0389] Mice are allocated to one of seven cohorts, depending on the agent that is administered:
- 1. Control (no agent)
- 2. Adalimumab (2.5 mg/kg)
- 3. Adalimumab (5 mg/kg)
- 4. Adalimumab (10 mg/kg)
[0390] The control or agent is applied to a damaged mucosal surface of the bowel via administration
through a cecal catheter at the dose levels described above.
[0391] Additionally, for each cohort, the animals are separated into two groups. One group
receives a single dose of the control or agent on day 10 or 12. The other group receives
daily (or similar) dosing of the control or agent.
Analysis
[0392] For each animal, efficacy is determined (e.g., by endoscopy, histology, etc.), and
cytotoxic T-cell levels are determined in blood, feces, and tissue (tissue levels
are determined after animal sacrifice). For tissue samples, levels HER2 are additionally
determined, and the level of cytotoxic T cells is normalized to the level of HER2.
Additionally, other cytokine levels are determined in tissue (e.g., phospho STAT 1,
STAT 3 and STAT 5), in plasma (e.g., VEGF, VCAM, ICAM, IL-6), or both.
[0393] Pharmacokinetics are determined both systemically (e.g., in the plasma) and locally
(e.g., in colon tissue). For systemic pharmacokinetic analysis, blood and/or feces
is collected from the animals at one or more timepoints after administration (e.g.,
plasma samples are collected at 15 minutes, 30 minutes, 1 hour, 2 hours, 4 hours,
and/or 8 hours after administration). Local/colon tissue samples are collected once
after animal sacrifice.
Example 2a - Development of Preclinical Porcine Colitis Model
Experimental Induction of Colitis
[0394] Female swine weighing approximately 35 to 45 kg at study start are fasted at least
24 hours prior to intra-rectal administration of trinitrobenzene sulfonic acid (TNBS).
Animals are lightly anesthetized during the dosing and endoscopy procedure. An enema
to clean the colon is used, if necessary. One animal is administered 40 ml of 100%
EtOH mixed with 5 grams of TNBS diluted in 10 ml of water via an enema using a ball-tipped
catheter. The enema is deposited in the proximal portion of the descending colon just
past the bend of the transverse colon. The TNBS is retained at the dose site for 12
minutes by use of two Foley catheters with 60-ml balloons placed in the mid-section
of the descending colon below the dose site. A second animal is similarly treated,
but with a solution containing 10 grams of TNBS. An Endoscope is employed to positively
identify the dose site in both animals prior to TNBS administration. Dosing and endoscopy
are performed by a veterinary surgeon
[0395] Seven (7) days after TNBS administration, after light anesthesia, the dose site and
mucosal tissues above and below the dose site are evaluated by the veterinary surgeon
using an endoscope. Pinch Biopsies are obtained necessary, as determined by the surgeon.
Based on the endoscopy findings, the animals may be euthanized for tissue collection
on that day, or may proceed on study pending the results of subsequent endoscopy exams
for 1 to 4 more days. Macroscopic and microscopic alterations of colonic architecture,
possible necrosis, thickening of the colon, and substantial histologic changes are
observed at the proper TNBS dose.
[0396] Clinical signs (e.g., ill health, behavioral changes, etc.) are recorded at least
daily during acclimation and throughout the study. Additional pen-side observations
are conducted twice daily (once-daily on weekends). Body weight is measured for both
animals Days 1 and 7 (and on the day of euthanasia if after Day 7).
[0397] On the day of necropsy, the animals are euthanized via injection of a veterinarian-approved
euthanasia solution. Immediately after euthanasia in order to avoid autolytic changes,
colon tissues are collected, opened, rinsed with saline, and a detailed macroscopic
examination of the colon is performed to identify macroscopic finings related to TNBS-damage.
Photos are taken. Tissue samples are taken from the proximal, mid, and distal transverse
colon; the dose site; the distal colon; the rectum; and the anal canal. Samples are
placed into NBF and evaluated by a board certified veterinary pathologist.
Example 2b - Pharmacokinetic/Pharmacodynamic and Bioavailability of Adalimumab After
Topical Application
Groups
[0398] Sixteen (16) swine (approximately 35 to 45 kg at study start) are allocated to one
of five groups:
- 1. Vehicle Control: (3.2 mL saline); intra-rectal; (n=2)
- 2. Treated Control: Adalimumab (40mg in 3.2mL saline); subcutaneous; (n=2)
- 3. Adalimumab (low): Adalimumab (40mg in 3.2mL saline); intra-rectal; (n=4)
- 4. Adalimumab (med): Adalimumab (80mg in 3.2 mL saline); intra-rectal; (n=4)
- 5. Adalimumab (high): Adalimumab (160mg in 3.2 mL saline); intra-rectal; (n=4)
[0399] On Day 0, the test article is applied to a damaged mucosal surface of the bowel via
intra-rectal administration or subcutaneous injection by a veterinary surgeon at the
dose levels and volume described above.
Clinical Observations and Body Weight
[0400] Clinical observations are conducted at least once daily. Clinical signs (e.g., ill
health, behavioral changes, etc.) are recorded on all appropriate animals at least
daily prior to the initiation of experiment and throughout the study until termination.
Additional clinical observations may be performed if deemed necessary. Animals whose
health condition warrants further evaluation are examined by a Clinical Veterinarian.
Body weight is measured for all animals Days -6, 0, and after the last blood collections.
Samples
Blood:
[0401] Blood is collected (cephalic, jugular, and/or catheter) into EDTA tubes during acclimation
on Day-7, just prior to dose on Day 0, and 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 24, and 48 hours
post-dose. The EDTA samples are split into two aliquots and one is centrifuged for
pharmacokinetic plasma and either analyzed immediately, or stored frozen (-80°C) for
later pharmacokinetic analyses. The remaining sample of whole blood is used for pharmacodynamic
analyses.
Feces:
[0402] Feces is collected Day -7, 0 and 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 24 and 48 hours post-dose,
and either analyzed immediately, or flash-frozen on liquid nitrogen and stored frozen
at -70°C pending later analysis of drug levels and inflammatory cytokines.
Tissue:
[0403] Immediately after euthanasia in order to avoid autolytic changes, colon tissues are
collected, opened, rinsed with saline, and a detailed macroscopic examination of the
colon is performed to identify macroscopic finings related to TNBS-damage. Triplicate
samples of normal and damaged tissues are either analyzed immediately, or are flash-frozen
on liquid nitrogen and stored frozen at -70°C pending later analysis of drug concentration,
inflammatory cytokines and histology.
[0404] Samples are analyzed for adalimumab levels (local mucosal tissue levels and systemic
circulation levels), and for levels of inflammatory cytokines including TNF-alpha.
Terminal Procedures
[0405] Animals are euthanized as per the schedule in Table 5, where one animal each of Vehicle
and Treated Control groups is euthanized at 6 and 48 hours post-dose, and one animal
of each the adalimumab groups are euthanized at 6, 12, 24 and 48 hours post-dose.
Animals are discarded after the last blood collection unless retained for a subsequent
study.
Table 5
Example 2c - Pharmacokinetic/Pharmacodynamic and Bioavailability of Adalimumab After
Topical Application
Groups
[0406] DSS-induced colitis Yorkshire-Cross Farm Swine (approximately 5-10 kg at study start)
are allocated to one of five groups:
- 1. Vehicle Control: (saline); intra-rectal;
- 2. Treated Control: Adalimumab (13 mg in saline); subcutaneous;
- 3. Adalimumab: Adalimumab (13 mg in saline); intra-rectal;
[0407] At t = 0, the test article is applied to a damaged mucosal surface of the bowel via
intra-rectal administration or subcutaneous injection by a veterinary surgeon at the
dose levels and volume described above.
Clinical Observations
[0408] Clinical signs (e.g., ill health, behavioral changes, etc.) are recorded on all appropriate
animals at least daily prior to the initiation of experiment and throughout the study
until termination. Additional clinical observations may be performed if deemed necessary.
Animals whose health condition warrants further evaluation are examined by a Clinical
Veterinarian.
Samples
Blood:
[0409] Blood is collected (cephalic, jugular, and/or catheter) into EDTA tubes during acclimation
on Day-7, just prior to dose on Day 0, and 12 hours post-dose. The EDTA samples are
split into two aliquots and one is centrifuged for pharmacokinetic plasma and either
analyzed immediately, or stored frozen (-80°C) for later pharmacokinetic analyses.
The remaining sample of whole blood is used for pharmacodynamic analyses.
Feces:
[0410] Feces is collected Day -7, 0 and 12 hours post-dose, and either analyzed immediately,
or flash-frozen on liquid nitrogen and stored frozen at -70°C pending later analysis
of drug levels and inflammatory cytokines.
Tissue:
[0411] Immediately after euthanasia (12 hours after dosing) in order to avoid autolytic
changes, colon tissues are collected, opened, rinsed with saline, and a detailed macroscopic
examination of the colon is performed to identify macroscopic finings related to DSS-damage.
Triplicate samples of normal and damaged tissues are either analyzed immediately,
or are flash-frozen on liquid nitrogen and stored frozen at -70°C pending later analysis
of drug concentration, inflammatory cytokines and histology.
[0412] Samples are analyzed for adalimumab levels (local mucosal tissue levels and systemic
circulation levels), and for levels of inflammatory cytokines including TNF-alpha.
Terminal Procedures
[0413] Animals are euthanized at 12 hours post-dose.
Example 3. Comparison of Systemic versus Intracecal Delivery of an Anti-IL-12 Antibody
[0414] The objective of this study was to compare the efficacy of an IL-12 inhibitor (anti-IL-12
p40; anti-p40 mAb; BioXCell (Cat#: BE0051)), when dosed systemically versus intracecally,
to the treat dextran sulfate sodium salt (DSS)-induced colitis in male C57B1/6 mice.
Materials and Methods
[0415] Mice. Normal male C57B1/6 mice between the ages of 6-8 weeks old, weighing 20-24 g, were
obtained from Charles River Laboratories. The mice were randomized into thirteen groups
of twelve animals and two groups of eight animals, and housed in groups of 6-8 per
cage, and acclimatized for at least three days prior to entering the study. Animal
rooms were set to maintain a minimum of 12 to 15 air changes per hour, with an automatic
timer for a light/dark cycle of 12 hours on/off, and fed with Labdiet 5053 sterile
rodent chow, with water administered
ad libitum.
Cecal Cannulation
[0416] Animals were placed under isoflurane anesthesia, with the cecum exposed via a midline
incision in the abdomen. A small point incision was made in the distal cecum where
1-2 cm of the cannula was inserted. The incision was closed with a purse string suture
using 5-0 silk. An incision was then made in the left abdominal wall through which
the distal end of the cannula was inserted and pushed subcutaneously to the dorsal
aspect of the back. The site was then washed copiously with warmed saline prior to
closing the abdominal wall. A small incision was also made in the skin of the back
between the shoulder blades, exposing the tip of the cannula. The cannula was secured
in place using suture, wound clips, and tissue glue. All animals received 1 mL of
warm sterile saline (subcutaneous injection) and were monitored closely until recovery
before returning to their cage. All animals received 0.6 mg/kg BID buprenorphine for
the first 3 days, and Baytril
® at 10mg/Kg every day for the first 5 days post surgery.
Induction of Colitis
[0417] Colitis was induced in male C57B1/6 mice by exposure to 3% DSS drinking water (MP
Biomedicals #0260110) from Day 0 to Day 5. Fresh DSS/water solutions were made again
on Day 3 and any of the remaining original DSS solution will be discarded.
Assessment of Colitis
[0418] All animals were weighed daily and visually assessed for the presence of diarrhea
and/or bloody stool at the time of dosing. The mice underwent two video endoscopies,
one on day 10 and one on day 14, to assess colitis severity. Images were captured
from each animal at the most severe region of disease identified during the endoscopy,
and assessed using the rubric demonstrated in Table 6. Additionally, stool consistency
was scored during the endoscopy using this rubric (Table 7) (0 = Normal, well-formed
pellet, 1 = Loose stool, soft, staying in shape, 2 = Loose stool, abnormal form with
excess moisture, 3 = Watery or diarrhea, 4 = Bloody diarrhea). At necropsy, intestinal
contents, peripheral blood, and tissue, and cecum/colon contents were collected for
analysis.
Table 6: Endoscopy Scoring
| Score |
Description of Endoscopy Score |
| 0 |
Normal |
| 1 |
Loss of vascularity |
| 2 |
Loss of vascularity and friability |
| 3 |
Friability and erosions |
| 4 |
Ulcerations and bleeding |
Table 7: Stool Consistency Score
| Score |
Description of Stool Consistency |
| 0 |
Normal, well-formed pellet |
| 1 |
Loose stool, soft, staying in shape |
| 2 |
Loose stool, abnormal form with excess moisture |
| 3 |
Watery or diarrhea |
| 4 |
Bloody diarrhea |
Treatment of Colitis
[0419] Mice were treated with anti-IL-12 p40 during the acute phase of colitis due to its
efficacy in the treatment of DSS-induced colitis. The test article was dosed at a
volume of 0.1 mL/20 g from days 0 to 14. Anti-IL-12 p40 was administered intraperitoneally
at a dose of 10 mg/kg every 3 days, and intracecally at a dose of 10 mg/kg, either
every 3 days or every day. There was also a lower dose of 1 mg/kg given every day
intracecally. The control groups were not administered drugs, and the vehicles (sterile
PBS) were administered the placebo drug intraperitoneally and intracecally every day.
These drugs were given from days 5-14, which is 9 days of administration. A more detailed
explanation of dosing and groups can be seen in Table 8.
Table 8: Groups of Animals
| Group # |
# of Animals |
DSS |
Cecal Cannula |
Treatment |
Dose(mg/ kg) |
Route |
Dosing Schedule |
| 1 |
8 males |
--- |
NO |
--- |
--- |
--- |
--- |
| 2 |
8 males |
--- |
YES |
--- |
--- |
--- |
--- |
| 3 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
NO |
Vehicle |
--- |
PO |
QD day 0-14 |
| 4 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
Vehicle |
--- |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
| 5 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
NO |
Anti-p40 |
10 |
IP |
Q3 0,3,6,9,12 |
| 6 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
Anti-p40 |
10 |
IC |
Q3 0,3,6,9,12 |
| 7 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
Anti-p40 |
10 |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
| 8 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
Anti-p40 |
1 |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
Sample Collection
[0420] Intestinal contents, peripheral blood, and tissue were collected at sacrifice on
day 14, as follows: at the end of each study period, mice were euthanized by CO
2 inhalation immediately following endoscopy on day 14. The blood was collected via
cardiac puncture into K
2EDTA-coated tubes and centrifuged at 4000 x g for 10 minutes. The blood cell pellet
was retained and snapped frozen. The resulting plasma was then split into two separate
cryotubes, with 100 µL in one tube and the remainder in the second. Plasma and cell
pellet were also collected, flash frozen, and stored at -80 degrees Celsius.
[0421] The cecum and colon were removed from each animal and contents were collected, weighed,
and snap frozen in separate cryovials. The colon was excised, rinsed, measured, weighed,
and then trimmed to 6 cm in length and divided into 5 pieces. The most proximal 1
cm of colon was snapped frozen for subsequent bioanalysis of test article levels.
Of the remaining 5 cm of colon, the most distal and proximal 1.5-cm sections was placed
in formalin for 24 hours then transferred to 70% ethanol for subsequent histological
evaluation. The middle 2-cm portion was bisected longitudinally and placed into two
separate cryotubes, weighed, and snap frozen in liquid nitrogen.
Results
[0422] The data in Figure 30 show that the DSS mice that were intracecally administered
an anti-IL-12 p40 (IgG2A) antibody had decreased weight loss as compared to DSS mice
that were intraperitoneally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody.
[0423] The data in Figure 31 show that the plasma concentration of the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody
was decreased in DSS mice that were intracecally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody
as compared to DSS mice that were intraperitoneally administered the anti-IL-12 p40
antibody. The data in Figure 32 show that the cecum and colon concentration of the
anti-IL-12 p40 antibody is increased in DSS mice that were intracecally administered
the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody as compared to the DSS mice that were intraperitoneally
administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody.
[0424] The data in Figures 33 and 34 show that the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody is able to penetrate
colon tissues (the lumen superficial, lamina propria, submucosa, and tunica muscularis/serosa)
in DSS mice intracecally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody, while the anti-IL-12
p40 antibody did not detectably penetrate the colon tissues of DSS mice intraperitoneally
administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody. The data in Figure 35 also show that the
ratio of the concentration of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody in colon tissue to the concentration
of the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody in plasma is increased in DSS mice intracecally administered
the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody as compared to the ratio in DSS mice intraperitoneally
administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody.
[0425] The data in Figure 36 show that the concentration of IL-1ϑ in colon tissue is decreased
in DSS mice intracecally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody as compared to the
concentration of IL-1ϑ in colon tissue in DSS mice intraperitoneally administered
the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody. The data in Figure 37 show that the concentration of
IL-6 in colon tissue is decreased in DSS mice intracecally administered the anti-IL-12
p40 antibody as compared to the concentration of IL-6 in colon tissue in DSS mice
intraperitoneally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody. The data in Figure 38
show that the concentration of IL-17A in colon tissue is decreased in DSS mice intracecally
administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody as compared to the concentration of IL-17A
in colon tissue in DSS mice intraperitoneally administered the anti-IL-12 p40 antibody.
[0426] No significant differences in clinical observations or gastrointestinal-specific
adverse effects, including stool consistency and/or bloody stool, were observed due
to cannulation or intra-cecal treatments when compared with vehicle. No toxicity resulting
from the treatments was reported. A significant reduction in body weight-loss (AUC)
was found in groups treated with anti-IL-12 p40 antibody (10 mg/kg and 1mg/kg, QD)
via intra-cecal delivery when compared with vehicle control and intraperitoneal delivery
(10 mg/kg, Q3D). The immunohistochemistry staining in anti-IL-12 p40 antibody (10
mg/kg, QD) treatment groups showed penetration of the antibody in all layers of colon
tissue, including lumen mucosa, lamina propria, submucosa, tunica muscularis, via
intra-cecal delivery. The distribution of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody was found in all
segments of the colon, however, higher levels were detected in the proximal region.
A significantly higher mean concentration of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody was found in
the gastrointestinal contents and colon tissues when delivered via intra-cecal administration
(Anti-p40: 10 mg/kg and 1mg/kg, QD) compared with intraperitoneal administration (anti-p40:
10 mg/kg, Q3D). The blood level of anti-IL-12 p40 antibody was significantly higher
when delivered via intraperitoneal administration (Q3D) as compared to intra-cecal
administration (Q3D & QD). The concentrations of inflammatory cytokines, including
IL-1β, IL-6, and IL-17, were significantly reduced by anti-IL-12 p40 antibody (10
mg/kg, QD) treatment when delivered via intra-cecal administration as compared to
vehicle controls.
[0427] In sum, these data show that the compositions and devices provided herein can suppress
the local immune response in the intestine, while having less of a suppressive effect
on the systemic immune response of an animal. These data also suggest that the presently
claimed compositions and devices will provide for treatment of colitis and other pro-inflammatory
disorders of the intestine.
Example 4. Comparison of Systemic versus Intracecal Delivery of an Anti-Integrin α4β7
Antibody
[0428] The objective of this study was to compare the efficacy of an integrin inhibitor
(anti-integrin α4β7; anti-LPAM1; DATK-32 mAb; BioXCell (Cat#: BE0034)) when dosed
systemically versus intracecally for treating dextran sulfate sodium salt (DSS)-induced
colitis in male C57B1/6 mice.
Materials and Methods
Mice
[0429] Normal male C57B1/6 mice between the ages of 6-8 weeks old, weighing 20-24 g, were
obtained from Charles River Laboratories. The mice were randomized into thirteen groups
of twelve animals and two groups of eight animals, and housed in groups of 6-8 per
cage, and acclimatized for at least three days prior to entering the study. Animal
rooms were set to maintain a minimum of 12 to 15 air changes per hour, with an automatic
timer for a light/dark cycle of 12 hours on/off, and fed with Labdiet 5053 sterile
rodent chow, with water administered
ad libitum.
Cecal Cannulation
[0430] The animals were placed under isoflurane anesthesia, with the cecum exposed via a
midline incision in the abdomen. A small point incision was made in the distal cecum
where 1-2 cm of the cannula was inserted. The incision was closed with a purse string
suture using 5-0 silk. An incision was then made in the left abdominal wall through
which the distal end of the cannula was inserted and pushed subcutaneously to the
dorsal aspect of the back. The site was then washed copiously with warmed saline prior
to closing the abdominal wall. A small incision was also made in the skin of the back
between the shoulder blades, exposing the tip of the cannula. The cannula was secured
in place using suture, wound clips, and tissue glue. All animals received 1 mL of
warm sterile saline (subcutaneous injection) and were monitored closely until recovery
before returning to their cage. All animals received 0.6 mg/kg BID buprenorphine for
the first 3 days, and Baytril
® at 10mg/Kg every day for the first 5 days post-surgery.
Induction of Colitis
[0431] Colitis was induced in male C57B1/6 mice by exposure to 3% DSS drinking water (MP
Biomedicals #0260110) from day 0 to day 5. Fresh DSS/water solutions were made again
on day 3 and any of the remaining original DSS solution will be discarded.
Assessment of Colitis
[0432] All animals were weighed daily and visually assessed for the presence of diarrhea
and/or bloody stool at the time of dosing. Mice underwent two video endoscopies, one
on day 10 and one on day 14, to assess colitis severity. Images were captured from
each animal at the most severe region of disease identified during the endoscopy,
and assessed using the rubric demonstrated in Table 2.1. Additionally, stool consistency
was scored during the endoscopy using this rubric (Table 2.2) (0 = Normal, well-formed
pellet, 1= Loose stool, soft, staying in shape, 2 = Loose stool, abnormal form with
excess moisture, 3 = Watery or diarrhea, 4 = Bloody diarrhea). At necropsy, intestinal
contents, peripheral blood and tissue, and cecum/colon contents were collected for
analysis.
Table 2.1. Endoscopy Score
| Score |
Description of Endoscopy Score |
| 0 |
Normal |
| 1 |
Loss of vascularity |
| 2 |
Loss of vascularity and friability |
| 3 |
Friability and erosions |
| 4 |
Ulcerations and bleeding |
Table 2.2. Stool Consistency Score
| Score |
Description of Stool Consistency |
| 0 |
Normal, well-formed pellet |
| 1 |
Loose stool, soft, staying in shape |
| 2 |
Loose stool, abnormal form with excess moisture |
| 3 |
Watery or diarrhea |
| 4 |
Bloody diarrhea |
Treatment of Colitis
[0433] Mice were treated with DATK32 during the acute phase of colitis due to its efficacy
in the treatment of DSS-induced colitis. The test article was dosed at a volume of
0.1 mL/20 g from days 0 to 14. DATK32 was administered intraperitoneally at a dose
of 25 mg/kg every 3 days, and intracecally at a dose of 25 mg/kg, either every 3 days
or every day. There was also a lower dose of 5 mg/kg given every day intracecally.
The control groups were not administered drugs, and the vehicle (sterile PBS) was
administered as the placebo drug intraperitoneally and intracecally every day. These
drugs were given from days 5-14, which is 9 days of administration. A more detailed
explanation of dosing and groups can be seen in Table 2.3.
Table 2.3. Groups of Mice
| Group # |
# of Animals |
DSS |
Cecal Cannula |
Treatment |
Dose(mg/ kg) |
Route |
Dosing Schedule |
| 1 |
8 males |
--- |
NO |
--- |
--- |
--- |
--- |
| 2 |
8 males |
--- |
YES |
--- |
--- |
--- |
--- |
| 3 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
NO |
Vehicle |
--- |
PO |
QD day 0-14 |
| 4 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
Vehicle |
--- |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
| 9 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
NO |
DATK32 |
25 |
IP |
Q3 0,3,6,9,12 |
| 10 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
DATK32 |
25 |
IC |
Q3 0,3,6,9,12 |
| 11 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
DATK32 |
25 |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
| 12 |
12 males |
3% DSS (day 0-5) |
YES |
DATK32 |
5 |
IC |
QD day 0-14 |
Sample Collection
[0434] Intestinal contents, peripheral blood, and tissue were collected at sacrifice on
day 14, as follows: at the end of each study period, mice were euthanized by CO
2 inhalation immediately following endoscopy on day 14. The blood was collected via
cardiac puncture into K
2EDTA-coated tubes and centrifuged at 4000 x g for 10 minutes. The blood cell pellet
was retained and snapped frozen. The resulting plasma was then split into two separate
cryotubes, with 100 µL in one tube and the remainder in the second. Plasma and the
cell pellet were also collected, flash frozen, and stored at -80 degrees Celsius.
An ELISA was used to determine the level of rat IgG2A.
[0435] The cecum and colon were removed from each animal and contents were collected, weighed,
and snap frozen in separate cryovials. The colon was excised, rinsed, measured, weighed,
and then trimmed to 6 cm in length and divided into 5 pieces. The most proximal 1
cm of colon was snapped frozen for subsequent bioanalysis of anti-DATK32 levels. Of
the remaining 5 cm of colon, the most distal and proximal 1.5-cm sections was placed
in formalin for 24 hours then transferred to 70% ethanol for subsequent histological
evaluation. The middle 2-cm portion was bisected longitudinally and placed into two
separate cryotubes, weighed, and snap frozen in liquid nitrogen.
[0436] There was an additional collection of 100 µL of whole blood from all animals and
processed for FACS analysis of α4 and
β7 expression on T-helper memory cells. Tissue and blood were immediately placed in
FACS buffer (1x PBS containing 2.5% fetal calf serum) and analyzed using the following
antibody panel (Table 2.4).
Table 2.4. Fluorophore Labelled Antibodies Used in FACS Analysis
| Antibody Target |
Flurochrome |
Purpose |
| CD4 |
APC-Vio770 |
Defines T-Helper Cells |
| CD44 |
VioBlue |
Memory/Naive Discrimination |
| CD45RB |
FITC |
Memory/Naive Discrimination |
| α4 |
APC |
Defines T-helper memory subset of interest |
| ϑ7 |
PE |
Defines T-helper memory subset of interest |
| CD 16/32 |
- |
Fc Block |
Results
[0437] The data in Figure 39 show decreased weight loss in DSS mice intracecally administered
DATK antibody as compared to DSS mice that were intraperitoneally administered the
DATK antibody. The data in Figure 40 show that DSS mice intracecally administered
DATK antibody have a decreased plasma concentration of DATK antibody as compared to
DSS mice that were intraperitoneally administered DATK antibody. The data in Figures
41 and 42 show that DSS mice intracecally administered DATK antibody have an increased
concentration of DATK antibody in the cecum and colon content as compared to DSS mice
intraperitoneally administered DATK antibody. The data in Figures 43 and 44 show that
DSS mice intracecally administered DATK antibody have an increased concentration of
DATK antibody in colon tissue as compared to DSS mice intraperitoneally administered
DATK antibody. The data in Figures 45 and 46 show an increased level of penetration
of DATK antibody into colon tissue in DSS mice intracecally administered the DATK
antibody as compared to an intracecal vehicle control (PBS). The data in Figure 47
show that DSS mice intracecally administered DATK antibody have an increased ratio
of the concentration of DATK antibody in colon tissue to the plasma concentration
of the DATK antibody, as compared to the same ratio in DSS mice intraperitoneally
administered the DATK antibody.
[0438] The data in Figure 48 show that DSS mice intracecally administered the DATK antibody
have an increased percentage of blood Th memory cells as compared to DSS mice intraperitoneally
administered the DATK antibody.
[0439] No significant differences in clinical observations or gastrointestinal-specific
adverse effects, including stool consistency and/or bloody stool, were observed due
to cannulation or intra-cecal treatments when compared with vehicle. No toxicity resulting
from the treatments was reported. A significant reduction in body weight-loss was
also found with DATK32 (5 mg/kg, QD) treatment (IC) when compared to vehicle control
at the endpoint (day 14). The immunohistochemistry staining in DATK32 (25 mg/kg, QD)
treatment groups showed penetration of DATK32 in all layers of colon tissue, including
lumen mucosa, lamina propria, submucosa, tunica muscularis, via intra-cecal delivery.
The distribution of DATK32 was found in all segments of the colon, however, higher
levels were detected in the proximal region. A significantly higher mean concentration
of DATK32 was found in gastrointestinal contents and colon tissues when delivered
via intra-cecal administration (DATK32: 25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg, QD) as compared to intraperitoneal
administration (DATK32: 25 mg/kg, Q3D). The blood level of DATK32 was significantly
higher when delivered via intraperitoneal administration (Q3D) as compared to intra-cecal
administration (Q3D & QD). The pharmacokinetics of DATK32 (25 mg/kg, QD) showed significantly
higher mean concentrations of DATK32 when delivered via intra-cecal administration
at 1, 2, and 4 h post-dose in the gastrointestinal contents, and 1, 2, 4 and 24 h
in colon tissue as compared with the mean concentrations of DATK32 following intraperitoneal
administration. The mean number of gut-homing T cells (Th memory cells) was significantly
higher in the blood of groups treated with DATK32 via intra-cecal administration (QD
25 mg/kg and QD 5 mg/kg) as compared to the groups treated with DATK32 via intraperitoneal
administration (Q3D 25 mg/kg). The mean number of Th memory cells was significantly
lower in the Peyer's Patches of groups treated with DATK32 via intra-cecal administration
(QD 25 mg/kg and 5 mg/kg) as compared to the groups treated with DATK32 via intraperitoneal
administration (Q3D 25 mg/kg). The mean number of Th memory cells in mesenteric lymph
nodes (MLN) was significantly lower in groups treated with DATK32 via intra-cecal
administratoin (QD and Q3D 25 mg/kg and QD 5 mg/kg) as compared to the groups treated
with DATK32 via intraperitoneal administration (Q3D 25 mg/kg).
[0440] In sum, these data show that the compositions and devices provided herein can suppress
the local immune response in the intestine, while having less of a suppressive effect
on the systemic immune response of an animal. These data also show that the release
of DATK-32 antibody in the colon can result in a suppression of leukocyte recruitment
and may provide for the treatment of colitis and other pro-inflammatory diseases of
the intestine.
Example 5. An Assessment of DATK32 Bio-Distribution Following Intracecal Administration
in Male C57B1/6 Mice
[0441] The objective of this study is to assess DATK32 bio-distribution when dosed intracecally
in male C57B1/6 mice. A minimum of 10 days prior to the start of the experiment a
cohort of animals will undergo surgical implantation of a cecal cannula. A sufficient
number of animals will undergo implantation to allow for 24 cannulated animals to
be enrolled in the main study (e.g., 31 animals). Animals were dosed with vehicle
or test article via intracecal injection (IC) on Day 0 as indicated in Table 3. Animals
from all groups were sacrificed for terminal sample collection three hours following
test article administration.
Materials and Methods
Mice
[0442] Normal male C57B1/6 mice between the ages of 6-8 weeks old, weighing 20-24 g, were
obtained from Charles River Laboratories. The mice were randomized into two groups
of twelve animals, and housed in groups of 12 per cage, and acclimatized for at least
three days prior to entering the study. Animal rooms were set to maintain a minimum
of 12 to 15 air changes per hour, with an automatic timer for a light/dark cycle of
12 hours on/off, and fed with Labdiet 5053 sterile rodent chow, with water administered
ad libitum.
Cecal Cannulation
[0443] The animals were placed under isoflurane anesthesia, with the cecum exposed via a
midline incision in the abdomen. A small point incision was made in the distal cecum
where 1-2 cm of the cannula was inserted. The incision was closed with a purse string
suture using 5-0 silk. An incision was then made in the left abdominal wall through
which the distal end of the cannula was inserted and pushed subcutaneously to the
dorsal aspect of the back. The site was then washed copiously with warmed saline prior
to closing the abdominal wall. A small incision was also made in the skin of the back
between the shoulder blades, exposing the tip of the cannula. The cannula was secured
in place using suture, wound clips, and tissue glue. All animals received 1 mL of
warm sterile saline (subcutaneous injection) and were monitored closely until recovery
before returning to their cage. All animals received 0.6 mg/kg BID buprenorphine for
the first 3 days, and Baytril
® at 10mg/Kg every day for the first 5 days post-surgery.
Dosing
[0444] Animals were dosed IC at a volume of 0.075 mL/animal on Days 0 as indicated in Table
14.
Sacrifice
[0445] . All animals were euthanized by CO
2 inhalation three hours after Day 0 dosing.
Sample Collection
[0446] Terminal blood was collected and prepared for plasma using K
2EDTA as the anti-coagulant. The plasma will be split into two cryotubes, with 50 µL
in one tube (PK analysis) and the remainder in another (other). Both samples were
flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen. Plasma was stored at -80°C for downstream analysis.
Mesenteric lymph nodes (mLN) were collected, weighed, and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen.
Mesenteric lymph nodes were stored at -80°C for downstream analysis. The small intestine
was excised and rinsed, and the most distal 1 cm of ilium was dissected, weighed,
and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen. The samples were stored at - 80°C for downstream
analysis. The cecum and colon were removed from each animal and contents collected,
weighed, and snap frozen in separate cryovials. The samples were stored at - 80°C
for downstream analysis. The colon was rinsed, and the most proximal 1 cm of colon
was weighed and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen. The snap frozen tissues were stored
at -80 °C.
Table 13: Study Design
| Group |
N° Animals |
Treatment |
Route |
Schedule |
Terminal Collections Day 0 |
| 1 |
12 |
Vehicle (PBS) |
IC |
Day 0 ** |
Blood (plasma) Small |
| 2 |
12 |
DATK32 (625 µg)∗ |
intestine mLN Colon |
| Colon Contents |
| Cecum Contents |
| *Per mouse. TA was administered in 0.075 mL/animal. DATK32 was delivered in sterile
PBS. |
| **Animals were dosed on Day 0 and collections were performed 3 hours later. |
Results
[0447] The data in FIGs. 63A-F show no significant differences in clinical observations.
No gastrointestinal-specific or adverse effects were found in the group administered
DATK32 via intra-cecal administration as compared to the group administered a vehicle
control. No toxicity resulting from the treatments was reported. The level of DATK32
in the group intracecally administered DATK32 was significantly higher in cecum and
colon content, and colon tissue compared to the group administered a vehicle control
at 3h post-dose. A small amount of DATK32 was also detected in plasma, small intestine,
and mesenteric lymph node in the group intracecally administered DATK32.
Example 6. Pharmacokinetics/Pharmacodynamics and Bioavailability of Adalimumab When Applied to a TNBS-damaged
Mucosal Surface (Induced Colitis) in Swine
[0448] The purpose of this non-Good Laboratory Practice (GLP) study was to explore the PK/PD,
and bioavailability of adalimumab when applied to a TNBS-damaged mucosal surface (induced
colitis) in Yorkshire-Cross farm swine, and to determine an appropriate dose and frequency
for studies where a drug will be delivered by the ingestible device system. The ingestible
device system will be capable of delivering a TNF inhibitor (adalimumab) topically
and locally to damaged mucosa in human patients with inflammatory bowel disease (IBD).
The TNBS-induced colitis model was validated when a single administration on Day 1
of 40 mL of 100% ethanol (EtOH) mixed with 5 grams of TNBS diluted in 10 mL of water
via an enema using a rubber catheter resulted in the intended reproducible induction
of damaged mucosal surface (induced colitis) in Yorkshire-Cross farm swine.
[0449] This study investigated whether topical delivery of adalimumab would result in increased
local mucosal tissue levels with limited drug reaching systemic circulation, as compared
to subcutaneous administration; whether local mucosal tissue levels of drug would
be greater in damaged tissues when compared to normal tissues; whether increasing
the dose of drug would result in increased mucosal tissue levels in local and distal
TNBS-damaged tissues; and whether topical delivery of adalimumab would result in reductions
in inflammatory cytokines such as TNF-α in damaged tissues, feces, and possibly blood.
[0450] All animals were subjected to intra-rectal administration of trinitrobenzene sulfonic
acid (TNBS) to induce chronic colitis on day -2. All animals were fasted prior to
colitis induction. Bedding was removed and replaced with rubber mats on day -3 to
prevent ingestion of straw bedding material. The dose was 40 mL of 100% EtOH mixed
with 5 grams of TNBS diluted in 10 mL of water, then instilled into the colon intra-rectally
using a flexible gavage tube by a veterinary surgeon (deposited in a 10-cm portion
of the distal colon and proximal rectum, and retained for 12 minutes by use of two
Foley catheters with 60-mL balloons). Approximately 3 days after induction, macroscopic
and microscopic alterations of colonic architecture were apparent: some necrosis,
thickening of the colon, and substantial histologic changes were observed (Figures
49 and 50). The study employed 15 female swine (approximately 35 to 45 kg at study
start) allocated to one of five groups. Group 1 employed three animals that were the
treated controls. Each animal in Group 1 was administered adalimumab by subcutaneous
injection at 40 mg in 0.8 mL saline. Groups 2, 3, 4, and 5 employed 3 animals in each
group. Animals in these groups were administered intra-rectal adalimumab at 40 mg
in 0.8 mL saline. The test drug (adalimumab) was administered to all groups on study
day 1. The intra-rectal administrations (Groups 2-5) were applied to damaged mucosal
surface of the bowel vial intra-rectal administration by a veterinary surgeon. Blood
(EDTA) was collected from all animals (cephalic, jugular, or catheter) on day -3 (n=15),
-1 (n=15), and 6 (n=15), 12 (n=12), 24 (n=9), and 48 (n=6) hours post-dose (87 bleeds
total). The EDTA samples were split into two aliquots, and one was centrifuged for
PK plasma, and stored frozen (-80°C) for PK analyses and reporting. Fecal samples
were collected for the same time-points (87 fecal collections). Fecal samples were
flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen and then stored at -80°C for analysis of drug levels
and inflammatory cytokines. Groups 2, 3, 4, and 5 were euthanized and subjected to
gross necropsy and tissue collection 6, 12, 24, and 48 hours post-dose, respectively.
Group 1 was similarly euthanized and necropsied 48 hours post-dose. The animals were
euthanized via injection of a veterinarian-approved euthanasia solution as per the
schedule. Immediately after euthanasia in order to avoid autolytic changes, colon
tissues were collected, opened, rinsed with saline, and a detailed macroscopic examination
of the colon were performed to identify macroscopic findings related to TNBS-damage.
Tissue samples were taken from the proximal, mid, and distal transverse colon; the
dose site; and the distal colon. Each tissue sample was divided into two approximate
halves; one tissue section was placed into 10% neutral buffered formalin (NBF) and
evaluated by a Board certified veterinary pathologist, and the remaining tissue section
was flash frozen in liquid nitrogen and stored frozen at -80 °C. Clinical signs (ill
health, behavioral changes, etc.) were recorded daily beginning on day -3. Additional
pen-side observations were conducted once or twice daily. Animals observed to be in
ill health were examined by a veterinarian. Body weight was measured for all animals
on day -3, and prior to scheduled euthanasia. Tables 14A and 14B, depicted below,
show the study design.
Materials and Methods
Test Article
[0451] Adalimumab (EXEMPTIA
™) is a Tumor Necrosis Factor (TNF) inhibitor. A single dose was pre-filled in a syringe
(40 mg in a volume of 0.8 mL).
Table 14A: Study Design Table
Table 14B: Study Design Table
Results
[0452] While subcutaneously administered adalimumab was detected at all times points tested
in plasma, topically administered adalimumab was barely detectable in plasma (Figures
51 and 52). Both topical delivery and subcutaneous delivery of adalimumab resulted
in reduced levels of TNF-α in colon tissue of TNBS-induced colitis animals, yet topical
delivery of adalimumab was able to achieve a greater reduction in TNF-α levels (Figures
53 and 54).
[0453] Either subcutaneous or intra-rectal administration of adalimumab was well tolerated
and did not result in death, morbidity, adverse clinical observations, or body weight
changes. A decreased level of total TNBS-related inflammatory response was observed
by adalimumab treatment via intra-rectal administration when applied to the damaged
mucosal surface of the bowel when compared to subcutaneous delivery. A significantly
higher concentration of adalimumab was measured in blood following subcutaneous delivery
as compared to the blood concentration following intra-rectal administration. Intra-rectal
administration of adalimumab decreased the total and normalized TNFα concentration
over time (6~48h) and was more effective at reducing TNFα at the endpoint (48h) as
compared to groups administered adalimumab subcutaneously.
[0454] In sum, these data show that the compositions and devices provided herein can suppress
the local immune response in the intestine, while having less of a suppressive effect
on the systemic immune response of an animal. For example, these data show that intracecal
administration of adalimumab using a device as described herein can provide for local
delivery of adalimumab to the site of disease, without suppressing the systemic immune
response. These data also show that local administration of adalimumab using a device
as described herein can result in a significant reduction of the levels of TNFα in
diseases animals.
Example 7. Comparison of Systemic Versus Intracecal Delivery of Cyclosporine A
[0455] The objective of this study was to compare the efficacy of an immunosuppressant agent
(cyclosporine A; CsA) when dosed systemically versus intracecally to treat dextran
sulfate sodium salt (DSS)-induced colitis in male C57B1/6 mice.
Experimental Design
[0456] A minimum of 10 days prior to the start of the experiment a cohort of animals underwent
surgical implantation of a cecal cannula. A sufficient number of animals underwent
implantation to allow for 44 cannulated animals to be enrolled in the main study (e.g.,
76 animals). Colitis was induced in 60 male C5Bl/6 mice by exposure to 3% DSS-treated
drinking water from day 0 to day 5. Two groups of eight additional animals (cannulated
and non-cannulated) served as no-disease controls (Groups 1 and 2). Animals were dosed
with cyclosporine A via intraperitoneal injection (IP), oral gavage (PO), or intracecal
injection (IC) from day 0 to 14 as indicated in Table 16. All animals were weighed
daily and assessed visually for the presence of diarrhea and/or bloody stool at the
time of dosing. Mice underwent video endoscopy on days 10 and 14 to assess colitis
severity. Images were captured from each animal at the most severe region of disease
identified during endoscopy. Additionally, stool consistency was scored during endoscopy
using the parameters defined in Table 17. Following endoscopy on day 14, animals from
all groups were sacrificed and underwent terminal sample collection.
[0457] Specifically, animals in all treatment groups dosed on day 14 were sacrificed at
a pre-dosing time point, or 1, 2, and 4 hours after dosing (n=3 / group / time point).
Terminal blood was collected via cardiac puncture and prepared for plasma using K
2EDTA as the anti-coagulant. The blood cell pellet was retained and snap frozen while
the resulting plasma was split into two separate cryotubes, with 100 µL in one tube
and the remainder in the second. Additionally, the cecum and colon were removed from
all animals; the contents were collected, weighed, and snap frozen in separate cyrovials.
The colon was then rinsed, measured, weighed, and then trimmed to 6 cm in length and
divided into five pieces. The most proximal 1 cm of colon was snap frozen for subsequent
bioanalysis of cyclosporine A levels. Of the remaining 5 cm of colon, the most distal
and proximal 1.5-cm sections were each placed in formalin for 24 hours, then transferred
to 70% ethanol for subsequent histological evaluation. The middle 2-cm portion was
bisected longitudinally and placed into two separate cryotubes, weighed, and snap
frozen in liquid nitrogen. All plasma and frozen colon tissue were stored at -80 °C
for selected end point analysis. For all control animals in Groups 1-4, there was
an additional collection of 100 µL of whole blood from all animals which was then
processed for FACS analysis of α4 and β7 expression on T
H memory cells. The details of the study are shown in Table 15.
Table 15: Study Design
| Group Number |
1 |
2 |
3 |
4 |
13 |
14 |
15 |
| Number of Animals |
8 |
8 |
12 |
12 |
12 |
12 |
12 |
| Cecal Cannula |
NO |
YES |
NO |
YES |
NO |
YES |
YES |
| DSS |
N/A |
N/A |
3% DSS on Day 0 to Day 5 |
| Treatment |
none |
none |
vehicle |
vehicle |
CsA |
CsA |
CsA |
| Dose (mg/kg) |
N/A |
N/A |
N/A |
N/A |
10 |
10 |
3 |
| Route |
N/A |
N/A |
N/A |
N/A |
PO |
IC |
IC |
| Dosing Schedule |
N/A |
N/A |
QD: Day 0 to 14 |
QD: Day 0 to 14 |
QD: Day 0 to 14 |
QD: Day 0 to 14 |
QD: Day 0 to 14 |
| Endoscopy Schedule* |
Days 10 and 14 |
| Endpoints Day 14 |
Endoscopy, Colon weight/ length, stool score |
| Terminal Collection (all groups): Cecal contents, colon contents, |
| plasma, and colon tissue |
| FACS analysis collection of Groups 1-4: |
| Whole blood for the following FACS panel: CD4, CD44, CD45RB, α4, β7, CD 16/32 |
| PK Sacrifice |
N=3/ time points |
| |
At pre-dose and 1, 2, and 4 hours post-dosing |
| (Day 14) |
|
| *Animals were dosed once (QD) on Day 14 and plasma collected (K2EDTA) at pre-dosing,
1, 2, and 4 hours post-dosing from n=3/group/time point. Each collection was terminal. |
Experimental Procedures
Cecal Cannulation
[0458] Animals were placed under isoflurane anesthesia, and the cecum exposed via a mid-line
incision in the abdomen. A small point incision was made in the distal cecum through
which 1-2 cm of the cannula was inserted. The incision was closed with a purse-string
suture using 5-0 silk. An incision was made in the left abdominal wall through which
the distal end of the cannula was inserted and pushed subcutaneously to the dorsal
aspect of the back. The site was washed copiously with warmed saline prior to closing
the abdominal wall. A small incision was made in the skin of the back between the
shoulder blades, exposing the tip of the cannula. The cannula was secured in place
using suture, wound clips, and tissue glue. All animals received 1 mL of warm sterile
saline (subcutaneous injection) and were monitored closely until fully recovered before
returning to the cage. All animals received buprenorphine at 0.6 mg/kg BID for the
first 3 days, and Baytril
® at 10 mg/kg QD for the first 5 days following surgery.
Disease Induction
[0459] Colitis was induced on day 0 via addition of 3% DSS (MP Biomedicals, Cat #0260110)
to the drinking water. Fresh DSS/water solutions were made on day 3 and any of the
remaining original DSS solution was discarded.
Dosing
[0460] Animals were dosed by oral gavage (PO), intraperitoneal injection (IP), or intracecal
injection (IC) at a volume of 0.1 mL/20 g on days 0 to 14 as indicated in Table 16.
Body Weight and Survival
[0461] Animals were observed daily (weight, morbidity, survival, presence of diarrhea, and/or
bloody stool) in order to assess possible differences among treatment groups and/or
possible toxicity resulting from the treatments.
Animals Found Dead or Moribund
[0462] Animals were monitored on a daily basis and those exhibiting weight loss greater
than 30% were euthanized, and samples were not collected from these animals.
Endoscopy
[0463] Each mouse underwent video endoscopy on days 10 and 14 using a small animal endoscope
(Karl Storz Endoskope, Germany) under isoflurane anesthesia. During each endoscopic
procedure still images as well as video were recorded to evaluate the extent of colitis
and the response to treatment. Additionally, we attempted to capture an image from
each animal at the most severe region of disease identified during endoscopy. Colitis
severity was scored using a 0-4 scale (0 = normal; 1 = loss of vascularity; 2 =loss
of vascularity and friability; 3 = friability and erosions; 4 = ulcerations and bleeding).
Additionally, stool consistency was scored during endoscopy using the parameters defined
in Table 16.
Table 16: Stool Consistency
| Score |
Description |
| 0 |
Normal, well-formed pellet |
| 1 |
Loose stool, soft, staying in shape |
| 2 |
Loose stool, abnormal form with excess moisture |
| 3 |
Watery or diarrhea |
| 4 |
Bloody diarrhea |
Tissue/Blood for FACS
[0464] Tissue and blood were immediately placed in FACS buffer (1x phosphate-buffered saline
(PBS) containing 2.5% fetal calf serum (FCS)) and analyzed using the antibody panel
in Table 17.
Table 17: FACS Antibody Panel
| Antibody Target |
Fluorochrome |
Purpose |
| CD4 |
APC-Vio770 |
Defines TH cells |
| CD44 |
VioBlue |
Memory/ Naive discrimination |
| CD45RB |
FITC |
Memory/ Naive discrimination |
| α4 |
APC |
Defines TH-memory subset of interest |
| β7 |
PE |
Defines TH-memory subset of interest |
| CD 16/32 |
- |
Fc block |
Results
[0465] The data in Figure 55 show a decrease in weight loss is observed in DSS mice intracecally
administered cyclosporine A as compared to DSS mice orally administered cyclosporine
A. The data in Figure 56 show a decrease in plasma concentration of cyclosporine A
in DSS mice intracecally administered cyclosporine A as compared to DSS mice orally
administered cyclosporine A. The data in Figures 57-59 show an increased concentration
of cyclosporine A in the colon tissue of DSS mice intracecally administered cyclosporine
A as compared to the concentration of cyclosporine A in the colon tissue of DSS mice
orally administered cyclosporine A.
[0466] The data in Figure 60 show that DSS mice intracecally administered cyclosporine A
have an increased concentration of IL-2 in colon tissue as compared to DSS mice orally
administered cyclosporine A. The data in Figure 61 show that DSS mice intracecally
administered cyclosporine A have a decreased concentration of IL-6 in colon tissue
as compared to DSS mice orally administered cyclosporine A.
[0467] In sum, these data show that the compositions and devices provided herein can suppress
the local immune response in the intestine, while having less of a suppressive effect
on the systemic immune response of an animal. For example, these data demonstrate
that the present compositions and devices can be used to release cyclosporine A to
the intestine and that this results in a selective immune suppression in the colon,
while having less of an effect on the immune system outside of the intestine. These
data also suggest that the present compositions and devices will provide for the treatment
of colitis and other pro-inflammatory disorders of the intestine.
Example 8. Bellows Testing: Drug Stability Bench Test
[0468] Experiments were run to evaluate the effects that bellows material would have on
the function of a drug used as the dispensable substance. The experiments also evaluated
the effects on drug function due to shelf life in the bellows.
[0469] The adalimumab was loaded into simulated device jigs containing either tapered silicone
bellows or smooth PVC bellows and allowed to incubate for 4, 24, or 336 hours at room
temperature while protected from light. FIG. 64 illustrates the tapered silicone bellows,
and FIG. 65 illustrates the tapered silicone bellows in the simulated device jig.
FIG. 66 illustrates the smooth PVC bellows, and FIG. 67 illustrates the smooth PVC
in the simulated device jig.
[0471] The bellows were loaded as follows: aseptically wiped the dispensing port of the
simulated ingestible device jig with 70% ethanol; allowed to air dry for one minute;
used an adalimumab delivery syringe to load each set of bellows with 200 µL of drug;
took a photo of the loaded device; gently rotated the device such that the drug is
allowed to come in contact with all bellows surfaces; protected the bellows from light;
and incubate at room temperature for the predetermined time period to allow full contact
of the drug with all bellows' surfaces.
[0472] The drug was extracted as follows: after completion of the incubation period; the
device jig was inverted such that the dispensing port was positioned over a sterile
collection microfuge tube and petri dish below; five cubic centimeters of air was
drawn into an appropriate syringe; the lure lock was attached to the device jig; the
syringe was used to gently apply positive pressure to the bellow with air such that
the drug was recovered in the collection microfuge tube; where possible, a video of
drug dispensing was taken; samples were collected from each bellows type; a control
drug sample was collected by directly dispensing 200 µL of drug from the commercial
dispensing syringe into a sterile microfuge tube; the control drug-free sample was
collected by directly dispensing 200 µL of PBS using a sterile pipette into a sterile
microfuge tube; the collected drug was protected from light; and the drug was diluted
over the following dilution range (250, 125, 25, 2.5, 0.25, 0.025, 0.0125, 0.0025
µg) in sterile PBS to determine the IC
50 range of the drug.
[0473] To determine any effects storage conditions may have on drug efficacy in the device,
the drug (stored either in the syringe, silicon bellows, PVC bellows) was stored at
room temperature while protected from light for 24 hours and 72 hours. Samples were
then extracted and the steps in the preceding paragraph were repeated.
[0474] The AlphaLISA (LOCI
™) test method was used. Human TNFα standard dilution ranges were prepared as described
in Table 18.
Table 18
| Tube |
Vol. of human TNFα (µL) |
Vol. of diluent (µL) * |
[human TNFα] in standard curve |
| (g/mL in 5 µL) |
(pg/mL in 5 µL) |
| A |
10 µL of reconstituted human TNFα |
90 |
1E-07 |
100 000 |
| B |
60 µL of tube A |
140 |
3E-08 |
30 000 |
| C |
60 µL of tube B |
120 |
1E-08 |
10 000 |
| D |
60 µL of tube C |
140 |
3E-09 |
3 000 |
| E |
60 µL of tube D |
120 |
1E-09 |
1000 |
| F |
60 µL of tube E |
140 |
3E-10 |
300 |
| G |
60 µL of tube F |
120 |
1E-10 |
100 |
| H |
60 µL of tube G |
140 |
3E-11 |
30 |
| I |
60 µL of tube H |
120 |
1E-11 |
10 |
| J |
60 µL of tube I |
140 |
3E-12 |
3 |
| K |
60 µL of tube J |
120 |
1E-12 |
1 |
| L |
60 µL of tube K |
140 |
3E-13 |
0.3 |
| M ** (background) |
0 |
100 |
0 |
0 |
| N ** (background) |
0 |
100 |
0 |
0 |
| O ** (background) |
0 |
100 |
0 |
0 |
| P ** (background) |
0 |
100 |
0 |
0 |
[0475] The test was performed as follows: the above standard dilution ranges were in a separate
96-well plate; to ensure consistent mixing, samples were mixed up and down gently
with a pipette five times; a 384-well test plate was prepared according to the test
layout diagram depicted Table 19; five microliters of 10,000 pg/mL TNFα standard from
the previously made dilution plate was added to each corresponding concentration as
shown in Table 18; five microliters of recovered drug (directly from the commercial
syringe (A), from the silicone bellows (B Si), from the PVC bellows (B PVC), or from
the PBS control (C) was added into the corresponding wells described in Table 18;
the test plate was incubated for one hour at room temperature while protected from
light; 10 microliters of acceptor beads were added to each previously accessed well;
the wells were incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature while protected from light;
10 µL of biotinylated antibody was added to each previously accessed well; the wells
were incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature, while protected from light; the
room lights were darkened and 25 microliters of streptavidin (SA) donor beads were
added to each previously accessed well; the wells were incubated for 30 minutes at
room temperature while protected from light; the plate was read in Alpha Mode; and
the results were recorded. Upon addition of reagent(s) in the various steps, each
well was pipetted up and down three times to achieve good mixing.
Table 19
[0476] The data are shown in FIGs. 69-71. The data demonstrate that the bellows do not negatively
impact the drug function after shelf lives of 4 hours, 24 hours, or 336 hours. The
IC
50 values of the drug dispensed from the bellows were comparable to the IC
50 values of the standard dispensation method (Table 19). A slight right shift was noted
in the bellows curves after 24 hours (FIG. 70), but this shift was well within the
error bars of the curves. Tables 20-23 represent data of FIGs. 69-71, respectively.
Of note, when comparing mean (n=5) RFU data between test articles over the concentration
ranges significant differences (p<0.05) were discerned. However, these significant
differences did not favor either test article over time, suggesting that they were
not related to the performance of the material in response to the drug (FIGs. 69-71).
Table 20
| |
Needle control (A) |
Silicone Bellows (B) |
PVC Bellows (C) |
| 4 Hours |
0.0174 |
0.0169 |
0.0172 |
| 24 Hours |
0.0180 |
0.0180 |
0.0180 |
| 336 Hours |
0.0144 |
0.0159 |
0.0163 |
Table 21
| Statistics (Student's T-test, 2 tailed, non-pair-wise, for significance p<0.05) |
| Drug (micrograms) |
Needle control (A) vs. Silicone (B) |
Needle control (A) vs. PVC |
Silicone vs. PVC |
| 0.0001 |
0.911 |
0.008* |
0.268 |
| 0.0025 |
0.138 |
0.390 |
0.822 |
| 0.0125 |
0.122 |
0.118 |
0.771 |
| 0.025 |
0.143 |
0.465 |
0.020* |
| 0.25 |
0.591 |
0.984 |
0.350 |
| 2.5 |
0.243 |
0.124 |
0.169 |
| 125 |
0.867 |
0.688 |
0.182 |
| 250 |
0.681 |
0.184 |
0.108 |
Table 22
| Statistics (Student's T-test, 2 tailed, non-pair-wise, for significance p<0.05) |
| Drug (micrograms) |
Needle control (A) vs. Silicone (B) |
Needle control (A) vs. PVC |
Silicone vs. PVC |
| 0.0001 |
0.132 |
0.038* |
0.292 |
| 0.0025 |
0.003* |
0.076 |
0.575 |
| 0.0125 |
0.161 |
0.022* |
0.783 |
| 0.025 |
0.058 |
0.078 |
0.538 |
| 0.25 |
0.974 |
0.384 |
0.198 |
| 2.5 |
0.714 |
0.080 |
0.017* |
| 125 |
0.873 |
0.731 |
0.269 |
| 250 |
0.798 |
0.956 |
0.903 |
Table 23
| Statistics (Student's T-test, 2 tailed, non-pair-wise, for significance p<0.05) |
| Drug (micrograms) |
Needle control (A) vs. Silicone (B) |
Needle control (A) vs. PVC |
Silicone vs. PVC |
| 0.0001 |
0.858449 |
0.036847* |
0.026444 * |
| 0.0025 |
0.087379 |
0.280302 |
0.046767* |
| 0.0125 |
0.469282 |
0.057232 |
0.117194 |
| 0.025 |
0.02758* |
0.078234 |
0.373419 |
| 0.25 |
0.411548 |
0.258928 |
0.400498 |
| 2.5 |
0.368959 |
0.156574 |
0.006719* |
| 125 |
0.948649 |
0.246702 |
0.463735 |
| 250 |
0.485046 |
0.128993 |
0.705543 |
Example 9. A Comparison Study of Systemic vs Intracecal Delivery of SMAD7 Bio-Distribution
in DSS-Induced Colitis in Male C57Bl/6 Mice
[0477] The objective of this study was to compare the efficacy of novel test articles, e.g.,
fluorescent SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotides (SMAD7 AS), when dosed systemically versus
intracecally in the treatment of DSS-induced colitis, in male C57Bl/6 mice.
Experimental Design
[0478] A minimum of 10 days prior to the start of the experiment a cohort of animals underwent
surgical implantation of a cecal cannula. A sufficient number of animals underwent
implantation to allow for 12 cannulated animals to be enrolled in the main study (i.e.,
16 animals).
[0479] Colitis was induced in 12 male C57Bl/6 mice (Groups 4-5) by exposure to 3% DSS-treated
drinking water from Day 0 to Day 5. Three groups of six additional animals per group
(n = 6 cannulated; n = 12 non-cannulated; Groups 1-3) served as no-disease controls
(Groups 1-3). All animals were weighed daily and assessed visually for the presence
of diarrhea and/or bloody stool during this time.
[0480] Animals were dosed with test-article via oral gavage (PO) or intracecal injection
(IC) once on Day 9 as indicated in Table 26. The animals in Group 0 were not dosed.
The animals in Groups 2 and 4 were dosed PO with SMAD7 antisense. The animals in Groups
3 and 5 were dosed IC with SMAD7 antisense.
[0481] All animals were euthanized by CO
2 inhalation 12 hours after dosing, on Day 10. Terminal blood was collected into two
K
2EDTA tubes and processed for plasma. Both plasma and pellet samples were snap-frozen
in liquid nitrogen and stored at -80 °C. Cecum contents were removed and the contents
were split into two aliquots. Both aliquots were weighed and snap frozen in separate
cryovials in liquid nitrogen. The cecum was excised and bisected longitudinally; each
piece is separately weighed and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen. The colon contents
were removed and the contents were split into two aliquots. Both aliquots were weighed
and snap frozen in separate cryovials in liquid nitrogen. The colon was then rinsed,
and the most proximal 2 cm of colon was collected. This 2-cm portion was bisected
longitudinally; each piece was separately weighed and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen.
Snap-frozen blood pellet, cecum/colon contents, and tissue samples were used for downstream
fluorimetry or RP-HPLC. The details of the study design are shown in Table 24.
Table 24: Study design
| Group |
Nº Animals |
Cecal Cannula |
Colitis Induction |
Treatment |
Route |
Schedule |
Terminal Collections Dav 10 |
| 1 |
6 |
NO |
-- |
-- |
-- |
-- |
Whole blood, plasma, cecal contents, colon contents, cecal tissue, colon tissue |
| 2 |
6 |
NO |
Fluorescently labeled SMAD7 antisense 50 µg * |
PO |
QD |
| 3 |
6 |
YES |
IC |
| 4 |
6 |
NO |
3% DSS |
PO |
Day 9** |
| 5 |
6 |
YES |
Days 0-5 |
IC |
*Per mouse. TA is administered in 0.075 mL/animal.
**Animals are dosed on Day 9 and collections are performed 12 hours later. |
Materials and Methods
Mice
[0482] Normal male C57Bl/6 mice between the ages of 6-8 weeks old, weighing 20-24 g, were
obtained from Charles River Laboratories. The mice were randomized into five groups
of six mice each, and housed in groups of 8-15 per cage, and acclimatized for at least
three days prior to entering the study. Animal rooms were set to maintain a minimum
of 12 to 15 air changes per hour, with an automatic timer for a light/dark cycle of
12 hours on/off, and fed with Labdiet 5053 sterile rodent chow, with water administered
ad libitum.
Cecal Cannulation
[0483] The animals were placed under isoflurane anesthesia, with the cecum exposed via a
midline incision in the abdomen. A small point incision was made in the distal cecum,
where 1-2 cm of the cannula was inserted. The incision was closed with a purse string
suture using 5-0 silk. An incision was then made in the left abdominal wall through
which the distal end of the cannula was inserted and pushed subcutaneously to the
dorsal aspect of the back. The site was then washed copiously with warmed saline prior
to closing the abdominal wall. A small incision was also made in the skin of the back
between the shoulder blades, exposing the tip of the cannula. The cannula was secured
in place using suture, wound clips, and tissue glue. All animals were administered
1 mL of warm sterile saline (subcutaneous injection) and were monitored closely until
recovery before returning to their cage. All animals were administered 0.6 mg/kg BID
buprenorphine for the first 3 days, and Baytril
® at 10mg/Kg every day for the first 5 days post-surgery.
Disease Induction
[0484] Colitis was induced on Day 0 via addition of 3% DSS (MP Biomedicals, Cat #0260110)
to the drinking water. Fresh DSS/water solutions was provided on Day 3 and any of
the remaining original DSS solution is discarded.
Body Weight and Survival
[0485] Animals were observed daily (weight, morbidity, survival, presence of diarrhea and/or
bloody stool) in order to assess possible differences among treatment groups and/or
possible toxicity resulting from the treatments.
Animals Found Dead or Moribund
[0486] Animals were monitored on a daily basis. Animals exhibiting weight loss greater than
30% were euthanized, and samples were not collected from these animals.
Dosing
[0487] Animals were dosed with test-article via oral gavage (PO) or intracecal injection
(IC) once on Day 9 as indicated in Table 26. Animals in Group 0 were not dosed. Animals
in Groups 2 and 4 were dosed PO with SMAD7 antisense. Animals in Groups 3 and 5 were
dosed IC with SMAD7 antisense.
Sacrifice
[0488] All animals were euthanized by CO
2 inhalation 12 hours after dosing, on Day 10.
Sample Collection
[0489] Intestinal contents, peripheral blood and tissue were collected at sacrifice on Day
10, as follows:
Blood/Plasma
[0490] Terminal blood was collected into two K
2EDTA tubes and processed for plasma. The approximate volume of each blood sample was
recorded prior to centrifugation. Both plasma and pellet samples were snap-frozen
in liquid nitrogen and stored at -80 °C. The first pellet sample (sample 1) was used
for fluorimetry. The second pellet sample (sample 2) was used for RP-HPLC.
Cecum Contents
[0491] Cecum contents was removed and contents were split into two aliquots. Both aliquots
were weighed and snap frozen in separate cryovials in liquid nitrogen. The first sample
(sample 1) was used for fluorimetry. The second sample (sample 2) was used for RP-HPLC.
Cecum
[0492] The cecum was excised and bisected longitudinally; each piece was separately weighed
and snap-frozen. The first sample (sample 1) was used for fluorimetry. The second
sample (sample 2) was used for RP-HPLC.
Colon Contents
[0493] Colon contents were removed and contents were split into two aliquots. Both aliquots
were weighed and snap frozen in separate cryovials in liquid nitrogen. The first sample
(sample 1) was used for fluorimetry. The second sample (sample 2) was used for RP-HPLC.
Colon
[0494] The colon was rinsed, and the most proximal 2 cm of colon was collected and bisected
longitudinally. Each piece was separately weighed and flash-frozen in liquid nitrogen.
The first sample (sample 1) was used for fluorimetry. The second sample (sample 2)
was used for RP-HPLC.
SMAD7 Antisense Bioanalysis
[0495] Samples flash-frozen for fluorimetry were homogenized in 0.5 mL buffer RLT+ (Qiagen).
Homogenate was centrifuged (4000 x g; 10 minutes), and supernatant was collected.
Forty microliters of the sample was diluted 1:6 in 200 µL of bicarbonate solution
and 100 µL of diluted supernatant was analyzed on a fluorescent plate reader (485
excitation; 535 emission) in duplicate.
[0496] Prior to the above, assay development was performed as follows. Samples (as indicated
in
Sample Collection) were harvested from a naive animal and flash-frozen. Samples were then homogenized
in 0.5 mL buffer RLT+, homogenate was centrifuged (4000 x g; 10 minutes) and supernatant
was collected and diluted 1:6 with bicarbonate solution (i.e., 0.5 mL supernatant
was added to 2.5 mL of PBS). An aliquot (0.200 mL (90 µL for each duplicate) of each
diluted sample was pipetted into 15 (14 dilution of FAM-AS-SAMD7+ blank control) Eppendorf
tubes. One tube was set-aside to be used as a blank sample. Ten microliters of fluorescently-labeled
SMAD7 antisense was then spiked into all other sample to achieve final concentrations
of 50 µg/mL, 16.67 µg/mL, 5.56 µg/mL, 1.85 µg/mL, 0.62 µg/mL, 0.21 µg/mL, 0.069 µg/mL,
0.023 µg/mL, 7.6 ng/mL, 2.5 ng/mL, 0.847 ng/mL, 0.282 ng/mL, 0.094 ng/mL, and 0.024
ng/mL respectively. The fluorescently-labeled SMAD7 antisense was prepared and serially
diluted such that the volume added to each organ homogenate sample was the same for
each of the above concentrations. These samples were analyzed on a fluorescent plate
reader (485 excitation; 535 emission) in duplicate.
Processing for RP-HPLC
[0497] Samples flash-frozen for RP-HPLC were homogenized in buffer RLT+ (Qiagen). Homogenate
was centrifuged (4000 x g; 10 minutes), and supernatant was used to perform RP-HPLC
analysis.
Results
[0498] The data in Figures 73 and 74 show that significantly more SMAD7 anstisense oligonucleotide
was present in cecum tissue and colon tissue for mice with or without DSS treatment
that were intracecally administered the SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotide as compared
to mice with or without DSS treatment that were orally administered the SMAD7 antisense
oligonucleotide. The data in Figure 75 show that there is about the same level of
SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotide in the cecum contents of mice with or without DSS
treatment that were orally or intracecally administered the SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotide.
No SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotide was found in the plasma or white blood cell pellet
of SMAD7 antisense oligonucleotide treated mice.
Example 10. Comparison of the Tissue, Plasma, and GI Content Pharmacokinetics of Tacrolimus
through Oral vs. Intra-Cecal Ingestible Device Delivery in Yorkshire-Cross Farm Swine
[0499] The primary objective of this study was to compare the tissue, plasma, rectal sample,
and GI content pharmacokinetics of tacrolimus through oral versus intra-cecal ingestible
device delivery in normal Yorkshire-Cross farm swine.
[0500] This study compares the effects of administration of: a single intra-cecal administration
of an ingestible device containing 0.8 mL sterile vehicle solution (80% alcohol, 20%
castor oil (HCO-60)); a single oral dose of tacrolimus at 4 mg/0.8 mL (in sterile
vehicle solution); and a single intra-cecal administration of an ingestible device
containing either 1 mg/0.8 mL (in sterile vehicle solution), 2 mg/0.8 mL (in sterile
vehicle solution), or 4 mg /0.8 mL (in sterile vehicle solution).
[0502] Animals in Group 1 received an ingestible device containing 0.8 mL of vehicle solution
(80% alcohol, 20% HCO-60). Animals in Group 2 received orally 4 mL liquid formulation
of tacrolimus at 4 mg/0.8 mL per animal (Prograf: 5 mg/mL). Animals in Group 3 received
intracecally an ingestible device containing tacrolimus at 1 mg in 0.8 mL per ingestible
device. Animals in Group 4 received intracecally an ingestible device containing tacrolimus
at 2 mg in 0.8 mL per ingestible device. Animals in Group 5 received intracecally
an ingestible device containing tacrolimus at 4 mg in 0.8 mL per ingestible device.
To control for potential confounding effects of the surgery, all groups fast on Day
-11 at least 24 hr before being subjected to anesthesia followed by surgical placements
of a cecal port by a veterinary surgeon at Day -10. All animals were fasted for at
least 12 hr prior to dosing on Day 1. Animals were dosed via either intra-cecal dosing
(IC) or oral dosing (PO) at Day 1 (between 6-8 p.m.). All animals resumed feeding
at approximately 4 hours after dose (11-12 p.m. after dosing).
[0503] Animals in Group 1 (Vehicle Control) were administered a single intra-cecal ingestible
device containing 0.8 mL Vehicle solution (80% alcohol, 20% castor oil (HCO-60) on
Day 1. On Day -10 the animals were anesthetized, and a veterinary surgeon surgically
placed an intra-cecal port in each animal. On Day 1, each animal was placed into a
sling then a single intra-cecal ingestible device containing 0.8 mL vehicle solution
(80% alcohol, 20% castor oil (HCO-60)) is introduced by the veterinary surgeon into
the cecum via the cecal port in each animal. Following ingestible device placement,
the animals were removed from the slings and placed back into their pens with water.
All animals resumed feeding at approximately 4 hours after dose. Samples of rectal
contents were collected for pharmacokinetic analyses from each animal at each of 1,
3, 6, and 12 hours post-ingestible device placement using a fecal swab (rectal swab).
A total of 60 samples were collected.
[0504] Approximately 200-400 mg of rectal content were collected, if available, with a fecal
swab (Copan Diagnostics Nylon Flocked Dry Swabs, 502CS01). The fecal swab was pre-weighed
and weighed after collection in the collection tube (Sterile Tube and Cap No Media,
PFPM913S), and the sample weight was recorded. The fecal swab was broken via the breakpoint,
and was stored in the collection tube, and immediately frozen at -70 °C. Whole blood
(2 mL) was collected into K
2EDTA coated tubes for pharmacokinetics at each time-point of pre-dose and 1, 2, 3,
4, 6 and 12 hours post-dose. Immediately following euthanasia, tissue was collected.
A total of 105 samples were collected.
[0505] For tissue necropsy, small intestine fluid and cecal fluid were collected separately
from all the animals into two separate square plastic bottles, and stored at -20 °C.
The length and diameter of the cecum and the colon was measured from one animal in
each group and recorded for reference. Tissues were collected for pharmacokinetic
analyses and include mesenteric lymph nodes, a Peyer's Patch, and five gastrointestinal
sections, including cecum, proximal colon, transverse colon, distal colon, and rectum.
All samples were weighed, and the tissue sample weights were recorded. In each of
the five gastrointestinal sections, tissue samples were collected in three different
areas where the mucosal surface was visible and not covered by luminal content by
using an 8.0-mm punch biopsy tool. Around 3 grams of the total punched sample were
collected into a pre-weighed 15-mL conical tube, and the tissue weight was recorded.
Three mesenteric lymph nodes were collected from different areas and weighed. At least
one Peyer's Patch was collected and weighed. Tissues were snap-frozen in liquid nitrogen
and stored frozen at approximately -70 °C or below (total of 105 samples).
[0506] Luminal contents were collected for pharmacokinetic analyses from the surface of
the tissue from each of five gastrointestinal sections: cecum, proximal colon, transverse
colon, distal colon, and rectum (total of 75). The contents were collected in pre-weighed
15-mL conical tubes and the sample weights were recorded. Samples were snap-frozen
in liquid nitrogen stored frozen at approximately -70 °C or below.
[0507] After removing the luminal content, another set of tissue samples from 3 different
areas were collected via an 8.0-mm punch biopsy in each section of the five tissue
gastrointestinal sections described above. Around 3 grams of the total punched sample
were collected into a pre-weighed 15-mL conical tube, and the tissue weight was recorded
(total of 75). Tissues were snap-frozen in liquid nitrogen and stored frozen at approximately
-70 °C or below.
[0508] A 30-cm length of jejunum (separated into two 15 cm lengths), and the remaining distal
and transverse colon tissue sample (after tissue and luminal content were collected
for PK) were collected in one animal in each group of treatment, snap-frozen in liquid
nitrogen and stored frozen at approximately -70 °C or below. All samples for pharmacokinetic
analyses were stored on dry ice before analyses.
[0509] Group 2 animals were administered a single oral dose of tacrolimus at 4 mg/0.8 mL
(0.08-mg/kg) (in the vehicle solution) on Day 1. Plasma, rectal content sample, tissue
collection, GI content collection and related procedures/storage/shipments was the
same as those employed in Group 1.
[0510] Group 3 animals were administered a single intra-cecal ingestible device containing
tacrolimus at 1 mg/0.8 mL (0.02 mg/kg) (in the vehicle solution) on Day 1 by a veterinary
surgeon. Plasma, rectal content sample, tissue collection, GI content collection and
related procedures/storage/shipments was the same as those employed in Group 1. All
samples were analyzed for tacrolimus.
[0511] Group 4 animals were administered a single intra-cecal ingestible device of tacrolimus
at 2 mg/0.8 mL (0.04 mg/kg) (in sterile vehicle solution) on Day 1 by a veterinary
surgeon. Plasma, rectal content sample, tissue collection, GI content collection and
related procedures/storage/shipments were the same as those employed in Group 1. All
samples were analyzed for tacrolimus.
[0512] Group 5 animals are administered a single intra-cecal ingestible device containing
tacrolimus at 4 mg /0.8 mL (0.08 mg/kg) (in the vehicle solution) on Day 1 by a veterinary
surgeon. Plasma, rectal content sample, tissue collection, GI content collection and
related procedures/storage/shipments were the same as those employed in Group 1. All
samples were analyzed for tacrolimus.
[0513] Detailed clinical observations were conducted daily from Day -10 to -5, and on Day
1. Additional pen-side observations were conducted at least once each day. The animals
remained under constant clinical observation for the entire 12 hours from dose until
euthanasia. Body weights were collected on Day -10, Day -5, and pre-dose on Day 1.
Animals were euthanized via injection of a veterinarian-approved euthanasia.
Test Article and Formulation
1. Vehicle solution, 20 mL
[0514] Description: 80% alcohol, 20% PEG-60 castor oil
[0515] Physical characteristics: clear liquid solution.
2. Prograf (tacrolimus injection), 10 ampules
[0516] Description: A sterile solution containing the equivalent of 5 mg anhydrous tacrolimus
in 1 mL. Tacrolimus is macrolide immunosuppressant and the active ingredient of Prograf.
0.8 mL of Prograf (5 mg/mL) was administrated through oral gavage per animal in group
2. Prograf (5 mg/mL) was diluted 2x folds (2.5 mg/mL) and 4x folds (1.25 mg/mL) by
using vehicle solution. 0.8 mL of each concentration, 1.25 mg/mL, 2.5 mg/mL, and 5
mg/mL of Prograf, was injected into a DSS ingestible device for group 3, 4, and 5.
[0517] Formulation: Each mL contained polyoxyl 60 hydrogenated castor oil (HCO-60), 200
mg, and dehydrated alcohol, USP, 80.0% v/v.
[0518] Physical characteristics: clear liquid solution.
3. DDS ingestible device containing Tacrolimus
[0519] Description: Three (3) DDS ingestible devices containing vehicle solution for Group
1, three (3) DSS ingestible devices containing 1 mg tacrolimus for Group 3, three
(3) DDS ingestible devices containing 2 mg tacrolimus for Group 4, and three (3) DDS
ingestible devices containing 4 mg tacrolimus for Group 5.
Acclimation
[0520] Animals were acclimated prior to study initiation for at least 7 days. Animals in
obvious poor health were not placed on study.
Concurrent Medication
[0521] Other than veterinary-approved anesthetics and medications used during surgery to
install the ileocecal ports, or for vehicle or test article administration, and analgesia
and antibiotics post-surgery, no further medications were employed.
Feed
[0522] All swine were fasted at least 24 hours before being anesthetized and properly medicated
for surgery or overnight before dosing. Otherwise, animals were fed ad-libitum. Tap
water was pressure-reduced and passed through a particulate filter, then a carbon
filter prior to supply to an automatic watering system. Water was supplied ad libitum.
There were no known contaminants in the feed or water that would be expected to interfere
with this study.
Results
[0523] The data in Figure 76 show that the mean concentration of tacrolimus in the cecum
tissue and the proximate colon tissue were higher in swine that were intacecally administered
tacrolimus as compared to swine that were orally administered tacrolimus.
[0524] These data suggest that intra-cecal administration of tacrolimus is able to locally
deliver tacrolimus to the tissues in the GI tract of a mammal, while not decreasing
the systemic immune system of a mammal.
Example 11. Comparison of the Tissue, Plasma, and GI Content Pharmacokinetics of Adalimumab
through SC vs. Intra-Cecal Ingestible Device Delivery in Yorkshire-Cross Farm Swine
in DSS-induced Colitis
[0525] The purpose of this non-Good Laboratory Practice (GLP) study is to explore the PK/PD
and bioavailability of adalimumab when applied to (Dextran Sulfate Sodium Salt) DSS-induced
colitis in Yorkshire-cross farm swine, and to evaluate topical Humira (adalimumab
or ADA) in DSS-colitis in swine. Colitis was induced in weanling YorkShire-Cross farm
swine by administering DSS once daily for 7 consecutive days via oral gastric intubation.
The dose levels were chosen based on the doses and regimens used to induce colitis
in weanling pigs. The doses of DSS were 1.275 or 2.225 g/k/day for Groups 2 and 3
respectively.
[0526] This study used one group of 19- to 21-day old weanling swine, and 2 groups of three,
19- to 20-day old weanling swine that weighed from 6.5 to 7.5 kg on arrival. To induce
colitis, on study day 1 through and including day 7, animals in Groups 2 and 3 were
administered once daily oral (gastric intubation) doses of DSS at 8.5% or 15% w/v
for dose levels of 1.275 or 2.25 g/kg/day, respectively (Groups 2 and 3 respectively,
2 hours before morning feeding). The Group 1 control animals were administered sterile
saline only. Each animal was placed in a sling for dosing. Animals were fasted at
least 6 hours prior to each dose. See Table 26 below.
Table 26
[0527] The day following the last DSS dose, using endoscopy and a catheter, at 13 mg adalimumab
/0.8 mL /pig (one 40 mg adalimumab/0.8 mL dosage syringe was divided into 3 parts
and diluted with PBS) was placed in the proximal portion of the descending colon just
past the bend of the transverse colon. Alternatively, 13 mg of adalimumab was diluted
with PBS to a volume suitable for dosing post-weanling swine. Prior to dosing, endoscopy
photographs were taken of the mucosal surface of the colon. Animals were anesthetized
during adalimumab dosing. Prior to adalimumab dosing, animals were housed on rubber
mats to prevent ingestion of bedding material, and were fasted at least 24 hours.
The colon was cleansed using an enema prior to the procedure.
[0528] All animals were properly euthanized approximately 3 hours post-adalimumab-dose for
tissue collections and subjected to a gross necropsy with emphasis on the severity
of colitis (immediately after euthanasia, in order to avoid autolytic changes). All
samples for histology were fixed in a fixation medium and the punch-biopsy sample
snap-frozen in liquid nitrogen and stored frozen (-70 °C).
[0529] To measure drug content, tissue samples and luminal content were collected by gently
removing and collecting luminal content first, then using an 8.0 mm-punch biopsy tool.
Biopsies from three different areas at the site of adalimumab administration were
collected in each animal. Additional tissue biopsy samples were collected from three
different areas at the proximal colon, and the proximal region of transverse colon
in each animal. Approximately 3 g of total punched sample and 200 mg of luminal content
were collected in a pre-weighed conical tubes and the tissue weighed was recorded.
[0530] Approximately, a 5-cm length of open gastrointestinal tissue sample including terminal
ileum, cecum (CAC); proximal colon (PCN); transverse colon (TCN); spiral colon, distal
colon (DCN), and rectum was collected, gently rinsed in saline to remove luminal material,
and individually fixed in fixation buffer (10% neutral buffered formalin). Also, a
5-cm length of open gastrointestinal tissue from 3 different areas near the site of
adalimumab administration was collected and fixed in formalin in the same manner for
immunohistochemical staining for adalimumab. Tissue samples for histopathology were
fixed in 10% neutral buffered formalin for 18~24 hr, and transferred to 70% ethanol.
[0531] HUMIRA
® was supplied in single-use, 1-mL pre-filled glass syringes, as a sterile, preservative-free
solution for subcutaneous administration. The solution of HUMIRA
® was clear and colorless, with a pH of about 5.2. Each syringe delivered 0.8 mL (40
mg adalimumab) of drug product. Each vial contained approximately 0.9 mL of solution
to deliver 0.8 mL (40 mg adalimumab) of drug product. Each 0.8 mL HUMIRA
® contained 40 mg adalimumab, 4.93 mg sodium chloride, 0.69 mg monobasic sodium phosphate
dihydrate, 1.22 mg dibasic sodium phosphate dihydrate, 0.24 mg sodium citrate, 1.04
mg citric acid monohydrate, 9.6 mg mannitol, 0.8 mg polysorbate 80, and water for
injection. Sodium hydroxide was added as necessary to adjust pH.
[0532] All animals were randomized into groups of three. Animals were dosed once with adalimumab
via subcutaneous (SC), perirectal (PR), or intracecal (IC) administration.
[0533] The concentration of adalimumab and TNFα was measured in plasma at 1, 2, 3, 4, 6,
and 12 hours post-dose. The concentration of adalimumab was measured in rectal contents
at 1, 3, 6, and 12 hours post-dose and in luminal content at 12 hours post-dose. Concentration
of adalimumab and TNFα, HER2, and total protein was measured in gastrointestinal tissue,
e.g., cecum sample (CAC), proximal colon sample (PCN), transverse colon sample (TCN),
distal colon sample (DCNi) inflamed, distal colon non-inflamed sample (DCNn), and
rectum sample (RTM), at 12 hours post-dose.
[0534] Treatment with 8.5% DSS (oral; Day 1 to Day7) induced mild body weight loss, hemorrhage
diarrhea, soft bloody stool, and moderate colitis in swine. Necropsy revealed marked
edema and full thickness of mucosal erosion from the proximal colon through the distal
rectum. The 8.5% DSS-induced animals were treated with adalimumab at day 8. No significant
differences in clinical observations, GI-specific adverse effects or toxicity due
to adalimumab treatment were observed. The 15% DSS (oral; day 1 to day 7)-induced
animals had marked mucosal sloughing and hemorrhage from cecum to rectum and severe
colitis. All of the animals were euthanized early on day 5.
[0535] Significant lesions of colitis were found in animals treated with 8.5% DSS and were
characterized by inflammation that involved mucosa and submucosa, loss of surface
epithelium (erosion), and intestinal crypts (Figure 93 and 94). There was little,
if any, evidence of regeneration. The ileum and cecum were unremarkable in all animals
except cecum from one animal (animal 2504) that was treated with 8.5% DSS, which had
lesions of inflammation and loss of surface and crypt epithelium (Figures 95-99).
Lesions of colitis were significant and consistent in all other segments of the large
intestine from animals treated with 8.5% DSS. The severity and character of the changes
were not remarkably different among the different segments or among these animals.
Staining for human IgG was most consistent and intense at the adalimumab administration
site and localized to the luminal surface of the mucosal epithelium or inflammatory
exudate at the luminal surface, and penetration of adalimumab is found in the lamina
propria near the luminal surface (Figure 100).
Example 12. Human Clinical Trial of Treatment of Ulcerative Colitis using Adalimumab
[0536] As a proof of concept, the patient population of this study is patients that (1)
have moderate to severe ulcerative colitis, regardless of extent, and (2) have had
an insufficient response to a previous treatment, e.g., a conventional therapy (e.g.,
5-ASA, corticosteroid, and/or immunosuppressant) or a FDA-approved treatment. In this
placebo-controlled eight-week study, patients are randomized. All patient undergo
a colonoscopy at the start of the study (baseline) and at week 8. Patients enrolled
in the study are assessed for clinical status of disease by stool frequency, rectal
bleeding, abdominal pain, physician's global assessment, and biomarker levels such
as fecal calprotectin and hsCRP. The primary endpoint is a shift in endoscopy scores
from Baseline to Week 8. Secondary and exploratory endpoints include safety and tolerability,
change in rectal bleeding score, change in abdominal pain score, change in stool frequency,
change in partial Mayo score, change in Mayo score, proportion of subjects achieving
endoscopy remission, proportion of subjects achieving clinical remission, change in
histology score, change in biomarkers of disease such as fecal calprotectin and hsCRP,
level of adalimumab in the blood/tissue/stool, change in cytokine levels (e.g., TNFα,
IL-6) in the blood and tissue.
[0537] Figure 72 describes an exemplary process of what would occur in clinical practice,
and when, where, and how the ingestible device will be used. Briefly, a patient displays
symptoms of ulcerative colitis, including but not limited to: diarrhea, bloody stool,
abdominal pain, high c-reactive protein (CRP), and/or high fecal calprotectin. A patient
may or may not have undergone a colonoscopy with diagnosis of ulcerative colitis at
this time. The patient's primary care physician refers the patient. The patient undergoes
a colonoscopy with a biopsy, CT scan, and/or MRI. Based on this testing, the patient
is diagnosed with ulcerative colitis. Most patients are diagnosed with ulcerative
colitis by colonoscopy with biopsy. The severity based on clinical symptoms and endoscopic
appearance, and the extent, based on the area of involvement on colonoscopy with or
without CT/MRI is documented. Treatment is determined based on diagnosis, severity
and extent.
[0538] For example, treatment for a patient that is diagnosed with ulcerative colitis is
an ingestible device programmed to release a single bolus of a therapeutic agent,
e.g., 40 mg adalimumab, in the cecum. Prior to administration of the treatment, the
patient is fasted overnight and is allowed to drink clear fluids. Four hours after
swallowing the ingestible device, the patient can resume a normal diet. An ingestible
device is swallowed at the same time each day. The ingestible device is not recovered.
[0539] In some cases, there may be two different ingestible devices: one including an induction
dose (first 8 to 12 weeks) and a different ingestible device including a different
dose or a different dosing interval.
[0540] In some examples, the ingestible device can include a mapping tool, which can be
used after 8 to 12 weeks of induction therapy, to assess the response status (e.g.,
based on one or more of the following: drug level, drug antibody level, biomarker
level, and mucosal healing status). Depending on the response status determined by
the mapping tool, a subject may continue to receive an induction regimen or maintenance
regimen of adalimumab.
[0541] In different clinical studies, the patients may be diagnosed with Crohn's disease
and the ingestible devices (including adalimumab) can be programmed to release adalimumab
in the cecum, or in both the cecum and transverse colon.
[0542] In different clinical studies, the patients may be diagnosed with illeocolonic Crohn's
disease and the ingestible devices (including adalimumab) can be programmed to release
adalimumab in the late jejunum or in the jejunum and transverse colon.
Example 13. Pharmacokinetic Study of Oral vs. Intra-Cecal Administration of Tacrolimus
in Yorkshire-Cross Farm Swine
[0543] The primary objective of this study was to study the pharmacokinetics of oral versus
intra-cecal administration of tacrolimus in normal Yorkshire-Cross farm swine.
[0544] This study compares the effects of administration of: a single intra-cecal administration
of a device containing 0.8 mL sterile vehicle solution (80% alcohol, 20% castor oil
(HCO-60)); a single oral dose of tacrolimus at 0.09 mg/kg (in sterile vehicle solution);
and a single intra-cecal administration of a device containing either 0.02 mg/kg (in
sterile vehicle solution), 0.04 mg/kg (in sterile vehicle solution), or 0.09 mg/kg
(in sterile vehicle solution).
[0545] This study employed five groups of three female swine weighing approximately 45 to
50 kg at study start. Swine were randomly placed into animal rooms/pens as they are
transferred from the delivery vehicle without regard to group. Group numbers were
assigned to the rooms in order of room number. No further randomization procedure
was employed. The study design is provided in Table 27.
Table 27: Study Design
[0546] Animals in Group 1 received intracecally a device containing a vehicle solution (80%
alcohol, 20% HCO-60). Animals in Group 2 received orally a liquid formulation of tacrolimus
at 0.09 mg/kg per animal. Animals in Group 3 received intracecally a device containing
tacrolimus at 0.02 mg/kg per device. Animals in Group 4 received intracecally a device
containing tacrolimus 0.04 mg/kg per device. Animals in Group 5 received intracecally
a device containing tacrolimus 0.09 mg/kg per device.
[0547] Samples of rectal contents were collected for pharmacokinetic analyses from each
animal at each of 1, 3, 6, and 12 hours post-device placement using a fecal swab (rectal
swab).
[0548] The concentration of tacrolimus measured was measured in the blood at 1-, 2-, 3-,
4-, 6-, and 12-hours post-dose. The concentration of tacrolimus was measured in rectal
contents at 1-, 3-, 6-, and 12-hours post-dose, and in the gastrointestinal tissue
and luminal content, e.g., the cecum tissue and lumen, the proximal colon tissue and
lumen, the spiral colon tissue and lumen, the transverse colon tissue and lumen, and
the distal colon tissue and lumen, at 12 hours post-dose.
Results
[0549] The data in Figures 77 and 78 show that the mean concentration and AUC
0-12 hours of tacrolimus in the blood was higher in swine that were intracecally administered
tacrolimus as compared to swine that were orally administered tacrolimus even at the
same concentration (0.09 mg/kg). The data in Figure 79 show that the mean concentration
of tacrolimus in the spiral colon tissue and the transverse colon tissue were statistically
higher in swine that were intacecally administered tacrolimus as compared to swine
that were orally administered tacrolimus. The data in Figure 80 show that the mean
concentration of tacrolimus in the spiral colon lumen, the transverse colon lumen,
and the distal colon lumen were statistically higher in swine that were intacecally
administered tacrolimus as compared to swine that were orally administered tacrolimus.
The data in Figures 81 and 82 show that the mean concentration of tacrolimus in the
rectal content was higher in swine that were intracecally administered tacrolimus
as compared to swine that were orally administered tacrolimus even at the same concentration,
particularly at 12 hours post-dose.
[0550] These data suggest that intra-cecal administration of tacrolimus is able to locally
deliver tacrolimus to the tissues in the GI tract of a mammal. A summary of the results
are shown in Table 28.
Table 28: Summary of Results
[0551] Tables 29-32 provide the tissue and plasma ratios of the animals in Groups 2-5.
Table 29: Tissue (mean) (ng/g)/ AUG(0-12hr) (ng·hr/mL) ratios
Table 30: Tissue (mean) (ng/g)/ AUG(0-12hr) (ng·hr/mL) ratios
Table 31: Tissue (mean) (ng/g)/ Trough(12hr)(ng/mL)
Table 32: Tissue (mean) (ng/g)/ Trough(12hr)(ng/mL)
Example 14
[0552] An ingestible medical device according to the disclosure ("TLC1") was tested on 20
subjects to investigate its localization ability. TLC1 was a biocompatible polycarbonate
ingestible device that contained a power supply, electronics and software. An onboard
software algorithm used time, temperature and reflected light spectral data to determine
the location of the ingestible device as it traveled the GI tract. The ingestible
device is 0.51 × 1.22 inches which is larger than a vitamin pill which is 0.4 x 0.85
inches. The subjects fasted overnight before participating in the study. Computerized
tomography ("CT") were used as a basis for determining the accuracy of the localization
data collected with TLC1. One of the 20 subjects did not follow the fasting rule.
CT data was lacking for another one of the 20 subjects. Thus, these two subjects were
excluded from further analysis. TLC1 sampled RGB data (radially transmitted) every
15 seconds for the first 14 hours after it entered the subject's stomach, and then
samples every five minutes after that until battery dies. TLC1 did not start to record
optical data until it reached the subject's stomach. Thus, there was no RGB-based
data for the mouth-esophagus transition for any of the subjects.
[0553] In addition, a PillCam
® SB (Given Imaging) device was tested on 57 subjects. The subjects fasted overnight
before joining the study. PillCam videos were recorded within each subject. The sampling
frequency of PillCam is velocity dependent. The faster PillCam travels, the faster
it would sample data. Each video is about seven to eight hours long, starting from
when the ingestible device was administrated into the subject's mouth. RGB optical
data were recorded in a table. A physician provided notes on where stomach-duodenum
transition and ileum-cecum transition occurred in each video. Computerized tomography
("CT") was used as a basis for determining the accuracy of the localization data collected
with PillCam.
Esophagus-Stomach Transition
[0554] For TLC1, it was assumed that this transition occurred one minute after the patient
ingested the device. For PillCam, the algorithm was as follows:
- 1. Start mouth-esophagus transition detection after ingestible device is activated/administrated
- 2. Check whether Green < 102.3 and Blue < 94.6
- a. If yes, mark as mouth-esophagus transition
- b. If no, continue to scan the data
- 3. After detecting mouth-esophagus transition, continue to monitor Green and Blue
signals for another 30 seconds, in case of location reversal
- a. If either Green > 110.1 or Blue > 105.5, mark it as mouth-esophagus location reversal
- b. Reset the mouth-esophagus flag and loop through step 2 and 3 until the confirmed
mouth-esophagus transition detected
- 4. Add one minute to the confirmed mouth-esophagus transition and mark it as esophagus-stomach
transition
[0555] For one of the PillCam subjects, there was not a clear cut difference between the
esophagus and stomach, so this subject was excluded from future analysis of stomach
localization. Among the 56 valid subjects, 54 of them have correct esophagus-stomach
transition localization. The total agreement is 54/56=96%. Each of the two failed
cases had prolonged esophageal of greater than one minute. Thus, adding one minute
to mouth-esophagus transition was not enough to cover the transition in esophagus
for these two subj ects.
Stomach-Duodenum
[0556] For both TLC1 and PillCam, a sliding window analysis was used. The algorithm used
a dumbbell shape two-sliding-window approach with a two-minute gap between the front
(first) and back (second) windows. The two-minute gap was designed, at least in part,
to skip the rapid transition from stomach to small intestine and capture the small
intestine signal after ingestible device settles down in small intestine. The algorithm
was as follows:
- 1. Start to check for stomach-duodenum transition after ingestible device enters stomach
- 2. Setup the two windows (front and back)
- a. Time length of each window: 3 minutes for TLC1; 30 seconds for PillCam
- b. Time gap between two windows: 2 minutes for both devices
- c. Window sliding step size: 0.5 minute for both devices
- 3. Compare signals in the two sliding windows
- a. If difference in mean is higher than 3 times the standard deviation of Green/Blue
signal in the back window
- i. If this is the first time ever, record the mean and standard deviation of signals
in the back window as stomach reference
- ii. If mean signal in the front window is higher than stomach reference signal by
a certain threshold (0.3 for TLC1 and 0.18 for PillCam), mark this as a possible stomach-duodenum
transition
- b. If a possible pyloric transition is detected, continue to scan for another 10 minutes
in case of false positive flag
- i. If within this 10 minutes, location reversal is detected, the previous pyloric
transition flag is a false positive flag. Clear the flag and continue to check
- ii. If no location reversal has been identified within 10 minutes following the possible
pyloric transition flag, mark it as a confirmed pyloric transition
- c. Continue monitoring Green/Blue data for another 2 hours after the confirmed pyloric
transition, in case of location reversal
- i. If a location reversal is identified, flag the timestamp when reversal happened
and then repeat steps a-c to look for the next pyloric transition
- ii. If the ingestible device has not gone back to stomach 2 hours after previously
confirmed pyloric transition, stops location reversal monitoring and assume the ingestible
device would stay in intestinal area
[0557] For TLC1, one of the 18 subjects had too few samples (<3 minutes) taken in the stomach
due to the delayed esophagus-stomach transition identification by previously developed
localization algorithm. Thus, this subject was excluded from the stomach-duodenum
transition algorithm test. For the rest of the TLC1 subjects, CT images confirmed
that the detected pyloric transitions for all the subjects were located somewhere
between stomach and jejunum. Two out of the 17 subjects showed that the ingestible
device went back to stomach after first the first stomach-duodenum transition. The
total agreement between the TLC1 algorithm detection and CT scans was 17/17 = 100%.
[0558] For one of the PillCam subjects, the ingestible device stayed in the subject's stomach
all the time before the video ended. For another two of the PillCam subjects, too
few samples were taken in the stomach to run the localization algorithm. These three
PillCam subjects were excluded from the stomach-duodenum transition localization algorithm
performance test. The performance summary of pyloric transition localization algorithm
for PillCam was as follows:
- 1. Good cases (48 subjects):
- a. For 25 subjects, our detection matches exactly with the physician's notes
- b. For 19 subjects, the difference between the two detections is less than five minutes
- c. For four subjects, the difference between the two detections is less than 10 minutes
(The full transition could take up to 10 minutes before the G/B signal settled)
- 2. Failed cases (6 subjects):
- a. Four subjects had high standard deviation of Green/Blue signal in the stomach
- b. One subject had bile in the stomach, which greatly affected Green/Blue in stomach
- c. One subject had no Green/Blue change at pyloric transition
[0559] The total agreement for the PillCam stomach-duodenum transition localization algorithm
detection and physician's notes was 48/54 = 89%.
Duodenum-Jejunum Transition
[0560] For TLC1, it was assumed that the device left the duodenum and entered the jejunum
three minutes after it was determined that the device entered the duodenum. Of the
17 subjects noted above with respect to the TLC1 investigation of the stomach-duodenum
transition, 16 of the subjects mentioned had CT images that confirmed that the duodenum-jejunum
transition was located somewhere between stomach and jejunum. One of the 17 subjects
had a prolonged transit time in duodenum. The total agreement between algorithm detection
and CT scans was 16/17 = 94%.
[0561] For PillCam, the duodenum-jejunum transition was not determined.
Jejunum-Ileum Transition
[0562] It is to be noted that the jejunum is redder and more vascular than ileum, and that
the jejunum has a thicker intestine wall with more mesentery fat. These differences
can cause various optical responses between jejunum and ileum, particularly for the
reflected red light signal. For both TLC1 and PillCam, two different approaches were
explored to track the change of red signal at the jejunum-ileum transition. The first
approach was a single-sliding-window analysis, where the window is 10 minutes long,
and the mean signal was compared with a threshold value while the window was moving
along. The second approach was a two-sliding-window analysis, where each window was
10 minutes long with a 20 minute spacing between the two windows. The algorithm for
the jejunum-ileum transition localization was as follows:
- 1. Obtain 20 minutes of Red signal after the duodenum-jejunum transition, average
the data and record it as the jejunum reference signal
- 2. Start to check the jejunum-ileum transition 20 minutes after the device enters
the jejunum
- a. Normalize the newly received data by the jejunum reference signal
- b. Two approaches:
- i. Single-sliding-window analysis
- Set the transition flag if the mean of reflected red signal is less than 0.8
- ii. Two-sliding-window analysis:
- Set the transition flag if the mean difference in reflected red is higher than 2X
the standard deviation of the reflected red signal in the front window
[0563] For TLC1, 16 of the 18 subjects had CT images that confirmed that the detected jejunum-ileum
transition fell between jejunum and cecum. The total agreement between algorithm and
CT scans was 16/18 = 89%. This was true for both the single-sliding-window and double-sliding-window
approaches, and the same two subjects failed in both approaches.
[0564] The performance summary of the jejunum-ileum transition detection for PillCam is
listed below:
- 1. Single-sliding-window analysis:
- a. 11 cases having jejunum-ileum transition detected somewhere between jejunum and
cecum
- b. 24 cases having jejunum-ileum transition detected after cecum
- c. 19 cases having no jejunum-ileum transition detected
- d. Total agreement: 11/54 = 20%
- 2. Two-sliding-window analysis:
- a. 30 cases having jejunum-ileum transition detected somewhere between jejunum and
cecum
- b. 24 cases having jejunum-ileum transition detected after cecum
- c. Total agreement: 30/54 = 56%
Ileum-Cecum Transition
[0565] Data demonstrated that, for TLC1, mean signal of reflected red/green provided the
most statistical difference before and after the ileum-cecum transition. Data also
demonstrated that, for TLC1, the coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue
provided the most statistical contrast at ileum-cecum transition. The analysis based
on PillCam videos showed very similar statistical trends to those results obtained
with TLC1 device. Thus, the algorithm utilized changes in mean value of reflected
red/green and the coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue. The algorithm
was as follows:
- 1. Start to monitor ileum-cecum transition after the ingestible device enters the
stomach
- 2. Setup the two windows (front (first) and back (second))
- a. Use a five-minute time length for each window
- b. Use a 10-minute gap between the two windows
- c. Use a one-minute window sliding step size
- 3. Compare signals in the two sliding windows
- a. Set ileum-cecum transition flag if
- i. Reflected red/green has a significant change or is lower than a threshold
- ii. Coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue is lower than a threshold
- b. If this is the first ileum-cecum transition detected, record average reflected
red/green signal in small intestine as small intestine reference signal
- c. Mark location reversal (i.e. ingestible device returns to terminal ileum) if
- i. Reflected red/green is statistically comparable with small intestine reference
signal
- ii. Coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue is higher than a threshold
- d. If a possible ileum-cecum transition is detected, continue to scan for another
10 minutes for TLC1 (15 minutes for PillCam) in case of false positive flag
- i. If within this time frame (10 minutes for TLC1, 15 minutes for PillCam), location
reversal is detected, the previous ileum-cecum transition flag is a false positive
flag. Clear the flag and continue to check
- ii. If no location reversal has been identified within this time frame (10 minutes
for TLC1, 15 minutes for PillCam) following the possible ileum-cecum transition flag,
mark it as a confirmed ileum-cecum transition
- e. Continue monitoring data for another 2 hours after the confirmed ileum-cecum transition,
in case of location reversal
- i. If a location reversal is identified, flag the timestamp when reversal happened
and then repeat steps a-d to look for the next ileum-cecum transition
- ii. If the ingestible device has not gone back to small intestine 2 hours after previously
confirmed ileum-cecum transition, stop location reversal monitoring and assume the
ingestible device would stay in large intestinal area
[0566] The flag setting and location reversal criteria particularly designed for TLC1 device
were as follows:
- 1. Set ileum-cecum transition flag if
- a. The average reflected red/Green in the front window is less than 0.7 or mean difference
between the two windows is higher than 0.6
- b. And the coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue is less than 0.02
- 2. Define as location reversal if
- a. The average reflected red/green in the front window is higher than small intestine
reference signal
- b. And the coefficient of variation of reflected green/blue is higher than 0.086
[0567] For TLC1, 16 of the 18 subjects had CT images that confirmed that the detected ileum-cecum
transition fell between terminal ileum and colon. The total agreement between algorithm
and CT scans was 16/18 = 89%. Regarding those two subject where the ileum-cecum transition
localization algorithm failed, for one subject the ileum-cecum transition was detected
while TLC1 was still in the subject's terminal ileum, and for the other subject the
ileum-cecum transition was detected when the device was in the colon.
[0568] Among the 57 available PillCam endoscopy videos, for three subjects the endoscopy
video ended before PillCam reached cecum, and another two subjects had only very limited
video data (less than five minutes) in the large intestine. These five subjects were
excluded from ileum-cecum transition localization algorithm performance test. The
performance summary of ileum-cecum transition detection for PillCam is listed below:
- 1. Good cases (39 subjects):
- a. For 31 subjects, the difference between the PillCam detection and the physician's
notes was less than five minutes
- b. For 3 subjects, the difference between the PillCam detection and the physician's
notes was less than 10 minutes
- c. For 5 subjects, the difference between the PillCam detection and the physician's
notes was less than 20 minutes (the full transition can take up to 20 minutes before
the signal settles)
- 2. Marginal/bad cases (13 subjects):
- a. Marginal cases (9 subjects)
- i. The PillCam ileum-cecum transition detection appeared in the terminal ileum or
colon, but the difference between the two detections was within one hour
- b. Failed cases (4 subjects)
- i. Reasons of failure:
- 1. The signal already stabilized in the terminal ileum
- 2. The signal was highly variable from the entrance to exit
- 3. There was no statistically significant change in reflected red/green at ileum-cecum
transition
[0569] The total agreement between ileocecal transition localization algorithm detection
and the physician's notes is 39/52 = 75% if considering good cases only. Total agreement
including possibly acceptable cases is 48/52 = 92.3%
Cecum-Colon Transition
[0570] Data demonstrated that, for TLC1, mean signal of reflected red/green provided the
most statistical difference before and after the cecum-colon transition. Data also
demonstrated that, for TLC1, the coefficient of variation of reflected blue provided
the most statistical contrast at cecum-colon transition. The same signals were used
for PillCam. The cecum-colon transition localization algorithm was as follows:
- 1. Obtain 10 minutes of reflected red/green and reflected blue signals after ileum-cecum
transition, average the data and record it as the cecum reference signals
- 2. Start to check cecum-colon transition after ingestible device enters cecum (The
cecum-colon transition algorithm is dependent on the ileum-cecum transition flag)
- a. Normalize the newly received data by the cecum reference signals
- b. Two-sliding-window analysis:
- i. Use two adjacent 10 minute windows
- ii. Set the transition flag if any of the following criteria were met
- The mean difference in reflected red/green was more than 4X the standard deviation
of reflected red/green in the back (second) window
- The mean of reflected red/green in the front (first) window was higher than 1.03
- The coefficient of variation of reflected blue signal in the front (first) window
was greater than 0.23
[0571] The threshold values above were chosen based on a statistical analysis of data taken
by TLC1.
[0572] For TLC 1, 15 of the 18 subjects had the cecum-colon transition detected somewhere
between cecum and colon. One of the subjects had the cecum-colon transition detected
while TLC1 was still in cecum. The other two subjects had both wrong ileum-cecum transition
detection and wrong cecum-colon transition detection. The total agreement between
algorithm and CT scans was 15/18 = 83%.
[0573] For PillCam, for three subjects the endoscopy video ended before PillCam reached
cecum, and for another two subjects there was very limited video data (less than five
minutes) in the large intestine. These five subjects were excluded from cecum-colon
transition localization algorithm performance test. The performance summary of cecum-colon
transition detection for PillCam is listed below:
- 1. 27 cases had the cecum-colon transition detected somewhere between the cecum and
the colon
- 2. one case had the cecum-colon transition detected in the ileum
- 3. 24 cases had no cecum-colon transition localized
[0574] The total agreement: 27/52 = 52%.
[0575] The following table summarizes the localization accuracy results.
| Transition |
TLC1 |
PillCam |
| Stomach-Duodenum |
100% (17/17) |
89% (48/54) |
| Duodenum-Jejenum |
94% (16/17) |
N/A |
| Ileum-Cecum |
89% (16/18) |
75% (39/52) |
| Ileum-terminal ileum/cecum/colon |
100% (18/18) |
92% (48/52) |
Example 15.
[0576] In the following case, each subject is treated by administering a device as disclosed
herein containing a self-localization mechanism that autonomously determines the device
location within the subject's GI tract. The device localization mechanism includes
one or more sensors associated with the device that detects light reflectance that
is external to the device and present in the GI tract. Based on pre-determined identification
of the disease site in a particular section or subsection of the GI tract, as disclosed,
the device is pre-programmed with instructions to release the drug into or proximal
to the section of the GI tract containing the disease site. The instructions are provided
from at least one processor and/or at least one controller associated with the at
least one sensor. The device contains a therapeutically effective amount of a S1P
modulator, optionally selected from the group consisting of fingolimod, KRP203, siponimod,
ponesimod, cenerimod, ozanimod, ceralifimod, amiselimod, and etrasimod, and prodrugs
and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof; or more particularly, ozanimod or
a prodrug and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; etrasimod or a prodrug
and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; or amiselimod or a prodrug and/or
pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
Treatment of inflammatory disease site(s) in the cecum by releasing drug in the cecum
[0577] In the following 3 cases, based on pre-determined identification of disease site(s)
in the cecum, as disclosed in each case, the device is pre-programmed with instructions
to release the drug into the cecum to treat the disease site(s).
- (i) A 25-year old male subject suffering from symptoms of gastrointestinal inflammation
walks into a clinic. The subject undergoes an endoscopy, which reveals disease site(s)
in the tissue in the cecum. Subsequently, the subject is orally administered the ingestible
device containing the therapeutically effective amount of the drug. After ingestion
of the device, data collected from at least one of the light sensors, optionally in
conjunction with elapsed time through the GI tract after the oral administration,
indicates that the device has transitioned into the cecum with at least about 80%
accuracy. In this particular case, the light reflectance detected by the sensors includes
red, green and blue light. A decrease in the ratio of the red to green reflectance,
together with a decrease in the ratio of the green to blue reflectance, are used to
determine that the device has transitioned from the ileum to the cecum. The formulation
is then released from the device based on the instructions. The subject subsequently
undergoes an endoscopy to determine the effect of the treatment.
- (ii) Treatment of ulcerative colitis in the cecum by releasing drug in the cecum.
A subject with a history of ulcerative colitis returns to the clinic. The subject
undergoes an endoscopy, which reveals that the subject has disease site(s) in the
tissue in the cecum. Subsequently, the subject is orally administered the ingestible
device containing the therapeutically effective amount of the drug. After ingestion
of the device, data collected from at least one of the light sensors, optionally in
conjunction with elapsed time through the GI tract after the oral administration,
indicates that the device has transitioned into the cecum with at least about 80%
accuracy. In this particular case, the light reflectance detected by the sensors includes
red, green and blue light. A decrease in the ratio of the red to green reflectance,
together with a decrease in the ratio of the green to blue reflectance, are used to
determine that the device has transitioned from the ileum to the cecum. The formulation
is then released from the device based on the instructions. The subject subsequently
undergoes an endoscopy to determine the effect of the treatment.
- (iii) Treatment of Crohn's disease in the cecum by releasing drug in the cecum. A
subject suffering from symptoms of Crohn's disease, including fatigue, reduced appetite
and frequent, recurring diarrhea goes to a local clinic. The subject undergoes an
endoscopy, which reveals that the subject has disease site(s) in the tissue in the
cecum. Subsequently, the subject is orally administered the ingestible device containing
the therapeutically effective amount of the drug. After ingestion of the device, data
collected from at least one of the light sensors, optionally in conjunction with elapsed
time through the GI tract after the oral administration, indicates that the device
has transitioned into the cecum with at least about 80% accuracy. In this particular
case, the light reflectance detected by the sensors includes red, green and blue light.
A decrease in the ratio of the red to green reflectance, together with a decrease
in the ratio of the green to blue reflectance, are used to determine that the device
has transitioned from the ileum to the cecum. The formulation is then released from
the device based on the instructions. The subject subsequently undergoes an endoscopy
to determine the effect of the treatment.